summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/build-aux
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorLorry Tar Creator <lorry-tar-importer@lorry>2016-01-20 10:55:18 +0000
committerLorry Tar Creator <lorry-tar-importer@lorry>2016-01-20 10:55:18 +0000
commit70e9163c9c18e995515598085cb824e554eb7ae7 (patch)
treea42dc8b2a6c031354bf31472de888bfc8a060132 /build-aux
parentcbf5993c43f49281173f185863577d86bfac6eae (diff)
downloadcoreutils-tarball-master.tar.gz
Diffstat (limited to 'build-aux')
-rw-r--r--build-aux/ChangeLog-2007 (renamed from build-aux/ChangeLog)13
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/announce-gen557
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/ar-lib270
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/compile245
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/config.guess787
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/config.rpath200
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/config.sub409
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/cvsu514
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/depcomp612
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/do-release-commit-and-tag179
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/gen-lists-of-programs.sh194
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/gen-single-binary.sh111
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/gendocs.sh504
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/git-version-gen226
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/gitlog-to-changelog492
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/gnu-web-doc-update209
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/gnupload440
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/install-sh388
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/mdate-sh49
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/missing460
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/prefix-gnulib-mk238
-rw-r--r--build-aux/snippet/_Noreturn.h10
-rw-r--r--build-aux/snippet/arg-nonnull.h26
-rw-r--r--build-aux/snippet/c++defs.h271
-rw-r--r--build-aux/snippet/unused-parameter.h36
-rw-r--r--build-aux/snippet/warn-on-use.h109
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/test-driver148
-rw-r--r--build-aux/texinfo.tex5938
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/update-copyright274
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/useless-if-before-free207
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/vc-list-files131
-rwxr-xr-xbuild-aux/ylwrap228
32 files changed, 10845 insertions, 3630 deletions
diff --git a/build-aux/ChangeLog b/build-aux/ChangeLog-2007
index c18b1c2..bc5b2fb 100644
--- a/build-aux/ChangeLog
+++ b/build-aux/ChangeLog-2007
@@ -1,3 +1,13 @@
+2007-09-29 Eric Blake <ebb9@byu.net>
+
+ * check.mk (%.log): Also allow suffix-less tests, on platforms
+ where $(EXEEXT) is not empty.
+
+2007-09-15 Jim Meyering <jim@meyering.net>
+
+ * vc-list-files: Remove mercurial support.
+ Check for CVS first. Adjust comments.
+
2007-01-30 Jim Meyering <jim@meyering.net>
* vc-list-files: Select column 2, not 3 (hg-0.9.3's manifest format
@@ -224,8 +234,7 @@
-----
- Copyright (C) 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software
- Foundation, Inc.
+ Copyright (C) 2002-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
Copying and distribution of this file, with or without
modification, are permitted provided the copyright notice
diff --git a/build-aux/announce-gen b/build-aux/announce-gen
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..b461174
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/announce-gen
@@ -0,0 +1,557 @@
+eval '(exit $?0)' && eval 'exec perl -wS "$0" "$@"'
+ & eval 'exec perl -wS "$0" $argv:q'
+ if 0;
+# Generate a release announcement message.
+
+my $VERSION = '2016-01-12 23:09'; # UTC
+# The definition above must lie within the first 8 lines in order
+# for the Emacs time-stamp write hook (at end) to update it.
+# If you change this file with Emacs, please let the write hook
+# do its job. Otherwise, update this string manually.
+
+# Copyright (C) 2002-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
+# (at your option) any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# Written by Jim Meyering
+
+use strict;
+
+use Getopt::Long;
+use POSIX qw(strftime);
+
+(my $ME = $0) =~ s|.*/||;
+
+my %valid_release_types = map {$_ => 1} qw (alpha beta stable);
+my @archive_suffixes = ('tar.gz', 'tar.bz2', 'tar.lzma', 'tar.xz');
+my %digest_classes =
+ (
+ 'md5' => (eval { require Digest::MD5; } and 'Digest::MD5'),
+ 'sha1' => ((eval { require Digest::SHA; } and 'Digest::SHA')
+ or (eval { require Digest::SHA1; } and 'Digest::SHA1'))
+ );
+my $srcdir = '.';
+
+sub usage ($)
+{
+ my ($exit_code) = @_;
+ my $STREAM = ($exit_code == 0 ? *STDOUT : *STDERR);
+ if ($exit_code != 0)
+ {
+ print $STREAM "Try '$ME --help' for more information.\n";
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ my @types = sort keys %valid_release_types;
+ print $STREAM <<EOF;
+Usage: $ME [OPTIONS]
+Generate an announcement message. Run this from builddir.
+
+OPTIONS:
+
+These options must be specified:
+
+ --release-type=TYPE TYPE must be one of @types
+ --package-name=PACKAGE_NAME
+ --previous-version=VER
+ --current-version=VER
+ --gpg-key-id=ID The GnuPG ID of the key used to sign the tarballs
+ --url-directory=URL_DIR
+
+The following are optional:
+
+ --news=NEWS_FILE include the NEWS section about this release
+ from this NEWS_FILE; accumulates.
+ --srcdir=DIR where to find the NEWS_FILEs (default: $srcdir)
+ --bootstrap-tools=TOOL_LIST a comma-separated list of tools, e.g.,
+ autoconf,automake,bison,gnulib
+ --gnulib-version=VERSION report VERSION as the gnulib version, where
+ VERSION is the result of running git describe
+ in the gnulib source directory.
+ required if gnulib is in TOOL_LIST.
+ --no-print-checksums do not emit MD5 or SHA1 checksums
+ --archive-suffix=SUF add SUF to the list of archive suffixes
+ --mail-headers=HEADERS a space-separated list of mail headers, e.g.,
+ To: x\@example.com Cc: y-announce\@example.com,...
+
+ --help display this help and exit
+ --version output version information and exit
+
+EOF
+ }
+ exit $exit_code;
+}
+
+
+=item C<%size> = C<sizes (@file)>
+
+Compute the sizes of the C<@file> and return them as a hash. Return
+C<undef> if one of the computation failed.
+
+=cut
+
+sub sizes (@)
+{
+ my (@file) = @_;
+
+ my $fail = 0;
+ my %res;
+ foreach my $f (@file)
+ {
+ my $cmd = "du -h $f";
+ my $t = `$cmd`;
+ # FIXME-someday: give a better diagnostic, a la $PROCESS_STATUS
+ $@
+ and (warn "command failed: '$cmd'\n"), $fail = 1;
+ chomp $t;
+ $t =~ s/^\s*([\d.]+[MkK]).*/${1}B/;
+ $res{$f} = $t;
+ }
+ return $fail ? undef : %res;
+}
+
+=item C<print_locations ($title, \@url, \%size, @file)
+
+Print a section C<$title> dedicated to the list of <@file>, which
+sizes are stored in C<%size>, and which are available from the C<@url>.
+
+=cut
+
+sub print_locations ($\@\%@)
+{
+ my ($title, $url, $size, @file) = @_;
+ print "Here are the $title:\n";
+ foreach my $url (@{$url})
+ {
+ for my $file (@file)
+ {
+ print " $url/$file";
+ print " (", $$size{$file}, ")"
+ if exists $$size{$file};
+ print "\n";
+ }
+ }
+ print "\n";
+}
+
+=item C<print_checksums (@file)
+
+Print the MD5 and SHA1 signature section for each C<@file>.
+
+=cut
+
+sub print_checksums (@)
+{
+ my (@file) = @_;
+
+ print "Here are the MD5 and SHA1 checksums:\n";
+ print "\n";
+
+ foreach my $meth (qw (md5 sha1))
+ {
+ my $class = $digest_classes{$meth} or next;
+ foreach my $f (@file)
+ {
+ open IN, '<', $f
+ or die "$ME: $f: cannot open for reading: $!\n";
+ binmode IN;
+ my $dig = $class->new->addfile(*IN)->hexdigest;
+ close IN;
+ print "$dig $f\n";
+ }
+ }
+ print "\n";
+}
+
+=item C<print_news_deltas ($news_file, $prev_version, $curr_version)
+
+Print the section of the NEWS file C<$news_file> addressing changes
+between versions C<$prev_version> and C<$curr_version>.
+
+=cut
+
+sub print_news_deltas ($$$)
+{
+ my ($news_file, $prev_version, $curr_version) = @_;
+
+ my $news_name = $news_file;
+ $news_name =~ s|^\Q$srcdir\E/||;
+
+ print "\n$news_name\n\n";
+
+ # Print all lines from $news_file, starting with the first one
+ # that mentions $curr_version up to but not including
+ # the first occurrence of $prev_version.
+ my $in_items;
+
+ my $re_prefix = qr/(?:\* )?(?:Noteworthy c|Major c|C)(?i:hanges)/;
+
+ my $found_news;
+ open NEWS, '<', $news_file
+ or die "$ME: $news_file: cannot open for reading: $!\n";
+ while (defined (my $line = <NEWS>))
+ {
+ if ( ! $in_items)
+ {
+ # Match lines like these:
+ # * Major changes in release 5.0.1:
+ # * Noteworthy changes in release 6.6 (2006-11-22) [stable]
+ $line =~ /^$re_prefix.*(?:[^\d.]|$)\Q$curr_version\E(?:[^\d.]|$)/o
+ or next;
+ $in_items = 1;
+ print $line;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ # This regexp must not match version numbers in NEWS items.
+ # For example, they might well say "introduced in 4.5.5",
+ # and we don't want that to match.
+ $line =~ /^$re_prefix.*(?:[^\d.]|$)\Q$prev_version\E(?:[^\d.]|$)/o
+ and last;
+ print $line;
+ $line =~ /\S/
+ and $found_news = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ close NEWS;
+
+ $in_items
+ or die "$ME: $news_file: no matching lines for '$curr_version'\n";
+ $found_news
+ or die "$ME: $news_file: no news item found for '$curr_version'\n";
+}
+
+sub print_changelog_deltas ($$)
+{
+ my ($package_name, $prev_version) = @_;
+
+ # Print new ChangeLog entries.
+
+ # First find all CVS-controlled ChangeLog files.
+ use File::Find;
+ my @changelog;
+ find ({wanted => sub {$_ eq 'ChangeLog' && -d 'CVS'
+ and push @changelog, $File::Find::name}},
+ '.');
+
+ # If there are no ChangeLog files, we're done.
+ @changelog
+ or return;
+ my %changelog = map {$_ => 1} @changelog;
+
+ # Reorder the list of files so that if there are ChangeLog
+ # files in the specified directories, they're listed first,
+ # in this order:
+ my @dir = qw ( . src lib m4 config doc );
+
+ # A typical @changelog array might look like this:
+ # ./ChangeLog
+ # ./po/ChangeLog
+ # ./m4/ChangeLog
+ # ./lib/ChangeLog
+ # ./doc/ChangeLog
+ # ./config/ChangeLog
+ my @reordered;
+ foreach my $d (@dir)
+ {
+ my $dot_slash = $d eq '.' ? $d : "./$d";
+ my $target = "$dot_slash/ChangeLog";
+ delete $changelog{$target}
+ and push @reordered, $target;
+ }
+
+ # Append any remaining ChangeLog files.
+ push @reordered, sort keys %changelog;
+
+ # Remove leading './'.
+ @reordered = map { s!^\./!!; $_ } @reordered;
+
+ print "\nChangeLog entries:\n\n";
+ # print join ("\n", @reordered), "\n";
+
+ $prev_version =~ s/\./_/g;
+ my $prev_cvs_tag = "\U$package_name\E-$prev_version";
+
+ my $cmd = "cvs -n diff -u -r$prev_cvs_tag -rHEAD @reordered";
+ open DIFF, '-|', $cmd
+ or die "$ME: cannot run '$cmd': $!\n";
+ # Print two types of lines, making minor changes:
+ # Lines starting with '+++ ', e.g.,
+ # +++ ChangeLog 22 Feb 2003 16:52:51 -0000 1.247
+ # and those starting with '+'.
+ # Don't print the others.
+ my $prev_printed_line_empty = 1;
+ while (defined (my $line = <DIFF>))
+ {
+ if ($line =~ /^\+\+\+ /)
+ {
+ my $separator = "*"x70 ."\n";
+ $line =~ s///;
+ $line =~ s/\s.*//;
+ $prev_printed_line_empty
+ or print "\n";
+ print $separator, $line, $separator;
+ }
+ elsif ($line =~ /^\+/)
+ {
+ $line =~ s///;
+ print $line;
+ $prev_printed_line_empty = ($line =~ /^$/);
+ }
+ }
+ close DIFF;
+
+ # The exit code should be 1.
+ # Allow in case there are no modified ChangeLog entries.
+ $? == 256 || $? == 128
+ or warn "warning: '$cmd' had unexpected exit code or signal ($?)\n";
+}
+
+sub get_tool_versions ($$)
+{
+ my ($tool_list, $gnulib_version) = @_;
+ @$tool_list
+ or return ();
+
+ my $fail;
+ my @tool_version_pair;
+ foreach my $t (@$tool_list)
+ {
+ if ($t eq 'gnulib')
+ {
+ push @tool_version_pair, ucfirst $t . ' ' . $gnulib_version;
+ next;
+ }
+ # Assume that the last "word" on the first line of
+ # 'tool --version' output is the version string.
+ my ($first_line, undef) = split ("\n", `$t --version`);
+ if ($first_line =~ /.* (\d[\w.-]+)$/)
+ {
+ $t = ucfirst $t;
+ push @tool_version_pair, "$t $1";
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ defined $first_line
+ and $first_line = '';
+ warn "$t: unexpected --version output\n:$first_line";
+ $fail = 1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ $fail
+ and exit 1;
+
+ return @tool_version_pair;
+}
+
+{
+ # Neutralize the locale, so that, for instance, "du" does not
+ # issue "1,2" instead of "1.2", what confuses our regexps.
+ $ENV{LC_ALL} = "C";
+
+ my $mail_headers;
+ my $release_type;
+ my $package_name;
+ my $prev_version;
+ my $curr_version;
+ my $gpg_key_id;
+ my @url_dir_list;
+ my @news_file;
+ my $bootstrap_tools;
+ my $gnulib_version;
+ my $print_checksums_p = 1;
+
+ # Reformat the warnings before displaying them.
+ local $SIG{__WARN__} = sub
+ {
+ my ($msg) = @_;
+ # Warnings from GetOptions.
+ $msg =~ s/Option (\w)/option --$1/;
+ warn "$ME: $msg";
+ };
+
+ GetOptions
+ (
+ 'mail-headers=s' => \$mail_headers,
+ 'release-type=s' => \$release_type,
+ 'package-name=s' => \$package_name,
+ 'previous-version=s' => \$prev_version,
+ 'current-version=s' => \$curr_version,
+ 'gpg-key-id=s' => \$gpg_key_id,
+ 'url-directory=s' => \@url_dir_list,
+ 'news=s' => \@news_file,
+ 'srcdir=s' => \$srcdir,
+ 'bootstrap-tools=s' => \$bootstrap_tools,
+ 'gnulib-version=s' => \$gnulib_version,
+ 'print-checksums!' => \$print_checksums_p,
+ 'archive-suffix=s' => \@archive_suffixes,
+
+ help => sub { usage 0 },
+ version => sub { print "$ME version $VERSION\n"; exit },
+ ) or usage 1;
+
+ my $fail = 0;
+ # Ensure that each required option is specified.
+ $release_type
+ or (warn "release type not specified\n"), $fail = 1;
+ $package_name
+ or (warn "package name not specified\n"), $fail = 1;
+ $prev_version
+ or (warn "previous version string not specified\n"), $fail = 1;
+ $curr_version
+ or (warn "current version string not specified\n"), $fail = 1;
+ $gpg_key_id
+ or (warn "GnuPG key ID not specified\n"), $fail = 1;
+ @url_dir_list
+ or (warn "URL directory name(s) not specified\n"), $fail = 1;
+
+ my @tool_list = split ',', $bootstrap_tools
+ if $bootstrap_tools;
+
+ grep (/^gnulib$/, @tool_list) ^ defined $gnulib_version
+ and (warn "when specifying gnulib as a tool, you must also specify\n"
+ . "--gnulib-version=V, where V is the result of running git describe\n"
+ . "in the gnulib source directory.\n"), $fail = 1;
+
+ !$release_type || exists $valid_release_types{$release_type}
+ or (warn "'$release_type': invalid release type\n"), $fail = 1;
+
+ @ARGV
+ and (warn "too many arguments:\n", join ("\n", @ARGV), "\n"),
+ $fail = 1;
+ $fail
+ and usage 1;
+
+ my $my_distdir = "$package_name-$curr_version";
+
+ my $xd = "$package_name-$prev_version-$curr_version.xdelta";
+
+ my @candidates = map { "$my_distdir.$_" } @archive_suffixes;
+ my @tarballs = grep {-f $_} @candidates;
+
+ @tarballs
+ or die "$ME: none of " . join(', ', @candidates) . " were found\n";
+ my @sizable = @tarballs;
+ -f $xd
+ and push @sizable, $xd;
+ my %size = sizes (@sizable);
+ %size
+ or exit 1;
+
+ my $headers = '';
+ if (defined $mail_headers)
+ {
+ ($headers = $mail_headers) =~ s/\s+(\S+:)/\n$1/g;
+ $headers .= "\n";
+ }
+
+ # The markup is escaped as <\# so that when this script is sent by
+ # mail (or part of a diff), Gnus is not triggered.
+ print <<EOF;
+
+${headers}Subject: $my_distdir released [$release_type]
+
+<\#secure method=pgpmime mode=sign>
+
+FIXME: put comments here
+
+EOF
+
+ if (@url_dir_list == 1 && @tarballs == 1)
+ {
+ # When there's only one tarball and one URL, use a more concise form.
+ my $m = "$url_dir_list[0]/$tarballs[0]";
+ print "Here are the compressed sources and a GPG detached signature[*]:\n"
+ . " $m\n"
+ . " $m.sig\n\n";
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ print_locations ("compressed sources", @url_dir_list, %size, @tarballs);
+ -f $xd
+ and print_locations ("xdelta diffs (useful? if so, "
+ . "please tell bug-gnulib\@gnu.org)",
+ @url_dir_list, %size, $xd);
+ my @sig_files = map { "$_.sig" } @tarballs;
+ print_locations ("GPG detached signatures[*]", @url_dir_list, %size,
+ @sig_files);
+ }
+
+ if ($url_dir_list[0] =~ "gnu\.org")
+ {
+ print "Use a mirror for higher download bandwidth:\n";
+ if (@tarballs == 1 && $url_dir_list[0] =~ m!http://ftp\.gnu\.org/gnu/!)
+ {
+ (my $m = "$url_dir_list[0]/$tarballs[0]")
+ =~ s!http://ftp\.gnu\.org/gnu/!http://ftpmirror\.gnu\.org/!;
+ print " $m\n"
+ . " $m.sig\n\n";
+
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ print " http://www.gnu.org/order/ftp.html\n\n";
+ }
+ }
+
+ $print_checksums_p
+ and print_checksums (@sizable);
+
+ print <<EOF;
+[*] Use a .sig file to verify that the corresponding file (without the
+.sig suffix) is intact. First, be sure to download both the .sig file
+and the corresponding tarball. Then, run a command like this:
+
+ gpg --verify $tarballs[0].sig
+
+If that command fails because you don't have the required public key,
+then run this command to import it:
+
+ gpg --keyserver keys.gnupg.net --recv-keys $gpg_key_id
+
+and rerun the 'gpg --verify' command.
+EOF
+
+ my @tool_versions = get_tool_versions (\@tool_list, $gnulib_version);
+ @tool_versions
+ and print "\nThis release was bootstrapped with the following tools:",
+ join ('', map {"\n $_"} @tool_versions), "\n";
+
+ print_news_deltas ($_, $prev_version, $curr_version)
+ foreach @news_file;
+
+ $release_type eq 'stable'
+ or print_changelog_deltas ($package_name, $prev_version);
+
+ exit 0;
+}
+
+### Setup "GNU" style for perl-mode and cperl-mode.
+## Local Variables:
+## mode: perl
+## perl-indent-level: 2
+## perl-continued-statement-offset: 2
+## perl-continued-brace-offset: 0
+## perl-brace-offset: 0
+## perl-brace-imaginary-offset: 0
+## perl-label-offset: -2
+## perl-extra-newline-before-brace: t
+## perl-merge-trailing-else: nil
+## eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+## time-stamp-start: "my $VERSION = '"
+## time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d %02H:%02M"
+## time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+## time-stamp-end: "'; # UTC"
+## End:
diff --git a/build-aux/ar-lib b/build-aux/ar-lib
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..463b9ec
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/ar-lib
@@ -0,0 +1,270 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+# Wrapper for Microsoft lib.exe
+
+me=ar-lib
+scriptversion=2012-03-01.08; # UTC
+
+# Copyright (C) 2010-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Written by Peter Rosin <peda@lysator.liu.se>.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
+# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
+# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
+# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
+
+# This file is maintained in Automake, please report
+# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
+# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
+
+
+# func_error message
+func_error ()
+{
+ echo "$me: $1" 1>&2
+ exit 1
+}
+
+file_conv=
+
+# func_file_conv build_file
+# Convert a $build file to $host form and store it in $file
+# Currently only supports Windows hosts.
+func_file_conv ()
+{
+ file=$1
+ case $file in
+ / | /[!/]*) # absolute file, and not a UNC file
+ if test -z "$file_conv"; then
+ # lazily determine how to convert abs files
+ case `uname -s` in
+ MINGW*)
+ file_conv=mingw
+ ;;
+ CYGWIN*)
+ file_conv=cygwin
+ ;;
+ *)
+ file_conv=wine
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ case $file_conv in
+ mingw)
+ file=`cmd //C echo "$file " | sed -e 's/"\(.*\) " *$/\1/'`
+ ;;
+ cygwin)
+ file=`cygpath -m "$file" || echo "$file"`
+ ;;
+ wine)
+ file=`winepath -w "$file" || echo "$file"`
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+}
+
+# func_at_file at_file operation archive
+# Iterate over all members in AT_FILE performing OPERATION on ARCHIVE
+# for each of them.
+# When interpreting the content of the @FILE, do NOT use func_file_conv,
+# since the user would need to supply preconverted file names to
+# binutils ar, at least for MinGW.
+func_at_file ()
+{
+ operation=$2
+ archive=$3
+ at_file_contents=`cat "$1"`
+ eval set x "$at_file_contents"
+ shift
+
+ for member
+ do
+ $AR -NOLOGO $operation:"$member" "$archive" || exit $?
+ done
+}
+
+case $1 in
+ '')
+ func_error "no command. Try '$0 --help' for more information."
+ ;;
+ -h | --h*)
+ cat <<EOF
+Usage: $me [--help] [--version] PROGRAM ACTION ARCHIVE [MEMBER...]
+
+Members may be specified in a file named with @FILE.
+EOF
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+ -v | --v*)
+ echo "$me, version $scriptversion"
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+esac
+
+if test $# -lt 3; then
+ func_error "you must specify a program, an action and an archive"
+fi
+
+AR=$1
+shift
+while :
+do
+ if test $# -lt 2; then
+ func_error "you must specify a program, an action and an archive"
+ fi
+ case $1 in
+ -lib | -LIB \
+ | -ltcg | -LTCG \
+ | -machine* | -MACHINE* \
+ | -subsystem* | -SUBSYSTEM* \
+ | -verbose | -VERBOSE \
+ | -wx* | -WX* )
+ AR="$AR $1"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ action=$1
+ shift
+ break
+ ;;
+ esac
+done
+orig_archive=$1
+shift
+func_file_conv "$orig_archive"
+archive=$file
+
+# strip leading dash in $action
+action=${action#-}
+
+delete=
+extract=
+list=
+quick=
+replace=
+index=
+create=
+
+while test -n "$action"
+do
+ case $action in
+ d*) delete=yes ;;
+ x*) extract=yes ;;
+ t*) list=yes ;;
+ q*) quick=yes ;;
+ r*) replace=yes ;;
+ s*) index=yes ;;
+ S*) ;; # the index is always updated implicitly
+ c*) create=yes ;;
+ u*) ;; # TODO: don't ignore the update modifier
+ v*) ;; # TODO: don't ignore the verbose modifier
+ *)
+ func_error "unknown action specified"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ action=${action#?}
+done
+
+case $delete$extract$list$quick$replace,$index in
+ yes,* | ,yes)
+ ;;
+ yesyes*)
+ func_error "more than one action specified"
+ ;;
+ *)
+ func_error "no action specified"
+ ;;
+esac
+
+if test -n "$delete"; then
+ if test ! -f "$orig_archive"; then
+ func_error "archive not found"
+ fi
+ for member
+ do
+ case $1 in
+ @*)
+ func_at_file "${1#@}" -REMOVE "$archive"
+ ;;
+ *)
+ func_file_conv "$1"
+ $AR -NOLOGO -REMOVE:"$file" "$archive" || exit $?
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+
+elif test -n "$extract"; then
+ if test ! -f "$orig_archive"; then
+ func_error "archive not found"
+ fi
+ if test $# -gt 0; then
+ for member
+ do
+ case $1 in
+ @*)
+ func_at_file "${1#@}" -EXTRACT "$archive"
+ ;;
+ *)
+ func_file_conv "$1"
+ $AR -NOLOGO -EXTRACT:"$file" "$archive" || exit $?
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ else
+ $AR -NOLOGO -LIST "$archive" | sed -e 's/\\/\\\\/g' | while read member
+ do
+ $AR -NOLOGO -EXTRACT:"$member" "$archive" || exit $?
+ done
+ fi
+
+elif test -n "$quick$replace"; then
+ if test ! -f "$orig_archive"; then
+ if test -z "$create"; then
+ echo "$me: creating $orig_archive"
+ fi
+ orig_archive=
+ else
+ orig_archive=$archive
+ fi
+
+ for member
+ do
+ case $1 in
+ @*)
+ func_file_conv "${1#@}"
+ set x "$@" "@$file"
+ ;;
+ *)
+ func_file_conv "$1"
+ set x "$@" "$file"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ shift
+ shift
+ done
+
+ if test -n "$orig_archive"; then
+ $AR -NOLOGO -OUT:"$archive" "$orig_archive" "$@" || exit $?
+ else
+ $AR -NOLOGO -OUT:"$archive" "$@" || exit $?
+ fi
+
+elif test -n "$list"; then
+ if test ! -f "$orig_archive"; then
+ func_error "archive not found"
+ fi
+ $AR -NOLOGO -LIST "$archive" || exit $?
+fi
diff --git a/build-aux/compile b/build-aux/compile
index 1b1d232..a85b723 100755
--- a/build-aux/compile
+++ b/build-aux/compile
@@ -1,9 +1,9 @@
#! /bin/sh
-# Wrapper for compilers which do not understand `-c -o'.
+# Wrapper for compilers which do not understand '-c -o'.
-scriptversion=2005-05-14.22
+scriptversion=2012-10-14.11; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 1999-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# Written by Tom Tromey <tromey@cygnus.com>.
#
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
@@ -17,8 +17,7 @@ scriptversion=2005-05-14.22
# GNU General Public License for more details.
#
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
-# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
@@ -29,21 +28,224 @@ scriptversion=2005-05-14.22
# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
+nl='
+'
+
+# We need space, tab and new line, in precisely that order. Quoting is
+# there to prevent tools from complaining about whitespace usage.
+IFS=" "" $nl"
+
+file_conv=
+
+# func_file_conv build_file lazy
+# Convert a $build file to $host form and store it in $file
+# Currently only supports Windows hosts. If the determined conversion
+# type is listed in (the comma separated) LAZY, no conversion will
+# take place.
+func_file_conv ()
+{
+ file=$1
+ case $file in
+ / | /[!/]*) # absolute file, and not a UNC file
+ if test -z "$file_conv"; then
+ # lazily determine how to convert abs files
+ case `uname -s` in
+ MINGW*)
+ file_conv=mingw
+ ;;
+ CYGWIN*)
+ file_conv=cygwin
+ ;;
+ *)
+ file_conv=wine
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ case $file_conv/,$2, in
+ *,$file_conv,*)
+ ;;
+ mingw/*)
+ file=`cmd //C echo "$file " | sed -e 's/"\(.*\) " *$/\1/'`
+ ;;
+ cygwin/*)
+ file=`cygpath -m "$file" || echo "$file"`
+ ;;
+ wine/*)
+ file=`winepath -w "$file" || echo "$file"`
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+}
+
+# func_cl_dashL linkdir
+# Make cl look for libraries in LINKDIR
+func_cl_dashL ()
+{
+ func_file_conv "$1"
+ if test -z "$lib_path"; then
+ lib_path=$file
+ else
+ lib_path="$lib_path;$file"
+ fi
+ linker_opts="$linker_opts -LIBPATH:$file"
+}
+
+# func_cl_dashl library
+# Do a library search-path lookup for cl
+func_cl_dashl ()
+{
+ lib=$1
+ found=no
+ save_IFS=$IFS
+ IFS=';'
+ for dir in $lib_path $LIB
+ do
+ IFS=$save_IFS
+ if $shared && test -f "$dir/$lib.dll.lib"; then
+ found=yes
+ lib=$dir/$lib.dll.lib
+ break
+ fi
+ if test -f "$dir/$lib.lib"; then
+ found=yes
+ lib=$dir/$lib.lib
+ break
+ fi
+ if test -f "$dir/lib$lib.a"; then
+ found=yes
+ lib=$dir/lib$lib.a
+ break
+ fi
+ done
+ IFS=$save_IFS
+
+ if test "$found" != yes; then
+ lib=$lib.lib
+ fi
+}
+
+# func_cl_wrapper cl arg...
+# Adjust compile command to suit cl
+func_cl_wrapper ()
+{
+ # Assume a capable shell
+ lib_path=
+ shared=:
+ linker_opts=
+ for arg
+ do
+ if test -n "$eat"; then
+ eat=
+ else
+ case $1 in
+ -o)
+ # configure might choose to run compile as 'compile cc -o foo foo.c'.
+ eat=1
+ case $2 in
+ *.o | *.[oO][bB][jJ])
+ func_file_conv "$2"
+ set x "$@" -Fo"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ func_file_conv "$2"
+ set x "$@" -Fe"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ -I)
+ eat=1
+ func_file_conv "$2" mingw
+ set x "$@" -I"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ -I*)
+ func_file_conv "${1#-I}" mingw
+ set x "$@" -I"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ -l)
+ eat=1
+ func_cl_dashl "$2"
+ set x "$@" "$lib"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ -l*)
+ func_cl_dashl "${1#-l}"
+ set x "$@" "$lib"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ -L)
+ eat=1
+ func_cl_dashL "$2"
+ ;;
+ -L*)
+ func_cl_dashL "${1#-L}"
+ ;;
+ -static)
+ shared=false
+ ;;
+ -Wl,*)
+ arg=${1#-Wl,}
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS=','
+ for flag in $arg; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ linker_opts="$linker_opts $flag"
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ ;;
+ -Xlinker)
+ eat=1
+ linker_opts="$linker_opts $2"
+ ;;
+ -*)
+ set x "$@" "$1"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *.cc | *.CC | *.cxx | *.CXX | *.[cC]++)
+ func_file_conv "$1"
+ set x "$@" -Tp"$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *.c | *.cpp | *.CPP | *.lib | *.LIB | *.Lib | *.OBJ | *.obj | *.[oO])
+ func_file_conv "$1" mingw
+ set x "$@" "$file"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set x "$@" "$1"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ shift
+ done
+ if test -n "$linker_opts"; then
+ linker_opts="-link$linker_opts"
+ fi
+ exec "$@" $linker_opts
+ exit 1
+}
+
+eat=
+
case $1 in
'')
- echo "$0: No command. Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
+ echo "$0: No command. Try '$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
exit 1;
;;
-h | --h*)
cat <<\EOF
Usage: compile [--help] [--version] PROGRAM [ARGS]
-Wrapper for compilers which do not understand `-c -o'.
-Remove `-o dest.o' from ARGS, run PROGRAM with the remaining
+Wrapper for compilers which do not understand '-c -o'.
+Remove '-o dest.o' from ARGS, run PROGRAM with the remaining
arguments, and rename the output as expected.
If you are trying to build a whole package this is not the
-right script to run: please start by reading the file `INSTALL'.
+right script to run: please start by reading the file 'INSTALL'.
Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>.
EOF
@@ -53,11 +255,13 @@ EOF
echo "compile $scriptversion"
exit $?
;;
+ cl | *[/\\]cl | cl.exe | *[/\\]cl.exe )
+ func_cl_wrapper "$@" # Doesn't return...
+ ;;
esac
ofile=
cfile=
-eat=
for arg
do
@@ -66,8 +270,8 @@ do
else
case $1 in
-o)
- # configure might choose to run compile as `compile cc -o foo foo.c'.
- # So we strip `-o arg' only if arg is an object.
+ # configure might choose to run compile as 'compile cc -o foo foo.c'.
+ # So we strip '-o arg' only if arg is an object.
eat=1
case $2 in
*.o | *.obj)
@@ -94,22 +298,22 @@ do
done
if test -z "$ofile" || test -z "$cfile"; then
- # If no `-o' option was seen then we might have been invoked from a
+ # If no '-o' option was seen then we might have been invoked from a
# pattern rule where we don't need one. That is ok -- this is a
# normal compilation that the losing compiler can handle. If no
- # `.c' file was seen then we are probably linking. That is also
+ # '.c' file was seen then we are probably linking. That is also
# ok.
exec "$@"
fi
# Name of file we expect compiler to create.
-cofile=`echo "$cfile" | sed -e 's|^.*/||' -e 's/\.c$/.o/'`
+cofile=`echo "$cfile" | sed 's|^.*[\\/]||; s|^[a-zA-Z]:||; s/\.c$/.o/'`
# Create the lock directory.
-# Note: use `[/.-]' here to ensure that we don't use the same name
+# Note: use '[/\\:.-]' here to ensure that we don't use the same name
# that we are using for the .o file. Also, base the name on the expected
# object file name, since that is what matters with a parallel build.
-lockdir=`echo "$cofile" | sed -e 's|[/.-]|_|g'`.d
+lockdir=`echo "$cofile" | sed -e 's|[/\\:.-]|_|g'`.d
while true; do
if mkdir "$lockdir" >/dev/null 2>&1; then
break
@@ -124,9 +328,9 @@ trap "rmdir '$lockdir'; exit 1" 1 2 15
ret=$?
if test -f "$cofile"; then
- mv "$cofile" "$ofile"
+ test "$cofile" = "$ofile" || mv "$cofile" "$ofile"
elif test -f "${cofile}bj"; then
- mv "${cofile}bj" "$ofile"
+ test "${cofile}bj" = "$ofile" || mv "${cofile}bj" "$ofile"
fi
rmdir "$lockdir"
@@ -138,5 +342,6 @@ exit $ret
# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/config.guess b/build-aux/config.guess
index 0f0fe71..dcd5149 100755
--- a/build-aux/config.guess
+++ b/build-aux/config.guess
@@ -1,14 +1,12 @@
#! /bin/sh
# Attempt to guess a canonical system name.
-# Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
-# 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation,
-# Inc.
+# Copyright 1992-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-timestamp='2007-03-06'
+timestamp='2016-01-01'
# This file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
# under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
# (at your option) any later version.
#
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
@@ -17,26 +15,22 @@ timestamp='2007-03-06'
# General Public License for more details.
#
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
-# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
-# 02110-1301, USA.
+# along with this program; if not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
#
# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
-# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
-
-
-# Originally written by Per Bothner <per@bothner.com>.
-# Please send patches to <config-patches@gnu.org>. Submit a context
-# diff and a properly formatted ChangeLog entry.
+# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that
+# program. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
+# of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
#
-# This script attempts to guess a canonical system name similar to
-# config.sub. If it succeeds, it prints the system name on stdout, and
-# exits with 0. Otherwise, it exits with 1.
+# Originally written by Per Bothner; maintained since 2000 by Ben Elliston.
#
-# The plan is that this can be called by configure scripts if you
-# don't specify an explicit build system type.
+# You can get the latest version of this script from:
+# http://git.savannah.gnu.org/gitweb/?p=config.git;a=blob_plain;f=config.guess
+#
+# Please send patches to <config-patches@gnu.org>.
+
me=`echo "$0" | sed -e 's,.*/,,'`
@@ -56,8 +50,7 @@ version="\
GNU config.guess ($timestamp)
Originally written by Per Bothner.
-Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
-Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+Copyright 1992-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This is free software; see the source for copying conditions. There is NO
warranty; not even for MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE."
@@ -139,12 +132,33 @@ UNAME_RELEASE=`(uname -r) 2>/dev/null` || UNAME_RELEASE=unknown
UNAME_SYSTEM=`(uname -s) 2>/dev/null` || UNAME_SYSTEM=unknown
UNAME_VERSION=`(uname -v) 2>/dev/null` || UNAME_VERSION=unknown
+case "${UNAME_SYSTEM}" in
+Linux|GNU|GNU/*)
+ # If the system lacks a compiler, then just pick glibc.
+ # We could probably try harder.
+ LIBC=gnu
+
+ eval $set_cc_for_build
+ cat <<-EOF > $dummy.c
+ #include <features.h>
+ #if defined(__UCLIBC__)
+ LIBC=uclibc
+ #elif defined(__dietlibc__)
+ LIBC=dietlibc
+ #else
+ LIBC=gnu
+ #endif
+ EOF
+ eval `$CC_FOR_BUILD -E $dummy.c 2>/dev/null | grep '^LIBC' | sed 's, ,,g'`
+ ;;
+esac
+
# Note: order is significant - the case branches are not exclusive.
case "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" in
*:NetBSD:*:*)
# NetBSD (nbsd) targets should (where applicable) match one or
- # more of the tupples: *-*-netbsdelf*, *-*-netbsdaout*,
+ # more of the tuples: *-*-netbsdelf*, *-*-netbsdaout*,
# *-*-netbsdecoff* and *-*-netbsd*. For targets that recently
# switched to ELF, *-*-netbsd* would select the old
# object file format. This provides both forward
@@ -154,23 +168,30 @@ case "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" in
# Note: NetBSD doesn't particularly care about the vendor
# portion of the name. We always set it to "unknown".
sysctl="sysctl -n hw.machine_arch"
- UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH=`(/sbin/$sysctl 2>/dev/null || \
- /usr/sbin/$sysctl 2>/dev/null || echo unknown)`
+ UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH=`(uname -p 2>/dev/null || \
+ /sbin/$sysctl 2>/dev/null || \
+ /usr/sbin/$sysctl 2>/dev/null || \
+ echo unknown)`
case "${UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH}" in
armeb) machine=armeb-unknown ;;
arm*) machine=arm-unknown ;;
sh3el) machine=shl-unknown ;;
sh3eb) machine=sh-unknown ;;
sh5el) machine=sh5le-unknown ;;
+ earmv*)
+ arch=`echo ${UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH} | sed -e 's,^e\(armv[0-9]\).*$,\1,'`
+ endian=`echo ${UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH} | sed -ne 's,^.*\(eb\)$,\1,p'`
+ machine=${arch}${endian}-unknown
+ ;;
*) machine=${UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH}-unknown ;;
esac
# The Operating System including object format, if it has switched
# to ELF recently, or will in the future.
case "${UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH}" in
- arm*|i386|m68k|ns32k|sh3*|sparc|vax)
+ arm*|earm*|i386|m68k|ns32k|sh3*|sparc|vax)
eval $set_cc_for_build
if echo __ELF__ | $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null \
- | grep __ELF__ >/dev/null
+ | grep -q __ELF__
then
# Once all utilities can be ECOFF (netbsdecoff) or a.out (netbsdaout).
# Return netbsd for either. FIX?
@@ -180,7 +201,14 @@ case "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" in
fi
;;
*)
- os=netbsd
+ os=netbsd
+ ;;
+ esac
+ # Determine ABI tags.
+ case "${UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH}" in
+ earm*)
+ expr='s/^earmv[0-9]/-eabi/;s/eb$//'
+ abi=`echo ${UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH} | sed -e "$expr"`
;;
esac
# The OS release
@@ -193,13 +221,17 @@ case "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" in
release='-gnu'
;;
*)
- release=`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-_].*/\./'`
+ release=`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE} | sed -e 's/[-_].*//' | cut -d. -f1,2`
;;
esac
# Since CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-KERNEL-OPERATING_SYSTEM:
# contains redundant information, the shorter form:
# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-OPERATING_SYSTEM is used.
- echo "${machine}-${os}${release}"
+ echo "${machine}-${os}${release}${abi}"
+ exit ;;
+ *:Bitrig:*:*)
+ UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH=`arch | sed 's/Bitrig.//'`
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH}-unknown-bitrig${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
*:OpenBSD:*:*)
UNAME_MACHINE_ARCH=`arch | sed 's/OpenBSD.//'`
@@ -217,13 +249,16 @@ case "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" in
*:MirBSD:*:*)
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-mirbsd${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
+ *:Sortix:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-sortix
+ exit ;;
alpha:OSF1:*:*)
case $UNAME_RELEASE in
*4.0)
UNAME_RELEASE=`/usr/sbin/sizer -v | awk '{print $3}'`
;;
*5.*)
- UNAME_RELEASE=`/usr/sbin/sizer -v | awk '{print $4}'`
+ UNAME_RELEASE=`/usr/sbin/sizer -v | awk '{print $4}'`
;;
esac
# According to Compaq, /usr/sbin/psrinfo has been available on
@@ -269,7 +304,10 @@ case "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" in
# A Xn.n version is an unreleased experimental baselevel.
# 1.2 uses "1.2" for uname -r.
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-dec-osf`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE} | sed -e 's/^[PVTX]//' | tr 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz'`
- exit ;;
+ # Reset EXIT trap before exiting to avoid spurious non-zero exit code.
+ exitcode=$?
+ trap '' 0
+ exit $exitcode ;;
Alpha\ *:Windows_NT*:*)
# How do we know it's Interix rather than the generic POSIX subsystem?
# Should we change UNAME_MACHINE based on the output of uname instead
@@ -295,12 +333,12 @@ case "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" in
echo s390-ibm-zvmoe
exit ;;
*:OS400:*:*)
- echo powerpc-ibm-os400
+ echo powerpc-ibm-os400
exit ;;
arm:RISC*:1.[012]*:*|arm:riscix:1.[012]*:*)
echo arm-acorn-riscix${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
- arm:riscos:*:*|arm:RISCOS:*:*)
+ arm*:riscos:*:*|arm*:RISCOS:*:*)
echo arm-unknown-riscos
exit ;;
SR2?01:HI-UX/MPP:*:* | SR8000:HI-UX/MPP:*:*)
@@ -324,14 +362,33 @@ case "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" in
case `/usr/bin/uname -p` in
sparc) echo sparc-icl-nx7; exit ;;
esac ;;
+ s390x:SunOS:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-ibm-solaris2`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
+ exit ;;
sun4H:SunOS:5.*:*)
echo sparc-hal-solaris2`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
exit ;;
sun4*:SunOS:5.*:* | tadpole*:SunOS:5.*:*)
echo sparc-sun-solaris2`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
exit ;;
- i86pc:SunOS:5.*:*)
- echo i386-pc-solaris2`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
+ i86pc:AuroraUX:5.*:* | i86xen:AuroraUX:5.*:*)
+ echo i386-pc-auroraux${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ exit ;;
+ i86pc:SunOS:5.*:* | i86xen:SunOS:5.*:*)
+ eval $set_cc_for_build
+ SUN_ARCH="i386"
+ # If there is a compiler, see if it is configured for 64-bit objects.
+ # Note that the Sun cc does not turn __LP64__ into 1 like gcc does.
+ # This test works for both compilers.
+ if [ "$CC_FOR_BUILD" != 'no_compiler_found' ]; then
+ if (echo '#ifdef __amd64'; echo IS_64BIT_ARCH; echo '#endif') | \
+ (CCOPTS= $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null) | \
+ grep IS_64BIT_ARCH >/dev/null
+ then
+ SUN_ARCH="x86_64"
+ fi
+ fi
+ echo ${SUN_ARCH}-pc-solaris2`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[^.]*//'`
exit ;;
sun4*:SunOS:6*:*)
# According to config.sub, this is the proper way to canonicalize
@@ -375,23 +432,23 @@ case "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" in
# MiNT. But MiNT is downward compatible to TOS, so this should
# be no problem.
atarist[e]:*MiNT:*:* | atarist[e]:*mint:*:* | atarist[e]:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-atari-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ echo m68k-atari-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
atari*:*MiNT:*:* | atari*:*mint:*:* | atarist[e]:*TOS:*:*)
echo m68k-atari-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
- exit ;;
+ exit ;;
*falcon*:*MiNT:*:* | *falcon*:*mint:*:* | *falcon*:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-atari-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ echo m68k-atari-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
milan*:*MiNT:*:* | milan*:*mint:*:* | *milan*:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-milan-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
- exit ;;
+ echo m68k-milan-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ exit ;;
hades*:*MiNT:*:* | hades*:*mint:*:* | *hades*:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-hades-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
- exit ;;
+ echo m68k-hades-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ exit ;;
*:*MiNT:*:* | *:*mint:*:* | *:*TOS:*:*)
- echo m68k-unknown-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
- exit ;;
+ echo m68k-unknown-mint${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ exit ;;
m68k:machten:*:*)
echo m68k-apple-machten${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
@@ -461,8 +518,8 @@ EOF
echo m88k-motorola-sysv3
exit ;;
AViiON:dgux:*:*)
- # DG/UX returns AViiON for all architectures
- UNAME_PROCESSOR=`/usr/bin/uname -p`
+ # DG/UX returns AViiON for all architectures
+ UNAME_PROCESSOR=`/usr/bin/uname -p`
if [ $UNAME_PROCESSOR = mc88100 ] || [ $UNAME_PROCESSOR = mc88110 ]
then
if [ ${TARGET_BINARY_INTERFACE}x = m88kdguxelfx ] || \
@@ -475,7 +532,7 @@ EOF
else
echo i586-dg-dgux${UNAME_RELEASE}
fi
- exit ;;
+ exit ;;
M88*:DolphinOS:*:*) # DolphinOS (SVR3)
echo m88k-dolphin-sysv3
exit ;;
@@ -532,15 +589,16 @@ EOF
echo rs6000-ibm-aix3.2
fi
exit ;;
- *:AIX:*:[45])
+ *:AIX:*:[4567])
IBM_CPU_ID=`/usr/sbin/lsdev -C -c processor -S available | sed 1q | awk '{ print $1 }'`
if /usr/sbin/lsattr -El ${IBM_CPU_ID} | grep ' POWER' >/dev/null 2>&1; then
IBM_ARCH=rs6000
else
IBM_ARCH=powerpc
fi
- if [ -x /usr/bin/oslevel ] ; then
- IBM_REV=`/usr/bin/oslevel`
+ if [ -x /usr/bin/lslpp ] ; then
+ IBM_REV=`/usr/bin/lslpp -Lqc bos.rte.libc |
+ awk -F: '{ print $3 }' | sed s/[0-9]*$/0/`
else
IBM_REV=${UNAME_VERSION}.${UNAME_RELEASE}
fi
@@ -575,52 +633,52 @@ EOF
9000/[678][0-9][0-9])
if [ -x /usr/bin/getconf ]; then
sc_cpu_version=`/usr/bin/getconf SC_CPU_VERSION 2>/dev/null`
- sc_kernel_bits=`/usr/bin/getconf SC_KERNEL_BITS 2>/dev/null`
- case "${sc_cpu_version}" in
- 523) HP_ARCH="hppa1.0" ;; # CPU_PA_RISC1_0
- 528) HP_ARCH="hppa1.1" ;; # CPU_PA_RISC1_1
- 532) # CPU_PA_RISC2_0
- case "${sc_kernel_bits}" in
- 32) HP_ARCH="hppa2.0n" ;;
- 64) HP_ARCH="hppa2.0w" ;;
+ sc_kernel_bits=`/usr/bin/getconf SC_KERNEL_BITS 2>/dev/null`
+ case "${sc_cpu_version}" in
+ 523) HP_ARCH="hppa1.0" ;; # CPU_PA_RISC1_0
+ 528) HP_ARCH="hppa1.1" ;; # CPU_PA_RISC1_1
+ 532) # CPU_PA_RISC2_0
+ case "${sc_kernel_bits}" in
+ 32) HP_ARCH="hppa2.0n" ;;
+ 64) HP_ARCH="hppa2.0w" ;;
'') HP_ARCH="hppa2.0" ;; # HP-UX 10.20
- esac ;;
- esac
+ esac ;;
+ esac
fi
if [ "${HP_ARCH}" = "" ]; then
eval $set_cc_for_build
- sed 's/^ //' << EOF >$dummy.c
+ sed 's/^ //' << EOF >$dummy.c
- #define _HPUX_SOURCE
- #include <stdlib.h>
- #include <unistd.h>
+ #define _HPUX_SOURCE
+ #include <stdlib.h>
+ #include <unistd.h>
- int main ()
- {
- #if defined(_SC_KERNEL_BITS)
- long bits = sysconf(_SC_KERNEL_BITS);
- #endif
- long cpu = sysconf (_SC_CPU_VERSION);
+ int main ()
+ {
+ #if defined(_SC_KERNEL_BITS)
+ long bits = sysconf(_SC_KERNEL_BITS);
+ #endif
+ long cpu = sysconf (_SC_CPU_VERSION);
- switch (cpu)
- {
- case CPU_PA_RISC1_0: puts ("hppa1.0"); break;
- case CPU_PA_RISC1_1: puts ("hppa1.1"); break;
- case CPU_PA_RISC2_0:
- #if defined(_SC_KERNEL_BITS)
- switch (bits)
- {
- case 64: puts ("hppa2.0w"); break;
- case 32: puts ("hppa2.0n"); break;
- default: puts ("hppa2.0"); break;
- } break;
- #else /* !defined(_SC_KERNEL_BITS) */
- puts ("hppa2.0"); break;
- #endif
- default: puts ("hppa1.0"); break;
- }
- exit (0);
- }
+ switch (cpu)
+ {
+ case CPU_PA_RISC1_0: puts ("hppa1.0"); break;
+ case CPU_PA_RISC1_1: puts ("hppa1.1"); break;
+ case CPU_PA_RISC2_0:
+ #if defined(_SC_KERNEL_BITS)
+ switch (bits)
+ {
+ case 64: puts ("hppa2.0w"); break;
+ case 32: puts ("hppa2.0n"); break;
+ default: puts ("hppa2.0"); break;
+ } break;
+ #else /* !defined(_SC_KERNEL_BITS) */
+ puts ("hppa2.0"); break;
+ #endif
+ default: puts ("hppa1.0"); break;
+ }
+ exit (0);
+ }
EOF
(CCOPTS= $CC_FOR_BUILD -o $dummy $dummy.c 2>/dev/null) && HP_ARCH=`$dummy`
test -z "$HP_ARCH" && HP_ARCH=hppa
@@ -640,7 +698,7 @@ EOF
# => hppa64-hp-hpux11.23
if echo __LP64__ | (CCOPTS= $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null) |
- grep __LP64__ >/dev/null
+ grep -q __LP64__
then
HP_ARCH="hppa2.0w"
else
@@ -711,22 +769,22 @@ EOF
exit ;;
C1*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C1*:*)
echo c1-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
+ exit ;;
C2*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C2*:*)
if getsysinfo -f scalar_acc
then echo c32-convex-bsd
else echo c2-convex-bsd
fi
- exit ;;
+ exit ;;
C34*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C34*:*)
echo c34-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
+ exit ;;
C38*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C38*:*)
echo c38-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
+ exit ;;
C4*:ConvexOS:*:* | convex:ConvexOS:C4*:*)
echo c4-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
+ exit ;;
CRAY*Y-MP:*:*:*)
echo ymp-cray-unicos${UNAME_RELEASE} | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$/.X/'
exit ;;
@@ -750,14 +808,14 @@ EOF
exit ;;
F30[01]:UNIX_System_V:*:* | F700:UNIX_System_V:*:*)
FUJITSU_PROC=`uname -m | tr 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz'`
- FUJITSU_SYS=`uname -p | tr 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz' | sed -e 's/\///'`
- FUJITSU_REL=`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE} | sed -e 's/ /_/'`
- echo "${FUJITSU_PROC}-fujitsu-${FUJITSU_SYS}${FUJITSU_REL}"
- exit ;;
+ FUJITSU_SYS=`uname -p | tr 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz' | sed -e 's/\///'`
+ FUJITSU_REL=`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE} | sed -e 's/ /_/'`
+ echo "${FUJITSU_PROC}-fujitsu-${FUJITSU_SYS}${FUJITSU_REL}"
+ exit ;;
5000:UNIX_System_V:4.*:*)
- FUJITSU_SYS=`uname -p | tr 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz' | sed -e 's/\///'`
- FUJITSU_REL=`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE} | tr 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz' | sed -e 's/ /_/'`
- echo "sparc-fujitsu-${FUJITSU_SYS}${FUJITSU_REL}"
+ FUJITSU_SYS=`uname -p | tr 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz' | sed -e 's/\///'`
+ FUJITSU_REL=`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE} | tr 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz' | sed -e 's/ /_/'`
+ echo "sparc-fujitsu-${FUJITSU_SYS}${FUJITSU_REL}"
exit ;;
i*86:BSD/386:*:* | i*86:BSD/OS:*:* | *:Ascend\ Embedded/OS:*:*)
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-bsdi${UNAME_RELEASE}
@@ -769,40 +827,51 @@ EOF
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-bsdi${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
*:FreeBSD:*:*)
- case ${UNAME_MACHINE} in
- pc98)
- echo i386-unknown-freebsd`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'` ;;
+ UNAME_PROCESSOR=`/usr/bin/uname -p`
+ case ${UNAME_PROCESSOR} in
amd64)
echo x86_64-unknown-freebsd`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'` ;;
*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-freebsd`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'` ;;
+ echo ${UNAME_PROCESSOR}-unknown-freebsd`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'` ;;
esac
exit ;;
i*:CYGWIN*:*)
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-cygwin
exit ;;
+ *:MINGW64*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-mingw64
+ exit ;;
*:MINGW*:*)
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-mingw32
exit ;;
+ *:MSYS*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-msys
+ exit ;;
i*:windows32*:*)
- # uname -m includes "-pc" on this system.
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-mingw32
+ # uname -m includes "-pc" on this system.
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-mingw32
exit ;;
i*:PW*:*)
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-pw32
exit ;;
- *:Interix*:[3456]*)
- case ${UNAME_MACHINE} in
- x86)
+ *:Interix*:*)
+ case ${UNAME_MACHINE} in
+ x86)
echo i586-pc-interix${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
- EM64T | authenticamd)
+ authenticamd | genuineintel | EM64T)
echo x86_64-unknown-interix${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
+ IA64)
+ echo ia64-unknown-interix${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ exit ;;
esac ;;
[345]86:Windows_95:* | [345]86:Windows_98:* | [345]86:Windows_NT:*)
echo i${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-mks
exit ;;
+ 8664:Windows_NT:*)
+ echo x86_64-pc-mks
+ exit ;;
i*:Windows_NT*:* | Pentium*:Windows_NT*:*)
# How do we know it's Interix rather than the generic POSIX subsystem?
# It also conflicts with pre-2.0 versions of AT&T UWIN. Should we
@@ -823,203 +892,163 @@ EOF
exit ;;
*:GNU:*:*)
# the GNU system
- echo `echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}|sed -e 's,[-/].*$,,'`-unknown-gnu`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's,/.*$,,'`
+ echo `echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}|sed -e 's,[-/].*$,,'`-unknown-${LIBC}`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's,/.*$,,'`
exit ;;
*:GNU/*:*:*)
# other systems with GNU libc and userland
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-`echo ${UNAME_SYSTEM} | sed 's,^[^/]*/,,' | tr '[A-Z]' '[a-z]'``echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-`echo ${UNAME_SYSTEM} | sed 's,^[^/]*/,,' | tr '[A-Z]' '[a-z]'``echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`-${LIBC}
exit ;;
i*86:Minix:*:*)
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-minix
exit ;;
+ aarch64:Linux:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ aarch64_be:Linux:*:*)
+ UNAME_MACHINE=aarch64_be
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ alpha:Linux:*:*)
+ case `sed -n '/^cpu model/s/^.*: \(.*\)/\1/p' < /proc/cpuinfo` in
+ EV5) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev5 ;;
+ EV56) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev56 ;;
+ PCA56) UNAME_MACHINE=alphapca56 ;;
+ PCA57) UNAME_MACHINE=alphapca56 ;;
+ EV6) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev6 ;;
+ EV67) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev67 ;;
+ EV68*) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev68 ;;
+ esac
+ objdump --private-headers /bin/sh | grep -q ld.so.1
+ if test "$?" = 0 ; then LIBC="gnulibc1" ; fi
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ arc:Linux:*:* | arceb:Linux:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
arm*:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-gnu
+ eval $set_cc_for_build
+ if echo __ARM_EABI__ | $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null \
+ | grep -q __ARM_EABI__
+ then
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ else
+ if echo __ARM_PCS_VFP | $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null \
+ | grep -q __ARM_PCS_VFP
+ then
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}eabi
+ else
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}eabihf
+ fi
+ fi
exit ;;
avr32*:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
cris:Linux:*:*)
- echo cris-axis-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-axis-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
crisv32:Linux:*:*)
- echo crisv32-axis-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-axis-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ e2k:Linux:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
frv:Linux:*:*)
- echo frv-unknown-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ hexagon:Linux:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ i*86:Linux:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
ia64:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ k1om:Linux:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
m32r*:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
m68*:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
- mips:Linux:*:*)
+ mips:Linux:*:* | mips64:Linux:*:*)
eval $set_cc_for_build
sed 's/^ //' << EOF >$dummy.c
#undef CPU
- #undef mips
- #undef mipsel
+ #undef ${UNAME_MACHINE}
+ #undef ${UNAME_MACHINE}el
#if defined(__MIPSEL__) || defined(__MIPSEL) || defined(_MIPSEL) || defined(MIPSEL)
- CPU=mipsel
+ CPU=${UNAME_MACHINE}el
#else
#if defined(__MIPSEB__) || defined(__MIPSEB) || defined(_MIPSEB) || defined(MIPSEB)
- CPU=mips
+ CPU=${UNAME_MACHINE}
#else
CPU=
#endif
#endif
EOF
- eval "`$CC_FOR_BUILD -E $dummy.c 2>/dev/null | sed -n '
- /^CPU/{
- s: ::g
- p
- }'`"
- test x"${CPU}" != x && { echo "${CPU}-unknown-linux-gnu"; exit; }
+ eval `$CC_FOR_BUILD -E $dummy.c 2>/dev/null | grep '^CPU'`
+ test x"${CPU}" != x && { echo "${CPU}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}"; exit; }
;;
- mips64:Linux:*:*)
- eval $set_cc_for_build
- sed 's/^ //' << EOF >$dummy.c
- #undef CPU
- #undef mips64
- #undef mips64el
- #if defined(__MIPSEL__) || defined(__MIPSEL) || defined(_MIPSEL) || defined(MIPSEL)
- CPU=mips64el
- #else
- #if defined(__MIPSEB__) || defined(__MIPSEB) || defined(_MIPSEB) || defined(MIPSEB)
- CPU=mips64
- #else
- CPU=
- #endif
- #endif
-EOF
- eval "`$CC_FOR_BUILD -E $dummy.c 2>/dev/null | sed -n '
- /^CPU/{
- s: ::g
- p
- }'`"
- test x"${CPU}" != x && { echo "${CPU}-unknown-linux-gnu"; exit; }
- ;;
- or32:Linux:*:*)
- echo or32-unknown-linux-gnu
+ openrisc*:Linux:*:*)
+ echo or1k-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
- ppc:Linux:*:*)
- echo powerpc-unknown-linux-gnu
+ or32:Linux:*:* | or1k*:Linux:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
- ppc64:Linux:*:*)
- echo powerpc64-unknown-linux-gnu
+ padre:Linux:*:*)
+ echo sparc-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
- alpha:Linux:*:*)
- case `sed -n '/^cpu model/s/^.*: \(.*\)/\1/p' < /proc/cpuinfo` in
- EV5) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev5 ;;
- EV56) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev56 ;;
- PCA56) UNAME_MACHINE=alphapca56 ;;
- PCA57) UNAME_MACHINE=alphapca56 ;;
- EV6) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev6 ;;
- EV67) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev67 ;;
- EV68*) UNAME_MACHINE=alphaev68 ;;
- esac
- objdump --private-headers /bin/sh | grep ld.so.1 >/dev/null
- if test "$?" = 0 ; then LIBC="libc1" ; else LIBC="" ; fi
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-gnu${LIBC}
+ parisc64:Linux:*:* | hppa64:Linux:*:*)
+ echo hppa64-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
parisc:Linux:*:* | hppa:Linux:*:*)
# Look for CPU level
case `grep '^cpu[^a-z]*:' /proc/cpuinfo 2>/dev/null | cut -d' ' -f2` in
- PA7*) echo hppa1.1-unknown-linux-gnu ;;
- PA8*) echo hppa2.0-unknown-linux-gnu ;;
- *) echo hppa-unknown-linux-gnu ;;
+ PA7*) echo hppa1.1-unknown-linux-${LIBC} ;;
+ PA8*) echo hppa2.0-unknown-linux-${LIBC} ;;
+ *) echo hppa-unknown-linux-${LIBC} ;;
esac
exit ;;
- parisc64:Linux:*:* | hppa64:Linux:*:*)
- echo hppa64-unknown-linux-gnu
+ ppc64:Linux:*:*)
+ echo powerpc64-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ ppc:Linux:*:*)
+ echo powerpc-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ ppc64le:Linux:*:*)
+ echo powerpc64le-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ ppcle:Linux:*:*)
+ echo powerpcle-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
s390:Linux:*:* | s390x:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-ibm-linux
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-ibm-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
sh64*:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
sh*:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
sparc:Linux:*:* | sparc64:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
+ exit ;;
+ tile*:Linux:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
vax:Linux:*:*)
- echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-dec-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-dec-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
x86_64:Linux:*:*)
- echo x86_64-unknown-linux-gnu
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
- xtensa:Linux:*:*)
- echo xtensa-unknown-linux-gnu
+ xtensa*:Linux:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-linux-${LIBC}
exit ;;
- i*86:Linux:*:*)
- # The BFD linker knows what the default object file format is, so
- # first see if it will tell us. cd to the root directory to prevent
- # problems with other programs or directories called `ld' in the path.
- # Set LC_ALL=C to ensure ld outputs messages in English.
- ld_supported_targets=`cd /; LC_ALL=C ld --help 2>&1 \
- | sed -ne '/supported targets:/!d
- s/[ ][ ]*/ /g
- s/.*supported targets: *//
- s/ .*//
- p'`
- case "$ld_supported_targets" in
- elf32-i386)
- TENTATIVE="${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-linux-gnu"
- ;;
- a.out-i386-linux)
- echo "${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-linux-gnuaout"
- exit ;;
- coff-i386)
- echo "${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-linux-gnucoff"
- exit ;;
- "")
- # Either a pre-BFD a.out linker (linux-gnuoldld) or
- # one that does not give us useful --help.
- echo "${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-linux-gnuoldld"
- exit ;;
- esac
- # Determine whether the default compiler is a.out or elf
- eval $set_cc_for_build
- sed 's/^ //' << EOF >$dummy.c
- #include <features.h>
- #ifdef __ELF__
- # ifdef __GLIBC__
- # if __GLIBC__ >= 2
- LIBC=gnu
- # else
- LIBC=gnulibc1
- # endif
- # else
- LIBC=gnulibc1
- # endif
- #else
- #if defined(__INTEL_COMPILER) || defined(__PGI) || defined(__SUNPRO_C) || defined(__SUNPRO_CC)
- LIBC=gnu
- #else
- LIBC=gnuaout
- #endif
- #endif
- #ifdef __dietlibc__
- LIBC=dietlibc
- #endif
-EOF
- eval "`$CC_FOR_BUILD -E $dummy.c 2>/dev/null | sed -n '
- /^LIBC/{
- s: ::g
- p
- }'`"
- test x"${LIBC}" != x && {
- echo "${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-linux-${LIBC}"
- exit
- }
- test x"${TENTATIVE}" != x && { echo "${TENTATIVE}"; exit; }
- ;;
i*86:DYNIX/ptx:4*:*)
# ptx 4.0 does uname -s correctly, with DYNIX/ptx in there.
# earlier versions are messed up and put the nodename in both
@@ -1027,11 +1056,11 @@ EOF
echo i386-sequent-sysv4
exit ;;
i*86:UNIX_SV:4.2MP:2.*)
- # Unixware is an offshoot of SVR4, but it has its own version
- # number series starting with 2...
- # I am not positive that other SVR4 systems won't match this,
+ # Unixware is an offshoot of SVR4, but it has its own version
+ # number series starting with 2...
+ # I am not positive that other SVR4 systems won't match this,
# I just have to hope. -- rms.
- # Use sysv4.2uw... so that sysv4* matches it.
+ # Use sysv4.2uw... so that sysv4* matches it.
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-sysv4.2uw${UNAME_VERSION}
exit ;;
i*86:OS/2:*:*)
@@ -1048,7 +1077,7 @@ EOF
i*86:syllable:*:*)
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-syllable
exit ;;
- i*86:LynxOS:2.*:* | i*86:LynxOS:3.[01]*:* | i*86:LynxOS:4.0*:*)
+ i*86:LynxOS:2.*:* | i*86:LynxOS:3.[01]*:* | i*86:LynxOS:4.[02]*:*)
echo i386-unknown-lynxos${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
i*86:*DOS:*:*)
@@ -1063,7 +1092,7 @@ EOF
fi
exit ;;
i*86:*:5:[678]*)
- # UnixWare 7.x, OpenUNIX and OpenServer 6.
+ # UnixWare 7.x, OpenUNIX and OpenServer 6.
case `/bin/uname -X | grep "^Machine"` in
*486*) UNAME_MACHINE=i486 ;;
*Pentium) UNAME_MACHINE=i586 ;;
@@ -1091,10 +1120,13 @@ EOF
exit ;;
pc:*:*:*)
# Left here for compatibility:
- # uname -m prints for DJGPP always 'pc', but it prints nothing about
- # the processor, so we play safe by assuming i386.
- echo i386-pc-msdosdjgpp
- exit ;;
+ # uname -m prints for DJGPP always 'pc', but it prints nothing about
+ # the processor, so we play safe by assuming i586.
+ # Note: whatever this is, it MUST be the same as what config.sub
+ # prints for the "djgpp" host, or else GDB configure will decide that
+ # this is a cross-build.
+ echo i586-pc-msdosdjgpp
+ exit ;;
Intel:Mach:3*:*)
echo i386-pc-mach3
exit ;;
@@ -1129,8 +1161,18 @@ EOF
/bin/uname -p 2>/dev/null | /bin/grep entium >/dev/null \
&& { echo i586-ncr-sysv4.3${OS_REL}; exit; } ;;
3[34]??:*:4.0:* | 3[34]??,*:*:4.0:*)
- /bin/uname -p 2>/dev/null | grep 86 >/dev/null \
- && { echo i486-ncr-sysv4; exit; } ;;
+ /bin/uname -p 2>/dev/null | grep 86 >/dev/null \
+ && { echo i486-ncr-sysv4; exit; } ;;
+ NCR*:*:4.2:* | MPRAS*:*:4.2:*)
+ OS_REL='.3'
+ test -r /etc/.relid \
+ && OS_REL=.`sed -n 's/[^ ]* [^ ]* \([0-9][0-9]\).*/\1/p' < /etc/.relid`
+ /bin/uname -p 2>/dev/null | grep 86 >/dev/null \
+ && { echo i486-ncr-sysv4.3${OS_REL}; exit; }
+ /bin/uname -p 2>/dev/null | /bin/grep entium >/dev/null \
+ && { echo i586-ncr-sysv4.3${OS_REL}; exit; }
+ /bin/uname -p 2>/dev/null | /bin/grep pteron >/dev/null \
+ && { echo i586-ncr-sysv4.3${OS_REL}; exit; } ;;
m68*:LynxOS:2.*:* | m68*:LynxOS:3.0*:*)
echo m68k-unknown-lynxos${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
@@ -1143,7 +1185,7 @@ EOF
rs6000:LynxOS:2.*:*)
echo rs6000-unknown-lynxos${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
- PowerPC:LynxOS:2.*:* | PowerPC:LynxOS:3.[01]*:* | PowerPC:LynxOS:4.0*:*)
+ PowerPC:LynxOS:2.*:* | PowerPC:LynxOS:3.[01]*:* | PowerPC:LynxOS:4.[02]*:*)
echo powerpc-unknown-lynxos${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
SM[BE]S:UNIX_SV:*:*)
@@ -1163,10 +1205,10 @@ EOF
echo ns32k-sni-sysv
fi
exit ;;
- PENTIUM:*:4.0*:*) # Unisys `ClearPath HMP IX 4000' SVR4/MP effort
- # says <Richard.M.Bartel@ccMail.Census.GOV>
- echo i586-unisys-sysv4
- exit ;;
+ PENTIUM:*:4.0*:*) # Unisys `ClearPath HMP IX 4000' SVR4/MP effort
+ # says <Richard.M.Bartel@ccMail.Census.GOV>
+ echo i586-unisys-sysv4
+ exit ;;
*:UNIX_System_V:4*:FTX*)
# From Gerald Hewes <hewes@openmarket.com>.
# How about differentiating between stratus architectures? -djm
@@ -1192,11 +1234,11 @@ EOF
exit ;;
R[34]000:*System_V*:*:* | R4000:UNIX_SYSV:*:* | R*000:UNIX_SV:*:*)
if [ -d /usr/nec ]; then
- echo mips-nec-sysv${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ echo mips-nec-sysv${UNAME_RELEASE}
else
- echo mips-unknown-sysv${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ echo mips-unknown-sysv${UNAME_RELEASE}
fi
- exit ;;
+ exit ;;
BeBox:BeOS:*:*) # BeOS running on hardware made by Be, PPC only.
echo powerpc-be-beos
exit ;;
@@ -1206,6 +1248,12 @@ EOF
BePC:BeOS:*:*) # BeOS running on Intel PC compatible.
echo i586-pc-beos
exit ;;
+ BePC:Haiku:*:*) # Haiku running on Intel PC compatible.
+ echo i586-pc-haiku
+ exit ;;
+ x86_64:Haiku:*:*)
+ echo x86_64-unknown-haiku
+ exit ;;
SX-4:SUPER-UX:*:*)
echo sx4-nec-superux${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
@@ -1232,9 +1280,31 @@ EOF
exit ;;
*:Darwin:*:*)
UNAME_PROCESSOR=`uname -p` || UNAME_PROCESSOR=unknown
- case $UNAME_PROCESSOR in
- unknown) UNAME_PROCESSOR=powerpc ;;
- esac
+ eval $set_cc_for_build
+ if test "$UNAME_PROCESSOR" = unknown ; then
+ UNAME_PROCESSOR=powerpc
+ fi
+ if test `echo "$UNAME_RELEASE" | sed -e 's/\..*//'` -le 10 ; then
+ if [ "$CC_FOR_BUILD" != 'no_compiler_found' ]; then
+ if (echo '#ifdef __LP64__'; echo IS_64BIT_ARCH; echo '#endif') | \
+ (CCOPTS= $CC_FOR_BUILD -E - 2>/dev/null) | \
+ grep IS_64BIT_ARCH >/dev/null
+ then
+ case $UNAME_PROCESSOR in
+ i386) UNAME_PROCESSOR=x86_64 ;;
+ powerpc) UNAME_PROCESSOR=powerpc64 ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ fi
+ elif test "$UNAME_PROCESSOR" = i386 ; then
+ # Avoid executing cc on OS X 10.9, as it ships with a stub
+ # that puts up a graphical alert prompting to install
+ # developer tools. Any system running Mac OS X 10.7 or
+ # later (Darwin 11 and later) is required to have a 64-bit
+ # processor. This is not true of the ARM version of Darwin
+ # that Apple uses in portable devices.
+ UNAME_PROCESSOR=x86_64
+ fi
echo ${UNAME_PROCESSOR}-apple-darwin${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
*:procnto*:*:* | *:QNX:[0123456789]*:*)
@@ -1248,7 +1318,10 @@ EOF
*:QNX:*:4*)
echo i386-pc-qnx
exit ;;
- NSE-?:NONSTOP_KERNEL:*:*)
+ NEO-?:NONSTOP_KERNEL:*:*)
+ echo neo-tandem-nsk${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ exit ;;
+ NSE-*:NONSTOP_KERNEL:*:*)
echo nse-tandem-nsk${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
NSR-?:NONSTOP_KERNEL:*:*)
@@ -1293,13 +1366,13 @@ EOF
echo pdp10-unknown-its
exit ;;
SEI:*:*:SEIUX)
- echo mips-sei-seiux${UNAME_RELEASE}
+ echo mips-sei-seiux${UNAME_RELEASE}
exit ;;
*:DragonFly:*:*)
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-dragonfly`echo ${UNAME_RELEASE}|sed -e 's/[-(].*//'`
exit ;;
*:*VMS:*:*)
- UNAME_MACHINE=`(uname -p) 2>/dev/null`
+ UNAME_MACHINE=`(uname -p) 2>/dev/null`
case "${UNAME_MACHINE}" in
A*) echo alpha-dec-vms ; exit ;;
I*) echo ia64-dec-vms ; exit ;;
@@ -1314,158 +1387,16 @@ EOF
i*86:rdos:*:*)
echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-rdos
exit ;;
-esac
-
-#echo '(No uname command or uname output not recognized.)' 1>&2
-#echo "${UNAME_MACHINE}:${UNAME_SYSTEM}:${UNAME_RELEASE}:${UNAME_VERSION}" 1>&2
-
-eval $set_cc_for_build
-cat >$dummy.c <<EOF
-#ifdef _SEQUENT_
-# include <sys/types.h>
-# include <sys/utsname.h>
-#endif
-main ()
-{
-#if defined (sony)
-#if defined (MIPSEB)
- /* BFD wants "bsd" instead of "newsos". Perhaps BFD should be changed,
- I don't know.... */
- printf ("mips-sony-bsd\n"); exit (0);
-#else
-#include <sys/param.h>
- printf ("m68k-sony-newsos%s\n",
-#ifdef NEWSOS4
- "4"
-#else
- ""
-#endif
- ); exit (0);
-#endif
-#endif
-
-#if defined (__arm) && defined (__acorn) && defined (__unix)
- printf ("arm-acorn-riscix\n"); exit (0);
-#endif
-
-#if defined (hp300) && !defined (hpux)
- printf ("m68k-hp-bsd\n"); exit (0);
-#endif
-
-#if defined (NeXT)
-#if !defined (__ARCHITECTURE__)
-#define __ARCHITECTURE__ "m68k"
-#endif
- int version;
- version=`(hostinfo | sed -n 's/.*NeXT Mach \([0-9]*\).*/\1/p') 2>/dev/null`;
- if (version < 4)
- printf ("%s-next-nextstep%d\n", __ARCHITECTURE__, version);
- else
- printf ("%s-next-openstep%d\n", __ARCHITECTURE__, version);
- exit (0);
-#endif
-
-#if defined (MULTIMAX) || defined (n16)
-#if defined (UMAXV)
- printf ("ns32k-encore-sysv\n"); exit (0);
-#else
-#if defined (CMU)
- printf ("ns32k-encore-mach\n"); exit (0);
-#else
- printf ("ns32k-encore-bsd\n"); exit (0);
-#endif
-#endif
-#endif
-
-#if defined (__386BSD__)
- printf ("i386-pc-bsd\n"); exit (0);
-#endif
-
-#if defined (sequent)
-#if defined (i386)
- printf ("i386-sequent-dynix\n"); exit (0);
-#endif
-#if defined (ns32000)
- printf ("ns32k-sequent-dynix\n"); exit (0);
-#endif
-#endif
-
-#if defined (_SEQUENT_)
- struct utsname un;
-
- uname(&un);
-
- if (strncmp(un.version, "V2", 2) == 0) {
- printf ("i386-sequent-ptx2\n"); exit (0);
- }
- if (strncmp(un.version, "V1", 2) == 0) { /* XXX is V1 correct? */
- printf ("i386-sequent-ptx1\n"); exit (0);
- }
- printf ("i386-sequent-ptx\n"); exit (0);
-
-#endif
-
-#if defined (vax)
-# if !defined (ultrix)
-# include <sys/param.h>
-# if defined (BSD)
-# if BSD == 43
- printf ("vax-dec-bsd4.3\n"); exit (0);
-# else
-# if BSD == 199006
- printf ("vax-dec-bsd4.3reno\n"); exit (0);
-# else
- printf ("vax-dec-bsd\n"); exit (0);
-# endif
-# endif
-# else
- printf ("vax-dec-bsd\n"); exit (0);
-# endif
-# else
- printf ("vax-dec-ultrix\n"); exit (0);
-# endif
-#endif
-
-#if defined (alliant) && defined (i860)
- printf ("i860-alliant-bsd\n"); exit (0);
-#endif
-
- exit (1);
-}
-EOF
-
-$CC_FOR_BUILD -o $dummy $dummy.c 2>/dev/null && SYSTEM_NAME=`$dummy` &&
- { echo "$SYSTEM_NAME"; exit; }
-
-# Apollos put the system type in the environment.
-
-test -d /usr/apollo && { echo ${ISP}-apollo-${SYSTYPE}; exit; }
-
-# Convex versions that predate uname can use getsysinfo(1)
-
-if [ -x /usr/convex/getsysinfo ]
-then
- case `getsysinfo -f cpu_type` in
- c1*)
- echo c1-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
- c2*)
- if getsysinfo -f scalar_acc
- then echo c32-convex-bsd
- else echo c2-convex-bsd
- fi
+ i*86:AROS:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-pc-aros
exit ;;
- c34*)
- echo c34-convex-bsd
- exit ;;
- c38*)
- echo c38-convex-bsd
+ x86_64:VMkernel:*:*)
+ echo ${UNAME_MACHINE}-unknown-esx
exit ;;
- c4*)
- echo c4-convex-bsd
+ amd64:Isilon\ OneFS:*:*)
+ echo x86_64-unknown-onefs
exit ;;
- esac
-fi
+esac
cat >&2 <<EOF
$0: unable to guess system type
@@ -1474,9 +1405,9 @@ This script, last modified $timestamp, has failed to recognize
the operating system you are using. It is advised that you
download the most up to date version of the config scripts from
- http://savannah.gnu.org/cgi-bin/viewcvs/*checkout*/config/config/config.guess
+ http://git.savannah.gnu.org/gitweb/?p=config.git;a=blob_plain;f=config.guess
and
- http://savannah.gnu.org/cgi-bin/viewcvs/*checkout*/config/config/config.sub
+ http://git.savannah.gnu.org/gitweb/?p=config.git;a=blob_plain;f=config.sub
If the version you run ($0) is already up to date, please
send the following data and any information you think might be
diff --git a/build-aux/config.rpath b/build-aux/config.rpath
index e082db6..98183ff 100755
--- a/build-aux/config.rpath
+++ b/build-aux/config.rpath
@@ -2,7 +2,7 @@
# Output a system dependent set of variables, describing how to set the
# run time search path of shared libraries in an executable.
#
-# Copyright 1996-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright 1996-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# Taken from GNU libtool, 2001
# Originally by Gordon Matzigkeit <gord@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996
#
@@ -25,7 +25,7 @@
# known workaround is to choose shorter directory names for the build
# directory and/or the installation directory.
-# All known linkers require a `.a' archive for static linking (except MSVC,
+# All known linkers require a '.a' archive for static linking (except MSVC,
# which needs '.lib').
libext=a
shrext=.so
@@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ for cc_temp in $CC""; do
done
cc_basename=`echo "$cc_temp" | sed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
-# Code taken from libtool.m4's AC_LIBTOOL_PROG_COMPILER_PIC.
+# Code taken from libtool.m4's _LT_COMPILER_PIC.
wl=
if test "$GCC" = yes; then
@@ -57,14 +57,7 @@ else
aix*)
wl='-Wl,'
;;
- darwin*)
- case $cc_basename in
- xlc*)
- wl='-Wl,'
- ;;
- esac
- ;;
- mingw* | pw32* | os2*)
+ mingw* | cygwin* | pw32* | os2* | cegcc*)
;;
hpux9* | hpux10* | hpux11*)
wl='-Wl,'
@@ -72,24 +65,37 @@ else
irix5* | irix6* | nonstopux*)
wl='-Wl,'
;;
- newsos6)
- ;;
- linux*)
+ linux* | k*bsd*-gnu | kopensolaris*-gnu)
case $cc_basename in
- icc* | ecc*)
+ ecc*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ icc* | ifort*)
wl='-Wl,'
;;
- pgcc | pgf77 | pgf90)
+ lf95*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ nagfor*)
+ wl='-Wl,-Wl,,'
+ ;;
+ pgcc* | pgf77* | pgf90* | pgf95* | pgfortran*)
wl='-Wl,'
;;
ccc*)
wl='-Wl,'
;;
+ xl* | bgxl* | bgf* | mpixl*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
como)
wl='-lopt='
;;
*)
case `$CC -V 2>&1 | sed 5q` in
+ *Sun\ F* | *Sun*Fortran*)
+ wl=
+ ;;
*Sun\ C*)
wl='-Wl,'
;;
@@ -97,22 +103,36 @@ else
;;
esac
;;
+ newsos6)
+ ;;
+ *nto* | *qnx*)
+ ;;
osf3* | osf4* | osf5*)
wl='-Wl,'
;;
- sco3.2v5*)
+ rdos*)
;;
solaris*)
- wl='-Wl,'
+ case $cc_basename in
+ f77* | f90* | f95* | sunf77* | sunf90* | sunf95*)
+ wl='-Qoption ld '
+ ;;
+ *)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ esac
;;
sunos4*)
wl='-Qoption ld '
;;
- sysv4 | sysv4.2uw2* | sysv4.3* | sysv5*)
+ sysv4 | sysv4.2uw2* | sysv4.3*)
wl='-Wl,'
;;
sysv4*MP*)
;;
+ sysv5* | unixware* | sco3.2v5* | sco5v6* | OpenUNIX*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
unicos*)
wl='-Wl,'
;;
@@ -121,7 +141,7 @@ else
esac
fi
-# Code taken from libtool.m4's AC_LIBTOOL_PROG_LD_SHLIBS.
+# Code taken from libtool.m4's _LT_LINKER_SHLIBS.
hardcode_libdir_flag_spec=
hardcode_libdir_separator=
@@ -129,7 +149,7 @@ hardcode_direct=no
hardcode_minus_L=no
case "$host_os" in
- cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
+ cygwin* | mingw* | pw32* | cegcc*)
# FIXME: the MSVC++ port hasn't been tested in a loooong time
# When not using gcc, we currently assume that we are using
# Microsoft Visual C++.
@@ -155,22 +175,21 @@ if test "$with_gnu_ld" = yes; then
# option of GNU ld is called -rpath, not --rpath.
hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
case "$host_os" in
- aix3* | aix4* | aix5*)
+ aix[3-9]*)
# On AIX/PPC, the GNU linker is very broken
if test "$host_cpu" != ia64; then
ld_shlibs=no
fi
;;
amigaos*)
- hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
- hardcode_minus_L=yes
- # Samuel A. Falvo II <kc5tja@dolphin.openprojects.net> reports
- # that the semantics of dynamic libraries on AmigaOS, at least up
- # to version 4, is to share data among multiple programs linked
- # with the same dynamic library. Since this doesn't match the
- # behavior of shared libraries on other platforms, we cannot use
- # them.
- ld_shlibs=no
+ case "$host_cpu" in
+ powerpc)
+ ;;
+ m68k)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ ;;
+ esac
;;
beos*)
if $LD --help 2>&1 | grep ': supported targets:.* elf' > /dev/null; then
@@ -179,7 +198,7 @@ if test "$with_gnu_ld" = yes; then
ld_shlibs=no
fi
;;
- cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
+ cygwin* | mingw* | pw32* | cegcc*)
# hardcode_libdir_flag_spec is actually meaningless, as there is
# no search path for DLLs.
hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
@@ -189,11 +208,13 @@ if test "$with_gnu_ld" = yes; then
ld_shlibs=no
fi
;;
- interix3*)
+ haiku*)
+ ;;
+ interix[3-9]*)
hardcode_direct=no
hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath,$libdir'
;;
- linux*)
+ gnu* | linux* | tpf* | k*bsd*-gnu | kopensolaris*-gnu)
if $LD --help 2>&1 | grep ': supported targets:.* elf' > /dev/null; then
:
else
@@ -251,7 +272,7 @@ else
hardcode_direct=unsupported
fi
;;
- aix4* | aix5*)
+ aix[4-9]*)
if test "$host_cpu" = ia64; then
# On IA64, the linker does run time linking by default, so we don't
# have to do anything special.
@@ -261,7 +282,7 @@ else
# Test if we are trying to use run time linking or normal
# AIX style linking. If -brtl is somewhere in LDFLAGS, we
# need to do runtime linking.
- case $host_os in aix4.[23]|aix4.[23].*|aix5*)
+ case $host_os in aix4.[23]|aix4.[23].*|aix[5-9]*)
for ld_flag in $LDFLAGS; do
if (test $ld_flag = "-brtl" || test $ld_flag = "-Wl,-brtl"); then
aix_use_runtimelinking=yes
@@ -280,7 +301,7 @@ else
strings "$collect2name" | grep resolve_lib_name >/dev/null
then
# We have reworked collect2
- hardcode_direct=yes
+ :
else
# We have old collect2
hardcode_direct=unsupported
@@ -316,14 +337,18 @@ else
fi
;;
amigaos*)
- hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
- hardcode_minus_L=yes
- # see comment about different semantics on the GNU ld section
- ld_shlibs=no
+ case "$host_cpu" in
+ powerpc)
+ ;;
+ m68k)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ ;;
+ esac
;;
bsdi[45]*)
;;
- cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
+ cygwin* | mingw* | pw32* | cegcc*)
# When not using gcc, we currently assume that we are using
# Microsoft Visual C++.
# hardcode_libdir_flag_spec is actually meaningless, as there is
@@ -333,33 +358,20 @@ else
;;
darwin* | rhapsody*)
hardcode_direct=no
- if test "$GCC" = yes ; then
+ if { case $cc_basename in ifort*) true;; *) test "$GCC" = yes;; esac; }; then
:
else
- case $cc_basename in
- xlc*)
- ;;
- *)
- ld_shlibs=no
- ;;
- esac
+ ld_shlibs=no
fi
;;
dgux*)
hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
;;
- freebsd1*)
- ld_shlibs=no
- ;;
- freebsd2.2*)
- hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
- hardcode_direct=yes
- ;;
- freebsd2*)
+ freebsd2.[01]*)
hardcode_direct=yes
hardcode_minus_L=yes
;;
- freebsd* | kfreebsd*-gnu | dragonfly*)
+ freebsd* | dragonfly*)
hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
hardcode_direct=yes
;;
@@ -411,19 +423,25 @@ else
hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
hardcode_libdir_separator=:
;;
+ *nto* | *qnx*)
+ ;;
openbsd*)
- hardcode_direct=yes
- if test -z "`echo __ELF__ | $CC -E - | grep __ELF__`" || test "$host_os-$host_cpu" = "openbsd2.8-powerpc"; then
- hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath,$libdir'
+ if test -f /usr/libexec/ld.so; then
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ if test -z "`echo __ELF__ | $CC -E - | grep __ELF__`" || test "$host_os-$host_cpu" = "openbsd2.8-powerpc"; then
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath,$libdir'
+ else
+ case "$host_os" in
+ openbsd[01].* | openbsd2.[0-7] | openbsd2.[0-7].*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
+ ;;
+ *)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath,$libdir'
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
else
- case "$host_os" in
- openbsd[01].* | openbsd2.[0-7] | openbsd2.[0-7].*)
- hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
- ;;
- *)
- hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath,$libdir'
- ;;
- esac
+ ld_shlibs=no
fi
;;
os2*)
@@ -471,7 +489,7 @@ else
ld_shlibs=yes
fi
;;
- sysv4*uw2* | sysv5OpenUNIX* | sysv5UnixWare7.[01].[10]* | unixware7*)
+ sysv4*uw2* | sysv5OpenUNIX* | sysv5UnixWare7.[01].[10]* | unixware7* | sco3.2v5.0.[024]*)
;;
sysv5* | sco3.2v5* | sco5v6*)
hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='`test -z "$SCOABSPATH" && echo ${wl}-R,$libdir`'
@@ -487,7 +505,7 @@ else
fi
# Check dynamic linker characteristics
-# Code taken from libtool.m4's AC_LIBTOOL_SYS_DYNAMIC_LINKER.
+# Code taken from libtool.m4's _LT_SYS_DYNAMIC_LINKER.
# Unlike libtool.m4, here we don't care about _all_ names of the library, but
# only about the one the linker finds when passed -lNAME. This is the last
# element of library_names_spec in libtool.m4, or possibly two of them if the
@@ -498,11 +516,16 @@ case "$host_os" in
aix3*)
library_names_spec='$libname.a'
;;
- aix4* | aix5*)
+ aix[4-9]*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
amigaos*)
- library_names_spec='$libname.a'
+ case "$host_cpu" in
+ powerpc*)
+ library_names_spec='$libname$shrext' ;;
+ m68k)
+ library_names_spec='$libname.a' ;;
+ esac
;;
beos*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
@@ -510,7 +533,7 @@ case "$host_os" in
bsdi[45]*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
- cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
+ cygwin* | mingw* | pw32* | cegcc*)
shrext=.dll
library_names_spec='$libname.dll.a $libname.lib'
;;
@@ -521,22 +544,18 @@ case "$host_os" in
dgux*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
- freebsd1*)
- ;;
- kfreebsd*-gnu)
- library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
+ freebsd[23].*)
+ library_names_spec='$libname$shrext$versuffix'
;;
freebsd* | dragonfly*)
- case "$host_os" in
- freebsd[123]*)
- library_names_spec='$libname$shrext$versuffix' ;;
- *)
- library_names_spec='$libname$shrext' ;;
- esac
+ library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
gnu*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
+ haiku*)
+ library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
+ ;;
hpux9* | hpux10* | hpux11*)
case $host_cpu in
ia64*)
@@ -551,7 +570,7 @@ case "$host_os" in
esac
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
- interix3*)
+ interix[3-9]*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
irix5* | irix6* | nonstopux*)
@@ -572,7 +591,7 @@ case "$host_os" in
;;
linux*oldld* | linux*aout* | linux*coff*)
;;
- linux*)
+ linux* | k*bsd*-gnu | kopensolaris*-gnu)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
knetbsd*-gnu)
@@ -584,7 +603,7 @@ case "$host_os" in
newsos6)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
- nto-qnx*)
+ *nto* | *qnx*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
openbsd*)
@@ -598,6 +617,8 @@ case "$host_os" in
osf3* | osf4* | osf5*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
+ rdos*)
+ ;;
solaris*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
@@ -613,6 +634,9 @@ case "$host_os" in
sysv5* | sco3.2v5* | sco5v6* | unixware* | OpenUNIX* | sysv4*uw2*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
+ tpf*)
+ library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
+ ;;
uts4*)
library_names_spec='$libname$shrext'
;;
diff --git a/build-aux/config.sub b/build-aux/config.sub
index 5defff6..da6d1b6 100755
--- a/build-aux/config.sub
+++ b/build-aux/config.sub
@@ -1,44 +1,40 @@
#! /bin/sh
# Configuration validation subroutine script.
-# Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
-# 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation,
-# Inc.
+# Copyright 1992-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-timestamp='2007-01-18'
+timestamp='2016-01-01'
-# This file is (in principle) common to ALL GNU software.
-# The presence of a machine in this file suggests that SOME GNU software
-# can handle that machine. It does not imply ALL GNU software can.
-#
-# This file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
+# This file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+# under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
# (at your option) any later version.
#
-# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-# GNU General Public License for more details.
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+# WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+# General Public License for more details.
#
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
-# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
-# 02110-1301, USA.
+# along with this program; if not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
#
# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
-# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
+# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that
+# program. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
+# of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
-# Please send patches to <config-patches@gnu.org>. Submit a context
-# diff and a properly formatted ChangeLog entry.
+# Please send patches to <config-patches@gnu.org>.
#
# Configuration subroutine to validate and canonicalize a configuration type.
# Supply the specified configuration type as an argument.
# If it is invalid, we print an error message on stderr and exit with code 1.
# Otherwise, we print the canonical config type on stdout and succeed.
+# You can get the latest version of this script from:
+# http://git.savannah.gnu.org/gitweb/?p=config.git;a=blob_plain;f=config.sub
+
# This file is supposed to be the same for all GNU packages
# and recognize all the CPU types, system types and aliases
# that are meaningful with *any* GNU software.
@@ -57,8 +53,7 @@ timestamp='2007-01-18'
me=`echo "$0" | sed -e 's,.*/,,'`
usage="\
-Usage: $0 [OPTION] CPU-MFR-OPSYS
- $0 [OPTION] ALIAS
+Usage: $0 [OPTION] CPU-MFR-OPSYS or ALIAS
Canonicalize a configuration name.
@@ -72,8 +67,7 @@ Report bugs and patches to <config-patches@gnu.org>."
version="\
GNU config.sub ($timestamp)
-Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
-Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+Copyright 1992-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This is free software; see the source for copying conditions. There is NO
warranty; not even for MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE."
@@ -120,12 +114,18 @@ esac
# Here we must recognize all the valid KERNEL-OS combinations.
maybe_os=`echo $1 | sed 's/^\(.*\)-\([^-]*-[^-]*\)$/\2/'`
case $maybe_os in
- nto-qnx* | linux-gnu* | linux-dietlibc | linux-newlib* | linux-uclibc* | \
- uclinux-uclibc* | uclinux-gnu* | kfreebsd*-gnu* | knetbsd*-gnu* | netbsd*-gnu* | \
+ nto-qnx* | linux-gnu* | linux-android* | linux-dietlibc | linux-newlib* | \
+ linux-musl* | linux-uclibc* | uclinux-uclibc* | uclinux-gnu* | kfreebsd*-gnu* | \
+ knetbsd*-gnu* | netbsd*-gnu* | netbsd*-eabi* | \
+ kopensolaris*-gnu* | \
storm-chaos* | os2-emx* | rtmk-nova*)
os=-$maybe_os
basic_machine=`echo $1 | sed 's/^\(.*\)-\([^-]*-[^-]*\)$/\1/'`
;;
+ android-linux)
+ os=-linux-android
+ basic_machine=`echo $1 | sed 's/^\(.*\)-\([^-]*-[^-]*\)$/\1/'`-unknown
+ ;;
*)
basic_machine=`echo $1 | sed 's/-[^-]*$//'`
if [ $basic_machine != $1 ]
@@ -148,10 +148,13 @@ case $os in
-convergent* | -ncr* | -news | -32* | -3600* | -3100* | -hitachi* |\
-c[123]* | -convex* | -sun | -crds | -omron* | -dg | -ultra | -tti* | \
-harris | -dolphin | -highlevel | -gould | -cbm | -ns | -masscomp | \
- -apple | -axis | -knuth | -cray)
+ -apple | -axis | -knuth | -cray | -microblaze*)
os=
basic_machine=$1
;;
+ -bluegene*)
+ os=-cnk
+ ;;
-sim | -cisco | -oki | -wec | -winbond)
os=
basic_machine=$1
@@ -166,10 +169,10 @@ case $os in
os=-chorusos
basic_machine=$1
;;
- -chorusrdb)
- os=-chorusrdb
+ -chorusrdb)
+ os=-chorusrdb
basic_machine=$1
- ;;
+ ;;
-hiux*)
os=-hiuxwe2
;;
@@ -214,6 +217,12 @@ case $os in
-isc*)
basic_machine=`echo $1 | sed -e 's/86-.*/86-pc/'`
;;
+ -lynx*178)
+ os=-lynxos178
+ ;;
+ -lynx*5)
+ os=-lynxos5
+ ;;
-lynx*)
os=-lynxos
;;
@@ -238,59 +247,91 @@ case $basic_machine in
# Some are omitted here because they have special meanings below.
1750a | 580 \
| a29k \
+ | aarch64 | aarch64_be \
| alpha | alphaev[4-8] | alphaev56 | alphaev6[78] | alphapca5[67] \
| alpha64 | alpha64ev[4-8] | alpha64ev56 | alpha64ev6[78] | alpha64pca5[67] \
| am33_2.0 \
- | arc | arm | arm[bl]e | arme[lb] | armv[2345] | armv[345][lb] | avr | avr32 \
+ | arc | arceb \
+ | arm | arm[bl]e | arme[lb] | armv[2-8] | armv[3-8][lb] | armv7[arm] \
+ | avr | avr32 \
+ | ba \
+ | be32 | be64 \
| bfin \
- | c4x | clipper \
+ | c4x | c8051 | clipper \
| d10v | d30v | dlx | dsp16xx \
- | fido | fr30 | frv \
+ | e2k | epiphany \
+ | fido | fr30 | frv | ft32 \
| h8300 | h8500 | hppa | hppa1.[01] | hppa2.0 | hppa2.0[nw] | hppa64 \
+ | hexagon \
| i370 | i860 | i960 | ia64 \
| ip2k | iq2000 \
+ | k1om \
+ | le32 | le64 \
+ | lm32 \
| m32c | m32r | m32rle | m68000 | m68k | m88k \
- | maxq | mb | microblaze | mcore | mep \
+ | maxq | mb | microblaze | microblazeel | mcore | mep | metag \
| mips | mipsbe | mipseb | mipsel | mipsle \
| mips16 \
| mips64 | mips64el \
- | mips64vr | mips64vrel \
+ | mips64octeon | mips64octeonel \
| mips64orion | mips64orionel \
+ | mips64r5900 | mips64r5900el \
+ | mips64vr | mips64vrel \
| mips64vr4100 | mips64vr4100el \
| mips64vr4300 | mips64vr4300el \
| mips64vr5000 | mips64vr5000el \
| mips64vr5900 | mips64vr5900el \
| mipsisa32 | mipsisa32el \
| mipsisa32r2 | mipsisa32r2el \
+ | mipsisa32r6 | mipsisa32r6el \
| mipsisa64 | mipsisa64el \
| mipsisa64r2 | mipsisa64r2el \
+ | mipsisa64r6 | mipsisa64r6el \
| mipsisa64sb1 | mipsisa64sb1el \
| mipsisa64sr71k | mipsisa64sr71kel \
+ | mipsr5900 | mipsr5900el \
| mipstx39 | mipstx39el \
| mn10200 | mn10300 \
+ | moxie \
| mt \
| msp430 \
- | nios | nios2 \
+ | nds32 | nds32le | nds32be \
+ | nios | nios2 | nios2eb | nios2el \
| ns16k | ns32k \
- | or32 \
+ | open8 | or1k | or1knd | or32 \
| pdp10 | pdp11 | pj | pjl \
- | powerpc | powerpc64 | powerpc64le | powerpcle | ppcbe \
+ | powerpc | powerpc64 | powerpc64le | powerpcle \
| pyramid \
+ | riscv32 | riscv64 \
+ | rl78 | rx \
| score \
- | sh | sh[1234] | sh[24]a | sh[23]e | sh[34]eb | sheb | shbe | shle | sh[1234]le | sh3ele \
+ | sh | sh[1234] | sh[24]a | sh[24]aeb | sh[23]e | sh[234]eb | sheb | shbe | shle | sh[1234]le | sh3ele \
| sh64 | sh64le \
| sparc | sparc64 | sparc64b | sparc64v | sparc86x | sparclet | sparclite \
| sparcv8 | sparcv9 | sparcv9b | sparcv9v \
- | spu | strongarm \
- | tahoe | thumb | tic4x | tic80 | tron \
- | v850 | v850e \
+ | spu \
+ | tahoe | tic4x | tic54x | tic55x | tic6x | tic80 | tron \
+ | ubicom32 \
+ | v850 | v850e | v850e1 | v850e2 | v850es | v850e2v3 \
+ | visium \
| we32k \
- | x86 | xc16x | xscale | xscalee[bl] | xstormy16 | xtensa \
- | z8k)
+ | x86 | xc16x | xstormy16 | xtensa \
+ | z8k | z80)
basic_machine=$basic_machine-unknown
;;
- m6811 | m68hc11 | m6812 | m68hc12)
- # Motorola 68HC11/12.
+ c54x)
+ basic_machine=tic54x-unknown
+ ;;
+ c55x)
+ basic_machine=tic55x-unknown
+ ;;
+ c6x)
+ basic_machine=tic6x-unknown
+ ;;
+ leon|leon[3-9])
+ basic_machine=sparc-$basic_machine
+ ;;
+ m6811 | m68hc11 | m6812 | m68hc12 | m68hcs12x | nvptx | picochip)
basic_machine=$basic_machine-unknown
os=-none
;;
@@ -300,6 +341,21 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=mt-unknown
;;
+ strongarm | thumb | xscale)
+ basic_machine=arm-unknown
+ ;;
+ xgate)
+ basic_machine=$basic_machine-unknown
+ os=-none
+ ;;
+ xscaleeb)
+ basic_machine=armeb-unknown
+ ;;
+
+ xscaleel)
+ basic_machine=armel-unknown
+ ;;
+
# We use `pc' rather than `unknown'
# because (1) that's what they normally are, and
# (2) the word "unknown" tends to confuse beginning users.
@@ -314,64 +370,89 @@ case $basic_machine in
# Recognize the basic CPU types with company name.
580-* \
| a29k-* \
+ | aarch64-* | aarch64_be-* \
| alpha-* | alphaev[4-8]-* | alphaev56-* | alphaev6[78]-* \
| alpha64-* | alpha64ev[4-8]-* | alpha64ev56-* | alpha64ev6[78]-* \
- | alphapca5[67]-* | alpha64pca5[67]-* | arc-* \
+ | alphapca5[67]-* | alpha64pca5[67]-* | arc-* | arceb-* \
| arm-* | armbe-* | armle-* | armeb-* | armv*-* \
| avr-* | avr32-* \
+ | ba-* \
+ | be32-* | be64-* \
| bfin-* | bs2000-* \
- | c[123]* | c30-* | [cjt]90-* | c4x-* | c54x-* | c55x-* | c6x-* \
- | clipper-* | craynv-* | cydra-* \
+ | c[123]* | c30-* | [cjt]90-* | c4x-* \
+ | c8051-* | clipper-* | craynv-* | cydra-* \
| d10v-* | d30v-* | dlx-* \
- | elxsi-* \
+ | e2k-* | elxsi-* \
| f30[01]-* | f700-* | fido-* | fr30-* | frv-* | fx80-* \
| h8300-* | h8500-* \
| hppa-* | hppa1.[01]-* | hppa2.0-* | hppa2.0[nw]-* | hppa64-* \
+ | hexagon-* \
| i*86-* | i860-* | i960-* | ia64-* \
| ip2k-* | iq2000-* \
+ | k1om-* \
+ | le32-* | le64-* \
+ | lm32-* \
| m32c-* | m32r-* | m32rle-* \
| m68000-* | m680[012346]0-* | m68360-* | m683?2-* | m68k-* \
- | m88110-* | m88k-* | maxq-* | mcore-* \
+ | m88110-* | m88k-* | maxq-* | mcore-* | metag-* \
+ | microblaze-* | microblazeel-* \
| mips-* | mipsbe-* | mipseb-* | mipsel-* | mipsle-* \
| mips16-* \
| mips64-* | mips64el-* \
- | mips64vr-* | mips64vrel-* \
+ | mips64octeon-* | mips64octeonel-* \
| mips64orion-* | mips64orionel-* \
+ | mips64r5900-* | mips64r5900el-* \
+ | mips64vr-* | mips64vrel-* \
| mips64vr4100-* | mips64vr4100el-* \
| mips64vr4300-* | mips64vr4300el-* \
| mips64vr5000-* | mips64vr5000el-* \
| mips64vr5900-* | mips64vr5900el-* \
| mipsisa32-* | mipsisa32el-* \
| mipsisa32r2-* | mipsisa32r2el-* \
+ | mipsisa32r6-* | mipsisa32r6el-* \
| mipsisa64-* | mipsisa64el-* \
| mipsisa64r2-* | mipsisa64r2el-* \
+ | mipsisa64r6-* | mipsisa64r6el-* \
| mipsisa64sb1-* | mipsisa64sb1el-* \
| mipsisa64sr71k-* | mipsisa64sr71kel-* \
+ | mipsr5900-* | mipsr5900el-* \
| mipstx39-* | mipstx39el-* \
| mmix-* \
| mt-* \
| msp430-* \
- | nios-* | nios2-* \
+ | nds32-* | nds32le-* | nds32be-* \
+ | nios-* | nios2-* | nios2eb-* | nios2el-* \
| none-* | np1-* | ns16k-* | ns32k-* \
+ | open8-* \
+ | or1k*-* \
| orion-* \
| pdp10-* | pdp11-* | pj-* | pjl-* | pn-* | power-* \
- | powerpc-* | powerpc64-* | powerpc64le-* | powerpcle-* | ppcbe-* \
+ | powerpc-* | powerpc64-* | powerpc64le-* | powerpcle-* \
| pyramid-* \
- | romp-* | rs6000-* \
- | sh-* | sh[1234]-* | sh[24]a-* | sh[23]e-* | sh[34]eb-* | sheb-* | shbe-* \
+ | riscv32-* | riscv64-* \
+ | rl78-* | romp-* | rs6000-* | rx-* \
+ | sh-* | sh[1234]-* | sh[24]a-* | sh[24]aeb-* | sh[23]e-* | sh[34]eb-* | sheb-* | shbe-* \
| shle-* | sh[1234]le-* | sh3ele-* | sh64-* | sh64le-* \
| sparc-* | sparc64-* | sparc64b-* | sparc64v-* | sparc86x-* | sparclet-* \
| sparclite-* \
- | sparcv8-* | sparcv9-* | sparcv9b-* | sparcv9v-* | strongarm-* | sv1-* | sx?-* \
- | tahoe-* | thumb-* \
+ | sparcv8-* | sparcv9-* | sparcv9b-* | sparcv9v-* | sv1-* | sx*-* \
+ | tahoe-* \
| tic30-* | tic4x-* | tic54x-* | tic55x-* | tic6x-* | tic80-* \
+ | tile*-* \
| tron-* \
- | v850-* | v850e-* | vax-* \
+ | ubicom32-* \
+ | v850-* | v850e-* | v850e1-* | v850es-* | v850e2-* | v850e2v3-* \
+ | vax-* \
+ | visium-* \
| we32k-* \
- | x86-* | x86_64-* | xc16x-* | xps100-* | xscale-* | xscalee[bl]-* \
- | xstormy16-* | xtensa-* \
+ | x86-* | x86_64-* | xc16x-* | xps100-* \
+ | xstormy16-* | xtensa*-* \
| ymp-* \
- | z8k-*)
+ | z8k-* | z80-*)
+ ;;
+ # Recognize the basic CPU types without company name, with glob match.
+ xtensa*)
+ basic_machine=$basic_machine-unknown
;;
# Recognize the various machine names and aliases which stand
# for a CPU type and a company and sometimes even an OS.
@@ -389,7 +470,7 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=a29k-amd
os=-udi
;;
- abacus)
+ abacus)
basic_machine=abacus-unknown
;;
adobe68k)
@@ -435,6 +516,13 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=m68k-apollo
os=-bsd
;;
+ aros)
+ basic_machine=i386-pc
+ os=-aros
+ ;;
+ asmjs)
+ basic_machine=asmjs-unknown
+ ;;
aux)
basic_machine=m68k-apple
os=-aux
@@ -443,10 +531,35 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=ns32k-sequent
os=-dynix
;;
+ blackfin)
+ basic_machine=bfin-unknown
+ os=-linux
+ ;;
+ blackfin-*)
+ basic_machine=bfin-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^[^-]*-//'`
+ os=-linux
+ ;;
+ bluegene*)
+ basic_machine=powerpc-ibm
+ os=-cnk
+ ;;
+ c54x-*)
+ basic_machine=tic54x-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^[^-]*-//'`
+ ;;
+ c55x-*)
+ basic_machine=tic55x-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^[^-]*-//'`
+ ;;
+ c6x-*)
+ basic_machine=tic6x-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^[^-]*-//'`
+ ;;
c90)
basic_machine=c90-cray
os=-unicos
;;
+ cegcc)
+ basic_machine=arm-unknown
+ os=-cegcc
+ ;;
convex-c1)
basic_machine=c1-convex
os=-bsd
@@ -475,8 +588,8 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=craynv-cray
os=-unicosmp
;;
- cr16c)
- basic_machine=cr16c-unknown
+ cr16 | cr16-*)
+ basic_machine=cr16-unknown
os=-elf
;;
crds | unos)
@@ -514,6 +627,10 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=m88k-motorola
os=-sysv3
;;
+ dicos)
+ basic_machine=i686-pc
+ os=-dicos
+ ;;
djgpp)
basic_machine=i586-pc
os=-msdosdjgpp
@@ -629,7 +746,6 @@ case $basic_machine in
i370-ibm* | ibm*)
basic_machine=i370-ibm
;;
-# I'm not sure what "Sysv32" means. Should this be sysv3.2?
i*86v32)
basic_machine=`echo $1 | sed -e 's/86.*/86-pc/'`
os=-sysv32
@@ -668,6 +784,17 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=m68k-isi
os=-sysv
;;
+ leon-*|leon[3-9]-*)
+ basic_machine=sparc-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/-.*//'`
+ ;;
+ m68knommu)
+ basic_machine=m68k-unknown
+ os=-linux
+ ;;
+ m68knommu-*)
+ basic_machine=m68k-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^[^-]*-//'`
+ os=-linux
+ ;;
m88k-omron*)
basic_machine=m88k-omron
;;
@@ -679,10 +806,21 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=ns32k-utek
os=-sysv
;;
+ microblaze*)
+ basic_machine=microblaze-xilinx
+ ;;
+ mingw64)
+ basic_machine=x86_64-pc
+ os=-mingw64
+ ;;
mingw32)
- basic_machine=i386-pc
+ basic_machine=i686-pc
os=-mingw32
;;
+ mingw32ce)
+ basic_machine=arm-unknown
+ os=-mingw32ce
+ ;;
miniframe)
basic_machine=m68000-convergent
;;
@@ -704,6 +842,10 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=powerpc-unknown
os=-morphos
;;
+ moxiebox)
+ basic_machine=moxie-unknown
+ os=-moxiebox
+ ;;
msdos)
basic_machine=i386-pc
os=-msdos
@@ -711,10 +853,18 @@ case $basic_machine in
ms1-*)
basic_machine=`echo $basic_machine | sed -e 's/ms1-/mt-/'`
;;
+ msys)
+ basic_machine=i686-pc
+ os=-msys
+ ;;
mvs)
basic_machine=i370-ibm
os=-mvs
;;
+ nacl)
+ basic_machine=le32-unknown
+ os=-nacl
+ ;;
ncr3000)
basic_machine=i486-ncr
os=-sysv4
@@ -779,6 +929,12 @@ case $basic_machine in
np1)
basic_machine=np1-gould
;;
+ neo-tandem)
+ basic_machine=neo-tandem
+ ;;
+ nse-tandem)
+ basic_machine=nse-tandem
+ ;;
nsr-tandem)
basic_machine=nsr-tandem
;;
@@ -809,6 +965,14 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=i860-intel
os=-osf
;;
+ parisc)
+ basic_machine=hppa-unknown
+ os=-linux
+ ;;
+ parisc-*)
+ basic_machine=hppa-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^[^-]*-//'`
+ os=-linux
+ ;;
pbd)
basic_machine=sparc-tti
;;
@@ -853,9 +1017,10 @@ case $basic_machine in
;;
power) basic_machine=power-ibm
;;
- ppc) basic_machine=powerpc-unknown
+ ppc | ppcbe) basic_machine=powerpc-unknown
;;
- ppc-*) basic_machine=powerpc-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^[^-]*-//'`
+ ppc-* | ppcbe-*)
+ basic_machine=powerpc-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^[^-]*-//'`
;;
ppcle | powerpclittle | ppc-le | powerpc-little)
basic_machine=powerpcle-unknown
@@ -880,7 +1045,11 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=i586-unknown
os=-pw32
;;
- rdos)
+ rdos | rdos64)
+ basic_machine=x86_64-pc
+ os=-rdos
+ ;;
+ rdos32)
basic_machine=i386-pc
os=-rdos
;;
@@ -949,6 +1118,9 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=i860-stratus
os=-sysv4
;;
+ strongarm-* | thumb-*)
+ basic_machine=arm-`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^[^-]*-//'`
+ ;;
sun2)
basic_machine=m68000-sun
;;
@@ -1005,17 +1177,9 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=t90-cray
os=-unicos
;;
- tic54x | c54x*)
- basic_machine=tic54x-unknown
- os=-coff
- ;;
- tic55x | c55x*)
- basic_machine=tic55x-unknown
- os=-coff
- ;;
- tic6x | c6x*)
- basic_machine=tic6x-unknown
- os=-coff
+ tile*)
+ basic_machine=$basic_machine-unknown
+ os=-linux-gnu
;;
tx39)
basic_machine=mipstx39-unknown
@@ -1084,6 +1248,9 @@ case $basic_machine in
xps | xps100)
basic_machine=xps100-honeywell
;;
+ xscale-* | xscalee[bl]-*)
+ basic_machine=`echo $basic_machine | sed 's/^xscale/arm/'`
+ ;;
ymp)
basic_machine=ymp-cray
os=-unicos
@@ -1092,6 +1259,10 @@ case $basic_machine in
basic_machine=z8k-unknown
os=-sim
;;
+ z80-*-coff)
+ basic_machine=z80-unknown
+ os=-sim
+ ;;
none)
basic_machine=none-none
os=-none
@@ -1130,7 +1301,7 @@ case $basic_machine in
we32k)
basic_machine=we32k-att
;;
- sh[1234] | sh[24]a | sh[34]eb | sh[1234]le | sh[23]ele)
+ sh[1234] | sh[24]a | sh[24]aeb | sh[34]eb | sh[1234]le | sh[23]ele)
basic_machine=sh-unknown
;;
sparc | sparcv8 | sparcv9 | sparcv9b | sparcv9v)
@@ -1177,9 +1348,12 @@ esac
if [ x"$os" != x"" ]
then
case $os in
- # First match some system type aliases
- # that might get confused with valid system types.
+ # First match some system type aliases
+ # that might get confused with valid system types.
# -solaris* is a basic system type, with this one exception.
+ -auroraux)
+ os=-auroraux
+ ;;
-solaris1 | -solaris1.*)
os=`echo $os | sed -e 's|solaris1|sunos4|'`
;;
@@ -1200,29 +1374,32 @@ case $os in
# Each alternative MUST END IN A *, to match a version number.
# -sysv* is not here because it comes later, after sysvr4.
-gnu* | -bsd* | -mach* | -minix* | -genix* | -ultrix* | -irix* \
- | -*vms* | -sco* | -esix* | -isc* | -aix* | -sunos | -sunos[34]*\
- | -hpux* | -unos* | -osf* | -luna* | -dgux* | -solaris* | -sym* \
+ | -*vms* | -sco* | -esix* | -isc* | -aix* | -cnk* | -sunos | -sunos[34]*\
+ | -hpux* | -unos* | -osf* | -luna* | -dgux* | -auroraux* | -solaris* \
+ | -sym* | -kopensolaris* | -plan9* \
| -amigaos* | -amigados* | -msdos* | -newsos* | -unicos* | -aof* \
- | -aos* \
+ | -aos* | -aros* | -cloudabi* | -sortix* \
| -nindy* | -vxsim* | -vxworks* | -ebmon* | -hms* | -mvs* \
| -clix* | -riscos* | -uniplus* | -iris* | -rtu* | -xenix* \
| -hiux* | -386bsd* | -knetbsd* | -mirbsd* | -netbsd* \
- | -openbsd* | -solidbsd* \
+ | -bitrig* | -openbsd* | -solidbsd* \
| -ekkobsd* | -kfreebsd* | -freebsd* | -riscix* | -lynxos* \
| -bosx* | -nextstep* | -cxux* | -aout* | -elf* | -oabi* \
| -ptx* | -coff* | -ecoff* | -winnt* | -domain* | -vsta* \
| -udi* | -eabi* | -lites* | -ieee* | -go32* | -aux* \
- | -chorusos* | -chorusrdb* \
- | -cygwin* | -pe* | -psos* | -moss* | -proelf* | -rtems* \
- | -mingw32* | -linux-gnu* | -linux-newlib* | -linux-uclibc* \
- | -uxpv* | -beos* | -mpeix* | -udk* \
+ | -chorusos* | -chorusrdb* | -cegcc* \
+ | -cygwin* | -msys* | -pe* | -psos* | -moss* | -proelf* | -rtems* \
+ | -mingw32* | -mingw64* | -linux-gnu* | -linux-android* \
+ | -linux-newlib* | -linux-musl* | -linux-uclibc* \
+ | -uxpv* | -beos* | -mpeix* | -udk* | -moxiebox* \
| -interix* | -uwin* | -mks* | -rhapsody* | -darwin* | -opened* \
| -openstep* | -oskit* | -conix* | -pw32* | -nonstopux* \
| -storm-chaos* | -tops10* | -tenex* | -tops20* | -its* \
| -os2* | -vos* | -palmos* | -uclinux* | -nucleus* \
| -morphos* | -superux* | -rtmk* | -rtmk-nova* | -windiss* \
| -powermax* | -dnix* | -nx6 | -nx7 | -sei* | -dragonfly* \
- | -skyos* | -haiku* | -rdos* | -toppers* | -drops*)
+ | -skyos* | -haiku* | -rdos* | -toppers* | -drops* | -es* \
+ | -onefs* | -tirtos*)
# Remember, each alternative MUST END IN *, to match a version number.
;;
-qnx*)
@@ -1261,7 +1438,7 @@ case $os in
-opened*)
os=-openedition
;;
- -os400*)
+ -os400*)
os=-os400
;;
-wince*)
@@ -1310,7 +1487,7 @@ case $os in
-sinix*)
os=-sysv4
;;
- -tpf*)
+ -tpf*)
os=-tpf
;;
-triton*)
@@ -1346,12 +1523,14 @@ case $os in
-aros*)
os=-aros
;;
- -kaos*)
- os=-kaos
- ;;
-zvmoe)
os=-zvmoe
;;
+ -dicos*)
+ os=-dicos
+ ;;
+ -nacl*)
+ ;;
-none)
;;
*)
@@ -1374,10 +1553,10 @@ else
# system, and we'll never get to this point.
case $basic_machine in
- score-*)
+ score-*)
os=-elf
;;
- spu-*)
+ spu-*)
os=-elf
;;
*-acorn)
@@ -1389,8 +1568,23 @@ case $basic_machine in
arm*-semi)
os=-aout
;;
- c4x-* | tic4x-*)
- os=-coff
+ c4x-* | tic4x-*)
+ os=-coff
+ ;;
+ c8051-*)
+ os=-elf
+ ;;
+ hexagon-*)
+ os=-elf
+ ;;
+ tic54x-*)
+ os=-coff
+ ;;
+ tic55x-*)
+ os=-coff
+ ;;
+ tic6x-*)
+ os=-coff
;;
# This must come before the *-dec entry.
pdp10-*)
@@ -1410,14 +1604,11 @@ case $basic_machine in
;;
m68000-sun)
os=-sunos3
- # This also exists in the configure program, but was not the
- # default.
- # os=-sunos4
;;
m68*-cisco)
os=-aout
;;
- mep-*)
+ mep-*)
os=-elf
;;
mips*-cisco)
@@ -1444,7 +1635,7 @@ case $basic_machine in
*-ibm)
os=-aix
;;
- *-knuth)
+ *-knuth)
os=-mmixware
;;
*-wec)
@@ -1549,7 +1740,7 @@ case $basic_machine in
-sunos*)
vendor=sun
;;
- -aix*)
+ -cnk*|-aix*)
vendor=ibm
;;
-beos*)
diff --git a/build-aux/cvsu b/build-aux/cvsu
deleted file mode 100755
index 03e3d06..0000000
--- a/build-aux/cvsu
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,514 +0,0 @@
-#! /usr/bin/perl -w
-
-# cvsu - do a quick check to see what files are out of date.
-#
-# Copyright (C) 2000-2005 Pavel Roskin <proski@gnu.org>
-# Initially written by Tom Tromey <tromey@cygnus.com>
-# Completely rewritten by Pavel Roskin <proski@gnu.org>
-#
-# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-# any later version.
-#
-# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-# GNU General Public License for more details.
-#
-# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
-# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
-# 02111-1307, USA.
-
-
-require 5.004;
-use Getopt::Long;
-use File::Basename;
-use Time::Local;
-use strict;
-
-use vars qw($list_types %messages %options @batch_list $batch_cmd
- $no_recurse $explain_type $find_mode $short_print
- $no_cvsignore $nolinks $file $single_filename $curr_dir
- @common_ignores $ignore_rx %entries %subdirs %removed);
-
-use constant SUBDIR_FOUND => 1;
-use constant SUBDIR_CVS => 2;
-
-# This list comes from the CVS manual.
-use constant STANDARD_IGNORES =>
- ('RCS', 'SCCS', 'CVS', 'CVS.adm', 'RCSLOG', 'cvslog.*', 'tags',
- 'TAGS', '.make.state', '.nse_depinfo', '*~', '#*', '.#*', ',*',
- "_\$*", "*\$", '*.old', '*.bak', '*.BAK', '*.orig', '*.rej',
- '.del-*', '*.a', '*.olb', '*.o', '*.obj', '*.so', '*.exe',
- '*.Z', '*.elc', '*.ln', 'core');
-
-# 3-letter month names in POSIX locale, for fast date decoding
-my %months = (
- "Jan" => 0,
- "Feb" => 1,
- "Mar" => 2,
- "Apr" => 3,
- "May" => 4,
- "Jun" => 5,
- "Jul" => 6,
- "Aug" => 7,
- "Sep" => 8,
- "Oct" => 9,
- "Nov" => 10,
- "Dec" => 11
-);
-
-# print usage information and exit
-sub usage ()
-{
- print "Usage:\n" .
- " cvsu [OPTIONS] [FILE] ...\n" .
- "Options:\n" .
- " --local Disable recursion\n" .
- " --explain Verbosely print status of files\n" .
- " --find Emulate find - filenames only\n" .
- " --short Don't print paths\n" .
- " --ignore Don't read .cvsignore\n" .
- " --messages List known file types and long messages\n" .
- " --nolinks Disable recognizing hard and soft links\n" .
- " --types=[^]LIST Print only file types [not] from LIST\n" .
- " --batch=COMMAND Execute this command on files\n" .
- " --help Print this usage information\n" .
- " --version Print version number\n" .
- "Abbreviations and short options are supported\n";
- exit 0;
-}
-
-# print version information and exit
-sub version ()
-{
- print "cvsu - CVS offline examiner, version 0.2.3\n";
- exit 0;
-}
-
-# If types begin with '^', make inversion
-sub adjust_types ()
-{
- if ($list_types =~ m{^\^(.*)$}) {
- $list_types = "";
- foreach (keys %messages) {
- $list_types .= $_
- if (index ($1, $_) < 0);
- }
- }
-}
-
-# list known messages and exit
-sub list_messages ()
-{
- my $default_mark;
- print "Recognizable file types are:\n";
- foreach (sort keys %messages) {
- if (index($list_types, $_) >= 0) {
- $default_mark = "*";
- } else {
- $default_mark = " ";
- }
- print " $default_mark $_ $messages{$_}\n";
- }
- print "* indicates file types listed by default\n";
- exit 0;
-}
-
-# Initialize @common_ignores
-# Also read $HOME/.cvsignore and append it to @common_ignores
-sub init_ignores ()
-{
- my $HOME = $ENV{"HOME"};
-
- push @common_ignores, STANDARD_IGNORES;
-
- unless (defined($HOME)) {
- return;
- }
-
- my $home_cvsignore = "${HOME}/.cvsignore";
-
- if (-f "$home_cvsignore") {
-
- unless (open (CVSIGNORE, "< $home_cvsignore")) {
- error ("couldn't open $home_cvsignore: $!");
- }
-
- while (<CVSIGNORE>) {
- push (@common_ignores, split);
- }
-
- close (CVSIGNORE);
- }
-
- my $CVSIGNOREENV = $ENV{"CVSIGNORE"};
-
- unless (defined($CVSIGNOREENV)) {
- return;
- }
-
- my @ignores_var = split (/ /, $CVSIGNOREENV);
- push (@common_ignores, @ignores_var);
-
-}
-
-# Print message and exit (like "die", but without raising an exception).
-# Newline is added at the end.
-sub error ($)
-{
- print STDERR "cvsu: ERROR: " . shift(@_) . "\n";
- exit 1;
-}
-
-# execute commands from @exec_list with $exec_cmd
-sub do_batch ()
-{
- my @cmd_list = split (' ', $batch_cmd);
- system (@cmd_list, @batch_list);
-}
-
-# print files status
-# Parameter 1: status in one-letter representation
-sub file_status ($)
-{
- my $type = shift (@_);
- my $item;
- my $pathfile;
-
- return
- if $ignore_rx ne '' && $type =~ /[?SLD]/ && $file =~ /$ignore_rx/;
-
- return
- if (index($list_types, $type) < 0);
-
- $pathfile = $curr_dir . $file;
-
- if (defined($batch_cmd)) {
- push (@batch_list, $pathfile);
- # 1000 items in the command line might be too much for HP-UX
- if ($#batch_list > 1000) {
- do_batch();
- undef @batch_list;
- }
- }
-
- if ($short_print) {
- $item = $file;
- } else {
- $item = $pathfile;
- }
-
- if ($find_mode) {
- print "$item\n";
- } else {
- $type = $messages{$type}
- if ($explain_type);
- print "$type $item\n";
- }
-}
-
-# load entries from CVS/Entries and CVS/Entries.Log
-# Parameter 1: file name for CVS/Entries
-# Return: list of entries in the format used in CVS/Entries
-sub load_entries ($);
-sub load_entries ($)
-{
- my $entries_file = shift (@_);
- my $entries_log_file = "$entries_file.Log";
- my %ent = ();
-
- unless (open (ENTRIES, "< $entries_file")) {
- error ("couldn't open $entries_file: $!");
- }
- while (<ENTRIES>) {
- chomp;
- $ent{$_} = 1;
- }
- close (ENTRIES);
-
- if (open (ENTRIES, "< $entries_log_file")) {
- while (<ENTRIES>) {
- chomp;
- if ( m{^A (.+)} ) {
- $ent{$1} = 1;
- } elsif ( m{^R (.+)} ) {
- delete $ent{$1};
- } else {
- # Note: "cvs commit" helps even when you are offline
- error ("$entries_log_file:$.: unrecognizable line, " .
- "try \"cvs commit\"");
- }
- }
- close (ENTRIES);
- }
-
- return keys %ent;
-}
-
-# process one directory
-# Parameter 1: directory name
-sub process_arg ($);
-sub process_arg ($)
-{
- my $arg = shift (@_);
- my %found_files = ();
-
- # $file, $curr_dir, and $ignore_rx must be seen in file_status
- local $file = "";
- local $ignore_rx = "";
- local $single_filename = 0;
-
- if ( $arg eq "" or -d $arg ) {
- $curr_dir = $arg;
- my $real_curr_dir = $curr_dir eq "" ? "." : $curr_dir;
-
- error ("$real_curr_dir is not a directory")
- unless ( -d $real_curr_dir );
-
- # Scan present files.
- file_status (".");
- opendir (DIR, $real_curr_dir) ||
- error ("couldn't open directory $real_curr_dir: $!");
- foreach (readdir (DIR)) {
- $found_files {$_} = 1;
- }
- closedir (DIR);
- } else {
- $single_filename = basename $arg;
- $curr_dir = dirname $arg;
- $found_files{$single_filename} = 1 if lstat $arg;
- }
-
- $curr_dir .= "/"
- unless ( $curr_dir eq "" || $curr_dir =~ m{/$} );
-
- # Scan CVS/Entries.
- my %entries = ();
- my %subdirs = ();
- my %removed = ();
-
- foreach ( load_entries ("${curr_dir}CVS/Entries") ) {
- if ( m{^D/([^/]+)/} ) {
- $subdirs{$1} = SUBDIR_FOUND if !$single_filename;
- } elsif ( m{^/([^/]+)/([^/])[^/]*/([^/]*)/} ) {
- if ( !$single_filename or $single_filename eq $1 ) {
- $entries{$1} = $3;
- $removed{$1} = 1
- if $2 eq '-';
- }
- } elsif ( m{^D$} ) {
- next;
- } else {
- error ("${curr_dir}CVS/Entries: unrecognizable line");
- }
- }
-
- if ( $single_filename && !$entries{$single_filename} &&
- !$found_files{$single_filename} ) {
- error ("nothing known about $arg");
- }
-
- # Scan .cvsignore if any
- unless ($no_cvsignore) {
- my (@ignore_list) = ();
-
- if (-f "${curr_dir}.cvsignore") {
- open (CVSIGNORE, "< ${curr_dir}.cvsignore")
- || error ("couldn't open ${curr_dir}.cvsignore: $!");
- while (<CVSIGNORE>) {
- push (@ignore_list, split);
- }
- close (CVSIGNORE);
- }
-
- my ($iter);
- foreach $iter (@ignore_list, @common_ignores) {
- if ($iter eq '!') {
- $ignore_rx = ''
- } else {
- if ($ignore_rx eq '') {
- $ignore_rx = '^(';
- } else {
- $ignore_rx .= '|';
- }
- $ignore_rx .= glob_to_rx ($iter);
- }
- }
- $ignore_rx .= ')$'
- if $ignore_rx ne '';
- }
-
- # File is missing
- foreach $file (sort keys %entries) {
- unless ($found_files{$file}) {
- if ($removed{$file}) {
- file_status("R");
- } else {
- file_status("U");
- }
- }
- }
-
- foreach $file (sort keys %found_files) {
- next if ($file eq '.' || $file eq '..');
- lstat ($curr_dir . $file) ||
- error ("lstat() failed on $curr_dir . $file");
- if (! $nolinks && -l _) {
- file_status ("L");
- } elsif (-d _) {
- if ($file eq 'CVS') {
- file_status ("C");
- } elsif ($subdirs{$file}) {
- $subdirs{$file} = SUBDIR_CVS;
- } else {
- file_status ("D"); # Unknown directory
- }
- } elsif (! (-f _) && ! (-l _)) {
- file_status ("S"); # This must be something very special
- } elsif (! $nolinks && (stat _) [3] > 1 ) {
- file_status ("H"); # Hard link
- } elsif (! $entries{$file}) {
- file_status ("?");
- } elsif ($entries{$file} =~ /^Initial |^dummy /) {
- file_status ("A");
- } elsif ($entries{$file} =~ /^Result of merge/) {
- file_status ("G");
- } elsif ($entries{$file} !~
- /^(...) (...) (..) (..):(..):(..) (....)$/) {
- error ("Invalid timestamp for $curr_dir$file: $entries{$file}");
- } else {
- my $cvtime = timegm($6, $5, $4, $3, $months{$2}, $7 - 1900);
- my $mtime = (stat _) [9];
- if ($cvtime == $mtime) {
- file_status ("F");
- } elsif ($cvtime < $mtime) {
- file_status ("M");
- } else {
- file_status ("O");
- }
- }
- }
-
- # Now do directories.
- unless ($no_recurse) {
- my $save_curr_dir = $curr_dir;
- foreach $file (sort keys %subdirs) {
- if ($subdirs{$file} == SUBDIR_FOUND) {
- $curr_dir = $save_curr_dir;
- file_status ("X");
- } elsif ($subdirs{$file} == SUBDIR_CVS) {
- process_arg ($save_curr_dir . $file)
- }
- }
- }
-}
-
-# Turn a glob into a regexp without recognizing square brackets.
-sub glob_to_rx_simple ($)
-{
- my ($expr) = @_;
- # Quote all non-word characters, convert ? to . and * to .*
- $expr =~ s/(\W)/\\$1/g;
- $expr =~ s/\\\*/.*/g;
- $expr =~ s/\\\?/./g;
- return $expr;
-}
-
-# Turn a glob into a regexp
-sub glob_to_rx ($)
-{
- my $result = '';
- my ($expr) = @_;
- # Find parts in square brackets and copy them literally
- # Text outside brackets is processed by glob_to_rx_simple()
- while ($expr ne '') {
- if ($expr =~ /^(.*?)(\[.*?\])(.*)/) {
- $expr = $3;
- $result .= glob_to_rx_simple ($1) . $2;
- } else {
- $result .= glob_to_rx_simple ($expr);
- last;
- }
- }
- return $result;
-}
-
-sub Main ()
-{
- # types of files to be listed
- $list_types = "^.FCL";
-
- # long status messages
- %messages = (
- "?" => "Unlisted file",
- "." => "Known directory",
- "F" => "Up-to-date file",
- "C" => "CVS admin directory",
- "M" => "Modified file",
- "S" => "Special file",
- "D" => "Unlisted directory",
- "L" => "Symbolic link",
- "H" => "Hard link",
- "U" => "Lost file",
- "X" => "Lost directory",
- "A" => "Newly added",
- "O" => "Older copy",
- "G" => "Result of merge",
- "R" => "Removed file"
- );
-
- undef @batch_list; # List of files for batch processing
- undef $batch_cmd; # Command to be executed on files
- $no_recurse = 0; # If this is set, do only local files
- $explain_type = 0; # Verbosely print status of files
- $find_mode = 0; # Don't print status at all
- $short_print = 0; # Print only filenames without path
- $no_cvsignore = 0; # Ignore .cvsignore
- $nolinks = 0; # Do not test for soft- or hard-links
- my $want_msg = 0; # List possible filetypes and exit
- my $want_help = 0; # Print help and exit
- my $want_ver = 0; # Print version and exit
-
- my %options = (
- "types=s" => \$list_types,
- "batch=s" => \$batch_cmd,
- "local" => \$no_recurse,
- "explain" => \$explain_type,
- "find" => \$find_mode,
- "short" => \$short_print,
- "ignore" => \$no_cvsignore,
- "messages" => \$want_msg,
- "nolinks" => \$nolinks,
- "help" => \$want_help,
- "version" => \$want_ver
- );
-
- GetOptions(%options);
-
- adjust_types();
-
- list_messages() if $want_msg;
- usage() if $want_help;
- version() if $want_ver;
-
- unless ($no_cvsignore) {
- init_ignores();
- }
-
- if ($#ARGV < 0) {
- @ARGV = ("");
- }
-
- foreach (@ARGV) {
- process_arg ($_);
- }
-
- if ($#batch_list >= 0) {
- do_batch();
- }
-}
-
-Main();
diff --git a/build-aux/depcomp b/build-aux/depcomp
index ca5ea4e..28ce42a 100755
--- a/build-aux/depcomp
+++ b/build-aux/depcomp
@@ -1,10 +1,9 @@
#! /bin/sh
# depcomp - compile a program generating dependencies as side-effects
-scriptversion=2006-10-15.18
+scriptversion=2016-01-11.22; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software
-# Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 1999-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
@@ -17,9 +16,7 @@ scriptversion=2006-10-15.18
# GNU General Public License for more details.
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
-# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
-# 02110-1301, USA.
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
@@ -30,9 +27,9 @@ scriptversion=2006-10-15.18
case $1 in
'')
- echo "$0: No command. Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
- exit 1;
- ;;
+ echo "$0: No command. Try '$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
+ exit 1;
+ ;;
-h | --h*)
cat <<\EOF
Usage: depcomp [--help] [--version] PROGRAM [ARGS]
@@ -42,11 +39,11 @@ as side-effects.
Environment variables:
depmode Dependency tracking mode.
- source Source file read by `PROGRAMS ARGS'.
- object Object file output by `PROGRAMS ARGS'.
+ source Source file read by 'PROGRAMS ARGS'.
+ object Object file output by 'PROGRAMS ARGS'.
DEPDIR directory where to store dependencies.
depfile Dependency file to output.
- tmpdepfile Temporary file to use when outputing dependencies.
+ tmpdepfile Temporary file to use when outputting dependencies.
libtool Whether libtool is used (yes/no).
Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>.
@@ -59,6 +56,66 @@ EOF
;;
esac
+# Get the directory component of the given path, and save it in the
+# global variables '$dir'. Note that this directory component will
+# be either empty or ending with a '/' character. This is deliberate.
+set_dir_from ()
+{
+ case $1 in
+ */*) dir=`echo "$1" | sed -e 's|/[^/]*$|/|'`;;
+ *) dir=;;
+ esac
+}
+
+# Get the suffix-stripped basename of the given path, and save it the
+# global variable '$base'.
+set_base_from ()
+{
+ base=`echo "$1" | sed -e 's|^.*/||' -e 's/\.[^.]*$//'`
+}
+
+# If no dependency file was actually created by the compiler invocation,
+# we still have to create a dummy depfile, to avoid errors with the
+# Makefile "include basename.Plo" scheme.
+make_dummy_depfile ()
+{
+ echo "#dummy" > "$depfile"
+}
+
+# Factor out some common post-processing of the generated depfile.
+# Requires the auxiliary global variable '$tmpdepfile' to be set.
+aix_post_process_depfile ()
+{
+ # If the compiler actually managed to produce a dependency file,
+ # post-process it.
+ if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then
+ # Each line is of the form 'foo.o: dependency.h'.
+ # Do two passes, one to just change these to
+ # $object: dependency.h
+ # and one to simply output
+ # dependency.h:
+ # which is needed to avoid the deleted-header problem.
+ { sed -e "s,^.*\.[$lower]*:,$object:," < "$tmpdepfile"
+ sed -e "s,^.*\.[$lower]*:[$tab ]*,," -e 's,$,:,' < "$tmpdepfile"
+ } > "$depfile"
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ else
+ make_dummy_depfile
+ fi
+}
+
+# A tabulation character.
+tab=' '
+# A newline character.
+nl='
+'
+# Character ranges might be problematic outside the C locale.
+# These definitions help.
+upper=ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
+lower=abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
+digits=0123456789
+alpha=${upper}${lower}
+
if test -z "$depmode" || test -z "$source" || test -z "$object"; then
echo "depcomp: Variables source, object and depmode must be set" 1>&2
exit 1
@@ -71,6 +128,9 @@ tmpdepfile=${tmpdepfile-`echo "$depfile" | sed 's/\.\([^.]*\)$/.T\1/'`}
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+# Avoid interferences from the environment.
+gccflag= dashmflag=
+
# Some modes work just like other modes, but use different flags. We
# parameterize here, but still list the modes in the big case below,
# to make depend.m4 easier to write. Note that we *cannot* use a case
@@ -82,9 +142,32 @@ if test "$depmode" = hp; then
fi
if test "$depmode" = dashXmstdout; then
- # This is just like dashmstdout with a different argument.
- dashmflag=-xM
- depmode=dashmstdout
+ # This is just like dashmstdout with a different argument.
+ dashmflag=-xM
+ depmode=dashmstdout
+fi
+
+cygpath_u="cygpath -u -f -"
+if test "$depmode" = msvcmsys; then
+ # This is just like msvisualcpp but w/o cygpath translation.
+ # Just convert the backslash-escaped backslashes to single forward
+ # slashes to satisfy depend.m4
+ cygpath_u='sed s,\\\\,/,g'
+ depmode=msvisualcpp
+fi
+
+if test "$depmode" = msvc7msys; then
+ # This is just like msvc7 but w/o cygpath translation.
+ # Just convert the backslash-escaped backslashes to single forward
+ # slashes to satisfy depend.m4
+ cygpath_u='sed s,\\\\,/,g'
+ depmode=msvc7
+fi
+
+if test "$depmode" = xlc; then
+ # IBM C/C++ Compilers xlc/xlC can output gcc-like dependency information.
+ gccflag=-qmakedep=gcc,-MF
+ depmode=gcc
fi
case "$depmode" in
@@ -107,8 +190,7 @@ gcc3)
done
"$@"
stat=$?
- if test $stat -eq 0; then :
- else
+ if test $stat -ne 0; then
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
exit $stat
fi
@@ -116,13 +198,17 @@ gcc3)
;;
gcc)
+## Note that this doesn't just cater to obsosete pre-3.x GCC compilers.
+## but also to in-use compilers like IMB xlc/xlC and the HP C compiler.
+## (see the conditional assignment to $gccflag above).
## There are various ways to get dependency output from gcc. Here's
## why we pick this rather obscure method:
## - Don't want to use -MD because we'd like the dependencies to end
## up in a subdir. Having to rename by hand is ugly.
## (We might end up doing this anyway to support other compilers.)
## - The DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT environment variable makes gcc act like
-## -MM, not -M (despite what the docs say).
+## -MM, not -M (despite what the docs say). Also, it might not be
+## supported by the other compilers which use the 'gcc' depmode.
## - Using -M directly means running the compiler twice (even worse
## than renaming).
if test -z "$gccflag"; then
@@ -130,31 +216,31 @@ gcc)
fi
"$@" -Wp,"$gccflag$tmpdepfile"
stat=$?
- if test $stat -eq 0; then :
- else
+ if test $stat -ne 0; then
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
exit $stat
fi
rm -f "$depfile"
echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile"
- alpha=ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
-## The second -e expression handles DOS-style file names with drive letters.
+ # The second -e expression handles DOS-style file names with drive
+ # letters.
sed -e 's/^[^:]*: / /' \
-e 's/^['$alpha']:\/[^:]*: / /' < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
-## This next piece of magic avoids the `deleted header file' problem.
+## This next piece of magic avoids the "deleted header file" problem.
## The problem is that when a header file which appears in a .P file
## is deleted, the dependency causes make to die (because there is
## typically no way to rebuild the header). We avoid this by adding
## dummy dependencies for each header file. Too bad gcc doesn't do
## this for us directly.
- tr ' ' '
-' < "$tmpdepfile" |
-## Some versions of gcc put a space before the `:'. On the theory
+## Some versions of gcc put a space before the ':'. On the theory
## that the space means something, we add a space to the output as
-## well.
+## well. hp depmode also adds that space, but also prefixes the VPATH
+## to the object. Take care to not repeat it in the output.
## Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation
## correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
- sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
+ tr ' ' "$nl" < "$tmpdepfile" \
+ | sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e "s|.*$object$||" -e '/:$/d' \
+ | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
;;
@@ -165,115 +251,136 @@ hp)
exit 1
;;
-sgi)
- if test "$libtool" = yes; then
- "$@" "-Wp,-MDupdate,$tmpdepfile"
- else
- "$@" -MDupdate "$tmpdepfile"
- fi
- stat=$?
- if test $stat -eq 0; then :
- else
- rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
- exit $stat
- fi
- rm -f "$depfile"
-
- if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then # yes, the sourcefile depend on other files
- echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile"
-
- # Clip off the initial element (the dependent). Don't try to be
- # clever and replace this with sed code, as IRIX sed won't handle
- # lines with more than a fixed number of characters (4096 in
- # IRIX 6.2 sed, 8192 in IRIX 6.5). We also remove comment lines;
- # the IRIX cc adds comments like `#:fec' to the end of the
- # dependency line.
- tr ' ' '
-' < "$tmpdepfile" \
- | sed -e 's/^.*\.o://' -e 's/#.*$//' -e '/^$/ d' | \
- tr '
-' ' ' >> $depfile
- echo >> $depfile
-
- # The second pass generates a dummy entry for each header file.
- tr ' ' '
-' < "$tmpdepfile" \
- | sed -e 's/^.*\.o://' -e 's/#.*$//' -e '/^$/ d' -e 's/$/:/' \
- >> $depfile
- else
- # The sourcefile does not contain any dependencies, so just
- # store a dummy comment line, to avoid errors with the Makefile
- # "include basename.Plo" scheme.
- echo "#dummy" > "$depfile"
- fi
- rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+xlc)
+ # This case exists only to let depend.m4 do its work. It works by
+ # looking at the text of this script. This case will never be run,
+ # since it is checked for above.
+ exit 1
;;
aix)
# The C for AIX Compiler uses -M and outputs the dependencies
# in a .u file. In older versions, this file always lives in the
- # current directory. Also, the AIX compiler puts `$object:' at the
+ # current directory. Also, the AIX compiler puts '$object:' at the
# start of each line; $object doesn't have directory information.
# Version 6 uses the directory in both cases.
- stripped=`echo "$object" | sed 's/\(.*\)\..*$/\1/'`
- tmpdepfile="$stripped.u"
+ set_dir_from "$object"
+ set_base_from "$object"
if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ tmpdepfile1=$dir$base.u
+ tmpdepfile2=$base.u
+ tmpdepfile3=$dir.libs/$base.u
"$@" -Wc,-M
else
+ tmpdepfile1=$dir$base.u
+ tmpdepfile2=$dir$base.u
+ tmpdepfile3=$dir$base.u
"$@" -M
fi
stat=$?
-
- if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then :
- else
- stripped=`echo "$stripped" | sed 's,^.*/,,'`
- tmpdepfile="$stripped.u"
+ if test $stat -ne 0; then
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2" "$tmpdepfile3"
+ exit $stat
fi
- if test $stat -eq 0; then :
- else
+ for tmpdepfile in "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2" "$tmpdepfile3"
+ do
+ test -f "$tmpdepfile" && break
+ done
+ aix_post_process_depfile
+ ;;
+
+tcc)
+ # tcc (Tiny C Compiler) understand '-MD -MF file' since version 0.9.26
+ # FIXME: That version still under development at the moment of writing.
+ # Make that this statement remains true also for stable, released
+ # versions.
+ # It will wrap lines (doesn't matter whether long or short) with a
+ # trailing '\', as in:
+ #
+ # foo.o : \
+ # foo.c \
+ # foo.h \
+ #
+ # It will put a trailing '\' even on the last line, and will use leading
+ # spaces rather than leading tabs (at least since its commit 0394caf7
+ # "Emit spaces for -MD").
+ "$@" -MD -MF "$tmpdepfile"
+ stat=$?
+ if test $stat -ne 0; then
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
exit $stat
fi
-
- if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then
- outname="$stripped.o"
- # Each line is of the form `foo.o: dependent.h'.
- # Do two passes, one to just change these to
- # `$object: dependent.h' and one to simply `dependent.h:'.
- sed -e "s,^$outname:,$object :," < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
- sed -e "s,^$outname: \(.*\)$,\1:," < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
- else
- # The sourcefile does not contain any dependencies, so just
- # store a dummy comment line, to avoid errors with the Makefile
- # "include basename.Plo" scheme.
- echo "#dummy" > "$depfile"
- fi
+ rm -f "$depfile"
+ # Each non-empty line is of the form 'foo.o : \' or ' dep.h \'.
+ # We have to change lines of the first kind to '$object: \'.
+ sed -e "s|.*:|$object :|" < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
+ # And for each line of the second kind, we have to emit a 'dep.h:'
+ # dummy dependency, to avoid the deleted-header problem.
+ sed -n -e 's|^ *\(.*\) *\\$|\1:|p' < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
;;
-icc)
- # Intel's C compiler understands `-MD -MF file'. However on
- # icc -MD -MF foo.d -c -o sub/foo.o sub/foo.c
- # ICC 7.0 will fill foo.d with something like
- # foo.o: sub/foo.c
- # foo.o: sub/foo.h
- # which is wrong. We want:
- # sub/foo.o: sub/foo.c
- # sub/foo.o: sub/foo.h
- # sub/foo.c:
- # sub/foo.h:
- # ICC 7.1 will output
+## The order of this option in the case statement is important, since the
+## shell code in configure will try each of these formats in the order
+## listed in this file. A plain '-MD' option would be understood by many
+## compilers, so we must ensure this comes after the gcc and icc options.
+pgcc)
+ # Portland's C compiler understands '-MD'.
+ # Will always output deps to 'file.d' where file is the root name of the
+ # source file under compilation, even if file resides in a subdirectory.
+ # The object file name does not affect the name of the '.d' file.
+ # pgcc 10.2 will output
# foo.o: sub/foo.c sub/foo.h
- # and will wrap long lines using \ :
+ # and will wrap long lines using '\' :
# foo.o: sub/foo.c ... \
# sub/foo.h ... \
# ...
+ set_dir_from "$object"
+ # Use the source, not the object, to determine the base name, since
+ # that's sadly what pgcc will do too.
+ set_base_from "$source"
+ tmpdepfile=$base.d
+
+ # For projects that build the same source file twice into different object
+ # files, the pgcc approach of using the *source* file root name can cause
+ # problems in parallel builds. Use a locking strategy to avoid stomping on
+ # the same $tmpdepfile.
+ lockdir=$base.d-lock
+ trap "
+ echo '$0: caught signal, cleaning up...' >&2
+ rmdir '$lockdir'
+ exit 1
+ " 1 2 13 15
+ numtries=100
+ i=$numtries
+ while test $i -gt 0; do
+ # mkdir is a portable test-and-set.
+ if mkdir "$lockdir" 2>/dev/null; then
+ # This process acquired the lock.
+ "$@" -MD
+ stat=$?
+ # Release the lock.
+ rmdir "$lockdir"
+ break
+ else
+ # If the lock is being held by a different process, wait
+ # until the winning process is done or we timeout.
+ while test -d "$lockdir" && test $i -gt 0; do
+ sleep 1
+ i=`expr $i - 1`
+ done
+ fi
+ i=`expr $i - 1`
+ done
+ trap - 1 2 13 15
+ if test $i -le 0; then
+ echo "$0: failed to acquire lock after $numtries attempts" >&2
+ echo "$0: check lockdir '$lockdir'" >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
- "$@" -MD -MF "$tmpdepfile"
- stat=$?
- if test $stat -eq 0; then :
- else
+ if test $stat -ne 0; then
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
exit $stat
fi
@@ -285,8 +392,8 @@ icc)
sed "s,^[^:]*:,$object :," < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
# Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation
# correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
- sed 's,^[^:]*: \(.*\)$,\1,;s/^\\$//;/^$/d;/:$/d' < "$tmpdepfile" |
- sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
+ sed 's,^[^:]*: \(.*\)$,\1,;s/^\\$//;/^$/d;/:$/d' < "$tmpdepfile" \
+ | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
;;
@@ -297,9 +404,8 @@ hp2)
# 'foo.d', which lands next to the object file, wherever that
# happens to be.
# Much of this is similar to the tru64 case; see comments there.
- dir=`echo "$object" | sed -e 's|/[^/]*$|/|'`
- test "x$dir" = "x$object" && dir=
- base=`echo "$object" | sed -e 's|^.*/||' -e 's/\.o$//' -e 's/\.lo$//'`
+ set_dir_from "$object"
+ set_base_from "$object"
if test "$libtool" = yes; then
tmpdepfile1=$dir$base.d
tmpdepfile2=$dir.libs/$base.d
@@ -310,8 +416,7 @@ hp2)
"$@" +Maked
fi
stat=$?
- if test $stat -eq 0; then :
- else
+ if test $stat -ne 0; then
rm -f "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2"
exit $stat
fi
@@ -321,72 +426,107 @@ hp2)
test -f "$tmpdepfile" && break
done
if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then
- sed -e "s,^.*\.[a-z]*:,$object:," "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
- # Add `dependent.h:' lines.
- sed -ne '2,${; s/^ *//; s/ \\*$//; s/$/:/; p;}' "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
+ sed -e "s,^.*\.[$lower]*:,$object:," "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
+ # Add 'dependent.h:' lines.
+ sed -ne '2,${
+ s/^ *//
+ s/ \\*$//
+ s/$/:/
+ p
+ }' "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
else
- echo "#dummy" > "$depfile"
+ make_dummy_depfile
fi
rm -f "$tmpdepfile" "$tmpdepfile2"
;;
tru64)
- # The Tru64 compiler uses -MD to generate dependencies as a side
- # effect. `cc -MD -o foo.o ...' puts the dependencies into `foo.o.d'.
- # At least on Alpha/Redhat 6.1, Compaq CCC V6.2-504 seems to put
- # dependencies in `foo.d' instead, so we check for that too.
- # Subdirectories are respected.
- dir=`echo "$object" | sed -e 's|/[^/]*$|/|'`
- test "x$dir" = "x$object" && dir=
- base=`echo "$object" | sed -e 's|^.*/||' -e 's/\.o$//' -e 's/\.lo$//'`
-
- if test "$libtool" = yes; then
- # With Tru64 cc, shared objects can also be used to make a
- # static library. This mechanism is used in libtool 1.4 series to
- # handle both shared and static libraries in a single compilation.
- # With libtool 1.4, dependencies were output in $dir.libs/$base.lo.d.
- #
- # With libtool 1.5 this exception was removed, and libtool now
- # generates 2 separate objects for the 2 libraries. These two
- # compilations output dependencies in $dir.libs/$base.o.d and
- # in $dir$base.o.d. We have to check for both files, because
- # one of the two compilations can be disabled. We should prefer
- # $dir$base.o.d over $dir.libs/$base.o.d because the latter is
- # automatically cleaned when .libs/ is deleted, while ignoring
- # the former would cause a distcleancheck panic.
- tmpdepfile1=$dir.libs/$base.lo.d # libtool 1.4
- tmpdepfile2=$dir$base.o.d # libtool 1.5
- tmpdepfile3=$dir.libs/$base.o.d # libtool 1.5
- tmpdepfile4=$dir.libs/$base.d # Compaq CCC V6.2-504
- "$@" -Wc,-MD
- else
- tmpdepfile1=$dir$base.o.d
- tmpdepfile2=$dir$base.d
- tmpdepfile3=$dir$base.d
- tmpdepfile4=$dir$base.d
- "$@" -MD
- fi
-
- stat=$?
- if test $stat -eq 0; then :
- else
- rm -f "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2" "$tmpdepfile3" "$tmpdepfile4"
- exit $stat
- fi
-
- for tmpdepfile in "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2" "$tmpdepfile3" "$tmpdepfile4"
- do
- test -f "$tmpdepfile" && break
- done
- if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then
- sed -e "s,^.*\.[a-z]*:,$object:," < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
- # That's a tab and a space in the [].
- sed -e 's,^.*\.[a-z]*:[ ]*,,' -e 's,$,:,' < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
- else
- echo "#dummy" > "$depfile"
- fi
- rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
- ;;
+ # The Tru64 compiler uses -MD to generate dependencies as a side
+ # effect. 'cc -MD -o foo.o ...' puts the dependencies into 'foo.o.d'.
+ # At least on Alpha/Redhat 6.1, Compaq CCC V6.2-504 seems to put
+ # dependencies in 'foo.d' instead, so we check for that too.
+ # Subdirectories are respected.
+ set_dir_from "$object"
+ set_base_from "$object"
+
+ if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ # Libtool generates 2 separate objects for the 2 libraries. These
+ # two compilations output dependencies in $dir.libs/$base.o.d and
+ # in $dir$base.o.d. We have to check for both files, because
+ # one of the two compilations can be disabled. We should prefer
+ # $dir$base.o.d over $dir.libs/$base.o.d because the latter is
+ # automatically cleaned when .libs/ is deleted, while ignoring
+ # the former would cause a distcleancheck panic.
+ tmpdepfile1=$dir$base.o.d # libtool 1.5
+ tmpdepfile2=$dir.libs/$base.o.d # Likewise.
+ tmpdepfile3=$dir.libs/$base.d # Compaq CCC V6.2-504
+ "$@" -Wc,-MD
+ else
+ tmpdepfile1=$dir$base.d
+ tmpdepfile2=$dir$base.d
+ tmpdepfile3=$dir$base.d
+ "$@" -MD
+ fi
+
+ stat=$?
+ if test $stat -ne 0; then
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2" "$tmpdepfile3"
+ exit $stat
+ fi
+
+ for tmpdepfile in "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2" "$tmpdepfile3"
+ do
+ test -f "$tmpdepfile" && break
+ done
+ # Same post-processing that is required for AIX mode.
+ aix_post_process_depfile
+ ;;
+
+msvc7)
+ if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ showIncludes=-Wc,-showIncludes
+ else
+ showIncludes=-showIncludes
+ fi
+ "$@" $showIncludes > "$tmpdepfile"
+ stat=$?
+ grep -v '^Note: including file: ' "$tmpdepfile"
+ if test $stat -ne 0; then
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ exit $stat
+ fi
+ rm -f "$depfile"
+ echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile"
+ # The first sed program below extracts the file names and escapes
+ # backslashes for cygpath. The second sed program outputs the file
+ # name when reading, but also accumulates all include files in the
+ # hold buffer in order to output them again at the end. This only
+ # works with sed implementations that can handle large buffers.
+ sed < "$tmpdepfile" -n '
+/^Note: including file: *\(.*\)/ {
+ s//\1/
+ s/\\/\\\\/g
+ p
+}' | $cygpath_u | sort -u | sed -n '
+s/ /\\ /g
+s/\(.*\)/'"$tab"'\1 \\/p
+s/.\(.*\) \\/\1:/
+H
+$ {
+ s/.*/'"$tab"'/
+ G
+ p
+}' >> "$depfile"
+ echo >> "$depfile" # make sure the fragment doesn't end with a backslash
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ ;;
+
+msvc7msys)
+ # This case exists only to let depend.m4 do its work. It works by
+ # looking at the text of this script. This case will never be run,
+ # since it is checked for above.
+ exit 1
+ ;;
#nosideeffect)
# This comment above is used by automake to tell side-effect
@@ -399,13 +539,13 @@ dashmstdout)
# Remove the call to Libtool.
if test "$libtool" = yes; then
- while test $1 != '--mode=compile'; do
+ while test "X$1" != 'X--mode=compile'; do
shift
done
shift
fi
- # Remove `-o $object'.
+ # Remove '-o $object'.
IFS=" "
for arg
do
@@ -425,18 +565,18 @@ dashmstdout)
done
test -z "$dashmflag" && dashmflag=-M
- # Require at least two characters before searching for `:'
+ # Require at least two characters before searching for ':'
# in the target name. This is to cope with DOS-style filenames:
- # a dependency such as `c:/foo/bar' could be seen as target `c' otherwise.
+ # a dependency such as 'c:/foo/bar' could be seen as target 'c' otherwise.
"$@" $dashmflag |
- sed 's:^[ ]*[^: ][^:][^:]*\:[ ]*:'"$object"'\: :' > "$tmpdepfile"
+ sed "s|^[$tab ]*[^:$tab ][^:][^:]*:[$tab ]*|$object: |" > "$tmpdepfile"
rm -f "$depfile"
cat < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
- tr ' ' '
-' < "$tmpdepfile" | \
-## Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation
-## correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
- sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
+ # Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this sed invocation
+ # correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
+ tr ' ' "$nl" < "$tmpdepfile" \
+ | sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' \
+ | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
;;
@@ -450,41 +590,51 @@ makedepend)
"$@" || exit $?
# Remove any Libtool call
if test "$libtool" = yes; then
- while test $1 != '--mode=compile'; do
+ while test "X$1" != 'X--mode=compile'; do
shift
done
shift
fi
# X makedepend
shift
- cleared=no
- for arg in "$@"; do
+ cleared=no eat=no
+ for arg
+ do
case $cleared in
no)
set ""; shift
cleared=yes ;;
esac
+ if test $eat = yes; then
+ eat=no
+ continue
+ fi
case "$arg" in
-D*|-I*)
set fnord "$@" "$arg"; shift ;;
# Strip any option that makedepend may not understand. Remove
# the object too, otherwise makedepend will parse it as a source file.
+ -arch)
+ eat=yes ;;
-*|$object)
;;
*)
set fnord "$@" "$arg"; shift ;;
esac
done
- obj_suffix="`echo $object | sed 's/^.*\././'`"
+ obj_suffix=`echo "$object" | sed 's/^.*\././'`
touch "$tmpdepfile"
${MAKEDEPEND-makedepend} -o"$obj_suffix" -f"$tmpdepfile" "$@"
rm -f "$depfile"
- cat < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
- sed '1,2d' "$tmpdepfile" | tr ' ' '
-' | \
-## Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation
-## correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
- sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
+ # makedepend may prepend the VPATH from the source file name to the object.
+ # No need to regex-escape $object, excess matching of '.' is harmless.
+ sed "s|^.*\($object *:\)|\1|" "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
+ # Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process the last invocation
+ # correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
+ sed '1,2d' "$tmpdepfile" \
+ | tr ' ' "$nl" \
+ | sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' \
+ | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
rm -f "$tmpdepfile" "$tmpdepfile".bak
;;
@@ -495,13 +645,13 @@ cpp)
# Remove the call to Libtool.
if test "$libtool" = yes; then
- while test $1 != '--mode=compile'; do
+ while test "X$1" != 'X--mode=compile'; do
shift
done
shift
fi
- # Remove `-o $object'.
+ # Remove '-o $object'.
IFS=" "
for arg
do
@@ -520,10 +670,10 @@ cpp)
esac
done
- "$@" -E |
- sed -n -e '/^# [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)".*/ s:: \1 \\:p' \
- -e '/^#line [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)".*/ s:: \1 \\:p' |
- sed '$ s: \\$::' > "$tmpdepfile"
+ "$@" -E \
+ | sed -n -e '/^# [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)".*/ s:: \1 \\:p' \
+ -e '/^#line [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)".*/ s:: \1 \\:p' \
+ | sed '$ s: \\$::' > "$tmpdepfile"
rm -f "$depfile"
echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile"
cat < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
@@ -533,35 +683,56 @@ cpp)
msvisualcpp)
# Important note: in order to support this mode, a compiler *must*
- # always write the preprocessed file to stdout, regardless of -o,
- # because we must use -o when running libtool.
+ # always write the preprocessed file to stdout.
"$@" || exit $?
+
+ # Remove the call to Libtool.
+ if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ while test "X$1" != 'X--mode=compile'; do
+ shift
+ done
+ shift
+ fi
+
IFS=" "
for arg
do
case "$arg" in
+ -o)
+ shift
+ ;;
+ $object)
+ shift
+ ;;
"-Gm"|"/Gm"|"-Gi"|"/Gi"|"-ZI"|"/ZI")
- set fnord "$@"
- shift
- shift
- ;;
+ set fnord "$@"
+ shift
+ shift
+ ;;
*)
- set fnord "$@" "$arg"
- shift
- shift
- ;;
+ set fnord "$@" "$arg"
+ shift
+ shift
+ ;;
esac
done
- "$@" -E |
- sed -n '/^#line [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)"/ s::echo "`cygpath -u \\"\1\\"`":p' | sort | uniq > "$tmpdepfile"
+ "$@" -E 2>/dev/null |
+ sed -n '/^#line [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)"/ s::\1:p' | $cygpath_u | sort -u > "$tmpdepfile"
rm -f "$depfile"
echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile"
- . "$tmpdepfile" | sed 's% %\\ %g' | sed -n '/^\(.*\)$/ s:: \1 \\:p' >> "$depfile"
- echo " " >> "$depfile"
- . "$tmpdepfile" | sed 's% %\\ %g' | sed -n '/^\(.*\)$/ s::\1\::p' >> "$depfile"
+ sed < "$tmpdepfile" -n -e 's% %\\ %g' -e '/^\(.*\)$/ s::'"$tab"'\1 \\:p' >> "$depfile"
+ echo "$tab" >> "$depfile"
+ sed < "$tmpdepfile" -n -e 's% %\\ %g' -e '/^\(.*\)$/ s::\1\::p' >> "$depfile"
rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
;;
+msvcmsys)
+ # This case exists only to let depend.m4 do its work. It works by
+ # looking at the text of this script. This case will never be run,
+ # since it is checked for above.
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+
none)
exec "$@"
;;
@@ -580,5 +751,6 @@ exit 0
# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/do-release-commit-and-tag b/build-aux/do-release-commit-and-tag
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..b4f3251
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/do-release-commit-and-tag
@@ -0,0 +1,179 @@
+#!/bin/sh
+# In a git/autoconf/automake-enabled project with a NEWS file and a version-
+# controlled .prev-version file, automate the procedure by which we record
+# the date, release-type and version string in the NEWS file. That commit
+# will serve to identify the release, so apply a signed tag to it as well.
+VERSION=2016-01-12.23 # UTC
+
+# Note: this is a bash script (could be zsh or dash)
+
+# Copyright (C) 2009-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
+# (at your option) any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# Written by Jim Meyering
+
+ME=$(basename "$0")
+warn() { printf '%s: %s\n' "$ME" "$*" >&2; }
+die() { warn "$*"; exit 1; }
+
+help()
+{
+ cat <<EOF
+Usage: $ME [OPTION...] VERSION RELEASE_TYPE
+
+Run this script from top_srcdir to perform the final pre-release NEWS
+update in which the date, release-type and version string are
+recorded. Commit that result with a log entry marking the release,
+and apply a signed tag. Run it from your project's top-level
+directory.
+
+Requirements:
+- you use git for version-control
+- a version-controlled .prev-version file
+- a NEWS file, with line 3 identical to this:
+$noteworthy_stub
+
+Options:
+ --branch=BRANCH set release branch (default: $branch)
+ -C, --builddir=DIR location of (configured) Makefile (default: $builddir)
+ --help print this help, then exit
+ --version print version number, then exit
+
+EXAMPLE:
+To update NEWS and tag the beta 8.1 release of coreutils, I would run this:
+
+ $ME 8.1 beta
+
+Report bugs and patches to <bug-gnulib@gnu.org>.
+EOF
+ exit
+}
+
+version()
+{
+ year=$(echo "$VERSION" | sed 's/[^0-9].*//')
+ cat <<EOF
+$ME $VERSION
+Copyright (C) $year Free Software Foundation, Inc,
+License GPLv3+: GNU GPL version 3 or later <http://gnu.org/licenses/gpl.html>
+This is free software: you are free to change and redistribute it.
+There is NO WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law.
+EOF
+ exit
+}
+
+## ------ ##
+## Main. ##
+## ------ ##
+
+# Constants.
+noteworthy='* Noteworthy changes in release'
+noteworthy_stub="$noteworthy ?.? (????-??-??) [?]"
+
+# Variables.
+branch=$(git branch | sed -ne '/^\* /{s///;p;q;}')
+builddir=.
+
+while test $# != 0
+do
+ # Handle --option=value by splitting apart and putting back on argv.
+ case $1 in
+ --*=*)
+ opt=$(echo "$1" | sed -e 's/=.*//')
+ val=$(echo "$1" | sed -e 's/[^=]*=//')
+ shift
+ set dummy "$opt" "$val" "$@"; shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ case $1 in
+ --help|--version) ${1#--};;
+ --branch) shift; branch=$1; shift ;;
+ -C|--builddir) shift; builddir=$1; shift ;;
+ --*) die "unrecognized option: $1";;
+ *) break;;
+ esac
+done
+
+test $# = 2 \
+ || die "Usage: $ME [OPTION...] VERSION TYPE"
+
+ver=$1
+type=$2
+
+
+## ---------------------- ##
+## First, sanity checks. ##
+## ---------------------- ##
+
+# Verify that $ver looks like a version number, and...
+echo "$ver"|grep -E '^[0-9][0-9.]*[0-9]$' > /dev/null \
+ || die "invalid version: $ver"
+prev_ver=$(cat .prev-version) \
+ || die 'failed to determine previous version number from .prev-version'
+
+# Verify that $ver is sensible (> .prev-version).
+case $(printf "$prev_ver\n$ver\n"|sort -V -u|tr '\n' ':') in
+ "$prev_ver:$ver:") ;;
+ *) die "invalid version: $ver (<= $prev_ver)";;
+esac
+
+case $type in
+ alpha|beta|stable) ;;
+ *) die "invalid release type: $type";;
+esac
+
+# No local modifications allowed.
+case $(git diff-index --name-only HEAD) in
+ '') ;;
+ *) die 'this tree is dirty; commit your changes first';;
+esac
+
+# Ensure the current branch name is correct:
+curr_br=$(git rev-parse --symbolic-full-name HEAD)
+test "$curr_br" = refs/heads/$branch || die not on branch $branch
+
+# Extract package name from Makefile.
+Makefile=$builddir/Makefile
+pkg=$(sed -n 's/^PACKAGE = \(.*\)/\1/p' "$Makefile") \
+ || die "failed to determine package name from $Makefile"
+
+# Check that line 3 of NEWS is the stub line about to be replaced.
+test "$(sed -n 3p NEWS)" = "$noteworthy_stub" \
+ || die "line 3 of NEWS must be exactly '$noteworthy_stub'"
+
+## --------------- ##
+## Then, changes. ##
+## --------------- ##
+
+# Update NEWS to have today's date, plus desired version number and $type.
+perl -MPOSIX -ni -e 'my $today = strftime "%F", localtime time;' \
+ -e 'my ($type, $ver) = qw('"$type $ver"');' \
+ -e 'my $pfx = "'"$noteworthy"'";' \
+ -e 'print $.==3 ? "$pfx $ver ($today) [$type]\n" : $_' \
+ NEWS || die 'failed to update NEWS'
+
+printf "version $ver\n\n* NEWS: Record release date.\n" \
+ | git commit -F - -a || die 'git commit failed'
+git tag -s -m "$pkg $ver" v$ver HEAD || die 'git tag failed'
+
+# Local variables:
+# indent-tabs-mode: nil
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "VERSION="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: " # UTC"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/gen-lists-of-programs.sh b/build-aux/gen-lists-of-programs.sh
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..40c3a32
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/gen-lists-of-programs.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,194 @@
+#!/bin/sh
+# Generate lists of all coreutils programs, to be fed both to Autoconf
+# and Automake, and with further distinctions about how and when these
+# programs should be built. This is useful to avoid duplicating these
+# list definitions among several files ('configure.ac' and
+# 'src/local.mk' at least); such duplication had proved a source of
+# inconsistencies and bugs in the past.
+
+set -u
+set -e
+
+# These are the names of programs that are neither built nor installed
+# by default. This list is *not* intended for programs like 'who',
+# 'nice', 'chroot', etc., that are built only when certain requisite
+# system features are detected.
+# If you would like to install programs from this list anyway, say A and B,
+# use "--enable-install-program=A,B" when invoking configure.
+disabled_by_default_progs='
+ arch
+ coreutils
+ hostname
+'
+
+# Programs that can be built only when certain requisite system
+# features are detected at configure time.
+build_if_possible_progs='
+ chroot
+ df
+ hostid
+ libstdbuf.so
+ nice
+ pinky
+ stdbuf
+ stty
+ uptime
+ users
+ who
+'
+
+# All the other programs, to be built by default, and that should
+# be buildable without problems on any target system.
+normal_progs='
+ [
+ base64
+ base32
+ basename
+ cat
+ chcon
+ chgrp
+ chmod
+ chown
+ cksum
+ comm
+ cp
+ csplit
+ cut
+ date
+ dd
+ dir
+ dircolors
+ dirname
+ du
+ echo
+ env
+ expand
+ expr
+ factor
+ false
+ fmt
+ fold
+ ginstall
+ groups
+ head
+ id
+ join
+ kill
+ link
+ ln
+ logname
+ ls
+ md5sum
+ mkdir
+ mkfifo
+ mknod
+ mktemp
+ mv
+ nl
+ nproc
+ nohup
+ numfmt
+ od
+ paste
+ pathchk
+ pr
+ printenv
+ printf
+ ptx
+ pwd
+ readlink
+ realpath
+ rm
+ rmdir
+ runcon
+ seq
+ sha1sum
+ sha224sum
+ sha256sum
+ sha384sum
+ sha512sum
+ shred
+ shuf
+ sleep
+ sort
+ split
+ stat
+ sum
+ sync
+ tac
+ tail
+ tee
+ test
+ timeout
+ touch
+ tr
+ true
+ truncate
+ tsort
+ tty
+ uname
+ unexpand
+ uniq
+ unlink
+ vdir
+ wc
+ whoami
+ yes
+'
+
+me=`echo "$0" | sed 's,.*/,,'`
+msg="Automatically generated by $me. DO NOT EDIT BY HAND!"
+
+case $#,$1 in
+ 1,--autoconf|1,--for-autoconf)
+ echo "dnl $msg"
+ for p in $normal_progs; do
+ test x"$p" = x"[" && p='@<:@'
+ echo "gl_ADD_PROG([optional_bin_progs], [$p])"
+ done
+ # Extra 'echo' to normalize whitespace.
+ echo "no_install_progs_default='`echo $disabled_by_default_progs`'"
+ sed 's/^ *//' <<END
+ # Given the name of a variable containing a space-separated
+ # list of install-by-default programs and the actual list of
+ # do-not-install-by-default programs, modify the former variable
+ # to reflect any "do-install" and "don't-install" requests.
+ # That is, add any program specified via --enable-install-program,
+ # and remove any program specified via --enable-no-install-program.
+ # Note how the second argument below is a literal, with ","
+ # separators. That is required due to the way the macro works,
+ # and since the corresponding ./configure option argument is
+ # comma-separated on input.
+ gl_INCLUDE_EXCLUDE_PROG([optional_bin_progs], [`\
+ echo $disabled_by_default_progs \
+ | sed 's/ /,/g'`])
+END
+ ;;
+ 1,--automake|1,--for-automake)
+ echo "## $msg"
+ progsdir=src
+ echo no_install__progs =
+ for p in $disabled_by_default_progs; do
+ echo no_install__progs += $progsdir/$p
+ done
+ echo build_if_possible__progs =
+ for p in $build_if_possible_progs; do
+ echo build_if_possible__progs += $progsdir/$p
+ done
+ echo default__progs =
+ for p in $normal_progs; do
+ echo default__progs += $progsdir/$p
+ done
+ ;;
+ 1,--list-progs)
+ for p in $disabled_by_default_progs $build_if_possible_progs \
+ $normal_progs; do
+ echo $p
+ done
+ ;;
+ *)
+ echo "$0: invalid usage" >&2; exit 2
+ ;;
+esac
+
+exit 0
diff --git a/build-aux/gen-single-binary.sh b/build-aux/gen-single-binary.sh
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..4e07cfd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/gen-single-binary.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,111 @@
+#!/bin/sh
+
+# Generate the list of rules for the single-binary option based on all the other
+# binaries found in src/local.mk.
+#
+# We need to duplicate the specific rules to build each program into a new
+# static library target. We can't reuse the existing target since we need to
+# create a .a file instead of linking the program. We can't do this at
+# ./configure since the file names need to be available when automake runs
+# to let it generate all the required rules in Makefile.in. The configure
+# step will select which ones will be used to build, but they need to be
+# generated beforehand.
+#
+# Instead of maintaining a duplicated list of rules, we generate the
+# single-binary required rules based on the normal configuration found on
+# src/local.mk with this script.
+
+if test "x$1" = "x"; then
+ echo "Usage: $0 path/to/src/local.mk" >&2
+ exit 1
+fi
+
+set -e
+
+LOCAL_MK=$1
+GEN_LISTS_OF_PROGRAMS="`dirname "$0"`/gen-lists-of-programs.sh"
+
+ALL_PROGRAMS=$($GEN_LISTS_OF_PROGRAMS --list-progs \
+ | grep -v -F -e coreutils -e libstdbuf.so \
+ | tr '[' '_')
+
+# Compute default SOURCES. automake will assume the source file for the
+# src_${cmd} target to be src/${cmd}.c, but we will add rules to generate
+# the lib src_libsinglebin_${cmd}_a which won't match the autogenerated source
+# file. This loop will initialize the default source file and will be reset
+# later if needed.
+for cmd in $ALL_PROGRAMS; do
+ eval "src_${cmd}_SOURCES=src/${cmd}.c"
+done
+
+# Load actual values from src/local.mk. This will read all the variables from
+# the local.mk matching the src_${cmd}_... case.
+while read l; do
+ if echo "$l" | grep -E '^src_\w+ +\+?=' > /dev/null; then
+ var=$(echo $l | cut -f 1 -d ' ')
+ value=$(echo $l | cut -f 2- -d =)
+ if [ "$value" != " \$(LDADD)" ]; then
+ oldvalue=""
+ if echo $l | grep -F '+=' >/dev/null; then
+ eval "oldvalue=\${$var}"
+ fi
+ value=$(echo "$value" | sed "s/'/'\"'\"'/g")
+ eval "$var='$oldvalue "$value"'"
+ fi
+ fi
+done < $LOCAL_MK
+
+me=`echo "$0" | sed 's,.*/,,'`
+echo "## Automatically generated by $me. DO NOT EDIT BY HAND!"
+
+# Override the sources for dir and vdir. We use a smaller version of dir and
+# vdir that relies on the ls main.
+src_dir_SOURCES="src/coreutils-dir.c"
+src_dir_LDADD="$src_dir_LDADD src/libsinglebin_ls.a"
+echo src_libsinglebin_dir_a_DEPENDENCIES = src/libsinglebin_ls.a
+src_vdir_SOURCES="src/coreutils-vdir.c"
+src_vdir_LDADD="$src_vdir_LDADD src/libsinglebin_ls.a"
+echo src_libsinglebin_vdir_a_DEPENDENCIES = src/libsinglebin_ls.a
+
+# Override the sources for arch likewise, using the main from uname.
+src_arch_SOURCES="src/coreutils-arch.c"
+src_arch_LDADD="$src_arch_LDADD src/libsinglebin_uname.a"
+echo src_libsinglebin_arch_a_DEPENDENCIES = src/libsinglebin_uname.a
+
+for cmd in $ALL_PROGRAMS; do
+ echo "# Command $cmd"
+ echo noinst_LIBRARIES += src/libsinglebin_${cmd}.a
+ base="src_libsinglebin_${cmd}_a"
+ # SOURCES
+ var=src_${cmd}_SOURCES
+ eval "value=\$$var"
+ echo "${base}_SOURCES = $value"
+
+ # LDADD
+ var=src_${cmd}_LDADD
+ eval "value=\$$var"
+ if [ "x$value" != "x" ]; then
+ echo "${base}_ldadd = $value"
+ fi
+
+ # CFLAGS
+ # Hack any other program defining a main() replacing its main by
+ # single_binary_main_$PROGRAM_NAME.
+ echo "${base}_CFLAGS = \"-Dmain=single_binary_main_${cmd} (int, char **);" \
+ " int single_binary_main_${cmd}\" " \
+ "-Dusage=_usage_${cmd} \$(src_coreutils_CFLAGS)"
+ var=src_${cmd}_CFLAGS
+ eval "value=\$$var"
+ if [ "x$value" != "x" ]; then
+ echo "${base}_CFLAGS += $value"
+ fi
+
+ # CPPFLAGS
+ var=src_${cmd}_CPPFLAGS
+ eval "value=\$$var"
+ if [ "x$value" != "x" ]; then
+ echo "${base}_CPPFLAGS = $value"
+ fi
+done
+
+exit 0
diff --git a/build-aux/gendocs.sh b/build-aux/gendocs.sh
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..1d1e1e7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/gendocs.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,504 @@
+#!/bin/sh -e
+# gendocs.sh -- generate a GNU manual in many formats. This script is
+# mentioned in maintain.texi. See the help message below for usage details.
+
+scriptversion=2016-01-01.00
+
+# Copyright 2003-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
+# (at your option) any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+#
+# Original author: Mohit Agarwal.
+# Send bug reports and any other correspondence to bug-gnulib@gnu.org.
+#
+# The latest version of this script, and the companion template, is
+# available from the Gnulib repository:
+#
+# http://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/gnulib.git/tree/build-aux/gendocs.sh
+# http://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/gnulib.git/tree/doc/gendocs_template
+
+# TODO:
+# - image importing was only implemented for HTML generated by
+# makeinfo. But it should be simple enough to adjust.
+# - images are not imported in the source tarball. All the needed
+# formats (PDF, PNG, etc.) should be included.
+
+prog=`basename "$0"`
+srcdir=`pwd`
+
+scripturl="http://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/gnulib.git/plain/build-aux/gendocs.sh"
+templateurl="http://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/gnulib.git/plain/doc/gendocs_template"
+
+: ${SETLANG="env LANG= LC_MESSAGES= LC_ALL= LANGUAGE="}
+: ${MAKEINFO="makeinfo"}
+: ${TEXI2DVI="texi2dvi"}
+: ${DOCBOOK2HTML="docbook2html"}
+: ${DOCBOOK2PDF="docbook2pdf"}
+: ${DOCBOOK2TXT="docbook2txt"}
+: ${GENDOCS_TEMPLATE_DIR="."}
+: ${PERL='perl'}
+: ${TEXI2HTML="texi2html"}
+unset CDPATH
+unset use_texi2html
+
+version="gendocs.sh $scriptversion
+
+Copyright 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+There is NO warranty. You may redistribute this software
+under the terms of the GNU General Public License.
+For more information about these matters, see the files named COPYING."
+
+usage="Usage: $prog [OPTION]... PACKAGE MANUAL-TITLE
+
+Generate output in various formats from PACKAGE.texinfo (or .texi or
+.txi) source. See the GNU Maintainers document for a more extensive
+discussion:
+ http://www.gnu.org/prep/maintain_toc.html
+
+Options:
+ --email ADR use ADR as contact in generated web pages; always give this.
+
+ -s SRCFILE read Texinfo from SRCFILE, instead of PACKAGE.{texinfo|texi|txi}
+ -o OUTDIR write files into OUTDIR, instead of manual/.
+ -I DIR append DIR to the Texinfo search path.
+ --common ARG pass ARG in all invocations.
+ --html ARG pass ARG to makeinfo or texi2html for HTML targets,
+ instead of --css-ref=/software/gnulib/manual.css.
+ --info ARG pass ARG to makeinfo for Info, instead of --no-split.
+ --no-ascii skip generating the plain text output.
+ --no-html skip generating the html output.
+ --no-info skip generating the info output.
+ --no-tex skip generating the dvi and pdf output.
+ --source ARG include ARG in tar archive of sources.
+ --split HOW make split HTML by node, section, chapter; default node.
+ --tex ARG pass ARG to texi2dvi for DVI and PDF, instead of -t @finalout.
+
+ --texi2html use texi2html to make HTML target, with all split versions.
+ --docbook convert through DocBook too (xml, txt, html, pdf).
+
+ --help display this help and exit successfully.
+ --version display version information and exit successfully.
+
+Simple example: $prog --email bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org emacs \"GNU Emacs Manual\"
+
+Typical sequence:
+ cd PACKAGESOURCE/doc
+ wget \"$scripturl\"
+ wget \"$templateurl\"
+ $prog --email BUGLIST MANUAL \"GNU MANUAL - One-line description\"
+
+Output will be in a new subdirectory \"manual\" (by default;
+use -o OUTDIR to override). Move all the new files into your web CVS
+tree, as explained in the Web Pages node of maintain.texi.
+
+Please use the --email ADDRESS option so your own bug-reporting
+address will be used in the generated HTML pages.
+
+MANUAL-TITLE is included as part of the HTML <title> of the overall
+manual/index.html file. It should include the name of the package being
+documented. manual/index.html is created by substitution from the file
+$GENDOCS_TEMPLATE_DIR/gendocs_template. (Feel free to modify the
+generic template for your own purposes.)
+
+If you have several manuals, you'll need to run this script several
+times with different MANUAL values, specifying a different output
+directory with -o each time. Then write (by hand) an overall index.html
+with links to them all.
+
+If a manual's Texinfo sources are spread across several directories,
+first copy or symlink all Texinfo sources into a single directory.
+(Part of the script's work is to make a tar.gz of the sources.)
+
+As implied above, by default monolithic Info files are generated.
+If you want split Info, or other Info options, use --info to override.
+
+You can set the environment variables MAKEINFO, TEXI2DVI, TEXI2HTML,
+and PERL to control the programs that get executed, and
+GENDOCS_TEMPLATE_DIR to control where the gendocs_template file is
+looked for. With --docbook, the environment variables DOCBOOK2HTML,
+DOCBOOK2PDF, and DOCBOOK2TXT are also consulted.
+
+By default, makeinfo and texi2dvi are run in the default (English)
+locale, since that's the language of most Texinfo manuals. If you
+happen to have a non-English manual and non-English web site, see the
+SETLANG setting in the source.
+
+Email bug reports or enhancement requests to bug-gnulib@gnu.org.
+"
+
+MANUAL_TITLE=
+PACKAGE=
+EMAIL=webmasters@gnu.org # please override with --email
+commonarg= # passed to all makeinfo/texi2html invcations.
+dirargs= # passed to all tools (-I dir).
+dirs= # -I directories.
+htmlarg=--css-ref=/software/gnulib/manual.css
+infoarg=--no-split
+generate_ascii=true
+generate_html=true
+generate_info=true
+generate_tex=true
+outdir=manual
+source_extra=
+split=node
+srcfile=
+texarg="-t @finalout"
+
+while test $# -gt 0; do
+ case $1 in
+ -s) shift; srcfile=$1;;
+ -o) shift; outdir=$1;;
+ -I) shift; dirargs="$dirargs -I '$1'"; dirs="$dirs $1";;
+ --common) shift; commonarg=$1;;
+ --docbook) docbook=yes;;
+ --email) shift; EMAIL=$1;;
+ --html) shift; htmlarg=$1;;
+ --info) shift; infoarg=$1;;
+ --no-ascii) generate_ascii=false;;
+ --no-html) generate_ascii=false;;
+ --no-info) generate_info=false;;
+ --no-tex) generate_tex=false;;
+ --source) shift; source_extra=$1;;
+ --split) shift; split=$1;;
+ --tex) shift; texarg=$1;;
+ --texi2html) use_texi2html=1;;
+
+ --help) echo "$usage"; exit 0;;
+ --version) echo "$version"; exit 0;;
+ -*)
+ echo "$0: Unknown option \`$1'." >&2
+ echo "$0: Try \`--help' for more information." >&2
+ exit 1;;
+ *)
+ if test -z "$PACKAGE"; then
+ PACKAGE=$1
+ elif test -z "$MANUAL_TITLE"; then
+ MANUAL_TITLE=$1
+ else
+ echo "$0: extra non-option argument \`$1'." >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi;;
+ esac
+ shift
+done
+
+# makeinfo uses the dirargs, but texi2dvi doesn't.
+commonarg=" $dirargs $commonarg"
+
+# For most of the following, the base name is just $PACKAGE
+base=$PACKAGE
+
+if test -n "$srcfile"; then
+ # but here, we use the basename of $srcfile
+ base=`basename "$srcfile"`
+ case $base in
+ *.txi|*.texi|*.texinfo) base=`echo "$base"|sed 's/\.[texinfo]*$//'`;;
+ esac
+ PACKAGE=$base
+elif test -s "$srcdir/$PACKAGE.texinfo"; then
+ srcfile=$srcdir/$PACKAGE.texinfo
+elif test -s "$srcdir/$PACKAGE.texi"; then
+ srcfile=$srcdir/$PACKAGE.texi
+elif test -s "$srcdir/$PACKAGE.txi"; then
+ srcfile=$srcdir/$PACKAGE.txi
+else
+ echo "$0: cannot find .texinfo or .texi or .txi for $PACKAGE in $srcdir." >&2
+ exit 1
+fi
+
+if test ! -r $GENDOCS_TEMPLATE_DIR/gendocs_template; then
+ echo "$0: cannot read $GENDOCS_TEMPLATE_DIR/gendocs_template." >&2
+ echo "$0: it is available from $templateurl." >&2
+ exit 1
+fi
+
+# Function to return size of $1 in something resembling kilobytes.
+calcsize()
+{
+ size=`ls -ksl $1 | awk '{print $1}'`
+ echo $size
+}
+
+# copy_images OUTDIR HTML-FILE...
+# -------------------------------
+# Copy all the images needed by the HTML-FILEs into OUTDIR.
+# Look for them in . and the -I directories; this is simpler than what
+# makeinfo supports with -I, but hopefully it will suffice.
+copy_images()
+{
+ local odir
+ odir=$1
+ shift
+ $PERL -n -e "
+BEGIN {
+ \$me = '$prog';
+ \$odir = '$odir';
+ @dirs = qw(. $dirs);
+}
+" -e '
+/<img src="(.*?)"/g && ++$need{$1};
+
+END {
+ #print "$me: @{[keys %need]}\n"; # for debugging, show images found.
+ FILE: for my $f (keys %need) {
+ for my $d (@dirs) {
+ if (-f "$d/$f") {
+ use File::Basename;
+ my $dest = dirname ("$odir/$f");
+ #
+ use File::Path;
+ -d $dest || mkpath ($dest)
+ || die "$me: cannot mkdir $dest: $!\n";
+ #
+ use File::Copy;
+ copy ("$d/$f", $dest)
+ || die "$me: cannot copy $d/$f to $dest: $!\n";
+ next FILE;
+ }
+ }
+ die "$me: $ARGV: cannot find image $f\n";
+ }
+}
+' -- "$@" || exit 1
+}
+
+case $outdir in
+ /*) abs_outdir=$outdir;;
+ *) abs_outdir=$srcdir/$outdir;;
+esac
+
+echo "Making output for $srcfile"
+echo " in `pwd`"
+mkdir -p "$outdir/"
+
+#
+if $generate_info; then
+ cmd="$SETLANG $MAKEINFO -o $PACKAGE.info $commonarg $infoarg \"$srcfile\""
+ echo "Generating info... ($cmd)"
+ rm -f $PACKAGE.info* # get rid of any strays
+ eval "$cmd"
+ tar czf "$outdir/$PACKAGE.info.tar.gz" $PACKAGE.info*
+ ls -l "$outdir/$PACKAGE.info.tar.gz"
+ info_tgz_size=`calcsize "$outdir/$PACKAGE.info.tar.gz"`
+ # do not mv the info files, there's no point in having them available
+ # separately on the web.
+fi # end info
+
+#
+if $generate_tex; then
+ cmd="$SETLANG $TEXI2DVI $dirargs $texarg \"$srcfile\""
+ printf "\nGenerating dvi... ($cmd)\n"
+ eval "$cmd"
+ # compress/finish dvi:
+ gzip -f -9 $PACKAGE.dvi
+ dvi_gz_size=`calcsize $PACKAGE.dvi.gz`
+ mv $PACKAGE.dvi.gz "$outdir/"
+ ls -l "$outdir/$PACKAGE.dvi.gz"
+
+ cmd="$SETLANG $TEXI2DVI --pdf $dirargs $texarg \"$srcfile\""
+ printf "\nGenerating pdf... ($cmd)\n"
+ eval "$cmd"
+ pdf_size=`calcsize $PACKAGE.pdf`
+ mv $PACKAGE.pdf "$outdir/"
+ ls -l "$outdir/$PACKAGE.pdf"
+fi # end tex (dvi + pdf)
+
+#
+if $generate_ascii; then
+ opt="-o $PACKAGE.txt --no-split --no-headers $commonarg"
+ cmd="$SETLANG $MAKEINFO $opt \"$srcfile\""
+ printf "\nGenerating ascii... ($cmd)\n"
+ eval "$cmd"
+ ascii_size=`calcsize $PACKAGE.txt`
+ gzip -f -9 -c $PACKAGE.txt >"$outdir/$PACKAGE.txt.gz"
+ ascii_gz_size=`calcsize "$outdir/$PACKAGE.txt.gz"`
+ mv $PACKAGE.txt "$outdir/"
+ ls -l "$outdir/$PACKAGE.txt" "$outdir/$PACKAGE.txt.gz"
+fi
+
+#
+
+if $generate_html; then
+# Split HTML at level $1. Used for texi2html.
+html_split()
+{
+ opt="--split=$1 --node-files $commonarg $htmlarg"
+ cmd="$SETLANG $TEXI2HTML --output $PACKAGE.html $opt \"$srcfile\""
+ printf "\nGenerating html by $1... ($cmd)\n"
+ eval "$cmd"
+ split_html_dir=$PACKAGE.html
+ (
+ cd ${split_html_dir} || exit 1
+ ln -sf ${PACKAGE}.html index.html
+ tar -czf "$abs_outdir/${PACKAGE}.html_$1.tar.gz" -- *.html
+ )
+ eval html_$1_tgz_size=`calcsize "$outdir/${PACKAGE}.html_$1.tar.gz"`
+ rm -f "$outdir"/html_$1/*.html
+ mkdir -p "$outdir/html_$1/"
+ mv ${split_html_dir}/*.html "$outdir/html_$1/"
+ rmdir ${split_html_dir}
+}
+
+if test -z "$use_texi2html"; then
+ opt="--no-split --html -o $PACKAGE.html $commonarg $htmlarg"
+ cmd="$SETLANG $MAKEINFO $opt \"$srcfile\""
+ printf "\nGenerating monolithic html... ($cmd)\n"
+ rm -rf $PACKAGE.html # in case a directory is left over
+ eval "$cmd"
+ html_mono_size=`calcsize $PACKAGE.html`
+ gzip -f -9 -c $PACKAGE.html >"$outdir/$PACKAGE.html.gz"
+ html_mono_gz_size=`calcsize "$outdir/$PACKAGE.html.gz"`
+ copy_images "$outdir/" $PACKAGE.html
+ mv $PACKAGE.html "$outdir/"
+ ls -l "$outdir/$PACKAGE.html" "$outdir/$PACKAGE.html.gz"
+
+ # Before Texinfo 5.0, makeinfo did not accept a --split=HOW option,
+ # it just always split by node. So if we're splitting by node anyway,
+ # leave it out.
+ if test "x$split" = xnode; then
+ split_arg=
+ else
+ split_arg=--split=$split
+ fi
+ #
+ opt="--html -o $PACKAGE.html $split_arg $commonarg $htmlarg"
+ cmd="$SETLANG $MAKEINFO $opt \"$srcfile\""
+ printf "\nGenerating html by $split... ($cmd)\n"
+ eval "$cmd"
+ split_html_dir=$PACKAGE.html
+ copy_images $split_html_dir/ $split_html_dir/*.html
+ (
+ cd $split_html_dir || exit 1
+ tar -czf "$abs_outdir/$PACKAGE.html_$split.tar.gz" -- *
+ )
+ eval \
+ html_${split}_tgz_size=`calcsize "$outdir/$PACKAGE.html_$split.tar.gz"`
+ rm -rf "$outdir/html_$split/"
+ mv $split_html_dir "$outdir/html_$split/"
+ du -s "$outdir/html_$split/"
+ ls -l "$outdir/$PACKAGE.html_$split.tar.gz"
+
+else # use texi2html:
+ opt="--output $PACKAGE.html $commonarg $htmlarg"
+ cmd="$SETLANG $TEXI2HTML $opt \"$srcfile\""
+ printf "\nGenerating monolithic html with texi2html... ($cmd)\n"
+ rm -rf $PACKAGE.html # in case a directory is left over
+ eval "$cmd"
+ html_mono_size=`calcsize $PACKAGE.html`
+ gzip -f -9 -c $PACKAGE.html >"$outdir/$PACKAGE.html.gz"
+ html_mono_gz_size=`calcsize "$outdir/$PACKAGE.html.gz"`
+ mv $PACKAGE.html "$outdir/"
+
+ html_split node
+ html_split chapter
+ html_split section
+fi
+fi # end html
+
+#
+printf "\nMaking .tar.gz for sources...\n"
+d=`dirname $srcfile`
+(
+ cd "$d"
+ srcfiles=`ls -d *.texinfo *.texi *.txi *.eps $source_extra 2>/dev/null` || true
+ tar czfh "$abs_outdir/$PACKAGE.texi.tar.gz" $srcfiles
+ ls -l "$abs_outdir/$PACKAGE.texi.tar.gz"
+)
+texi_tgz_size=`calcsize "$outdir/$PACKAGE.texi.tar.gz"`
+
+#
+# Do everything again through docbook.
+if test -n "$docbook"; then
+ opt="-o - --docbook $commonarg"
+ cmd="$SETLANG $MAKEINFO $opt \"$srcfile\" >${srcdir}/$PACKAGE-db.xml"
+ printf "\nGenerating docbook XML... ($cmd)\n"
+ eval "$cmd"
+ docbook_xml_size=`calcsize $PACKAGE-db.xml`
+ gzip -f -9 -c $PACKAGE-db.xml >"$outdir/$PACKAGE-db.xml.gz"
+ docbook_xml_gz_size=`calcsize "$outdir/$PACKAGE-db.xml.gz"`
+ mv $PACKAGE-db.xml "$outdir/"
+
+ split_html_db_dir=html_node_db
+ opt="$commonarg -o $split_html_db_dir"
+ cmd="$DOCBOOK2HTML $opt \"${outdir}/$PACKAGE-db.xml\""
+ printf "\nGenerating docbook HTML... ($cmd)\n"
+ eval "$cmd"
+ (
+ cd ${split_html_db_dir} || exit 1
+ tar -czf "$abs_outdir/${PACKAGE}.html_node_db.tar.gz" -- *.html
+ )
+ html_node_db_tgz_size=`calcsize "$outdir/${PACKAGE}.html_node_db.tar.gz"`
+ rm -f "$outdir"/html_node_db/*.html
+ mkdir -p "$outdir/html_node_db"
+ mv ${split_html_db_dir}/*.html "$outdir/html_node_db/"
+ rmdir ${split_html_db_dir}
+
+ cmd="$DOCBOOK2TXT \"${outdir}/$PACKAGE-db.xml\""
+ printf "\nGenerating docbook ASCII... ($cmd)\n"
+ eval "$cmd"
+ docbook_ascii_size=`calcsize $PACKAGE-db.txt`
+ mv $PACKAGE-db.txt "$outdir/"
+
+ cmd="$DOCBOOK2PDF \"${outdir}/$PACKAGE-db.xml\""
+ printf "\nGenerating docbook PDF... ($cmd)\n"
+ eval "$cmd"
+ docbook_pdf_size=`calcsize $PACKAGE-db.pdf`
+ mv $PACKAGE-db.pdf "$outdir/"
+fi
+
+#
+printf "\nMaking index.html for $PACKAGE...\n"
+if test -z "$use_texi2html"; then
+ CONDS="/%%IF *HTML_SECTION%%/,/%%ENDIF *HTML_SECTION%%/d;\
+ /%%IF *HTML_CHAPTER%%/,/%%ENDIF *HTML_CHAPTER%%/d"
+else
+ # should take account of --split here.
+ CONDS="/%%ENDIF.*%%/d;/%%IF *HTML_SECTION%%/d;/%%IF *HTML_CHAPTER%%/d"
+fi
+
+curdate=`$SETLANG date '+%B %d, %Y'`
+sed \
+ -e "s!%%TITLE%%!$MANUAL_TITLE!g" \
+ -e "s!%%EMAIL%%!$EMAIL!g" \
+ -e "s!%%PACKAGE%%!$PACKAGE!g" \
+ -e "s!%%DATE%%!$curdate!g" \
+ -e "s!%%HTML_MONO_SIZE%%!$html_mono_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%HTML_MONO_GZ_SIZE%%!$html_mono_gz_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%HTML_NODE_TGZ_SIZE%%!$html_node_tgz_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%HTML_SECTION_TGZ_SIZE%%!$html_section_tgz_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%HTML_CHAPTER_TGZ_SIZE%%!$html_chapter_tgz_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%INFO_TGZ_SIZE%%!$info_tgz_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%DVI_GZ_SIZE%%!$dvi_gz_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%PDF_SIZE%%!$pdf_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%ASCII_SIZE%%!$ascii_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%ASCII_GZ_SIZE%%!$ascii_gz_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%TEXI_TGZ_SIZE%%!$texi_tgz_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%DOCBOOK_HTML_NODE_TGZ_SIZE%%!$html_node_db_tgz_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%DOCBOOK_ASCII_SIZE%%!$docbook_ascii_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%DOCBOOK_PDF_SIZE%%!$docbook_pdf_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%DOCBOOK_XML_SIZE%%!$docbook_xml_size!g" \
+ -e "s!%%DOCBOOK_XML_GZ_SIZE%%!$docbook_xml_gz_size!g" \
+ -e "s,%%SCRIPTURL%%,$scripturl,g" \
+ -e "s!%%SCRIPTNAME%%!$prog!g" \
+ -e "$CONDS" \
+$GENDOCS_TEMPLATE_DIR/gendocs_template >"$outdir/index.html"
+
+echo "Done, see $outdir/ subdirectory for new files."
+
+# Local variables:
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/git-version-gen b/build-aux/git-version-gen
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..6c56147
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/git-version-gen
@@ -0,0 +1,226 @@
+#!/bin/sh
+# Print a version string.
+scriptversion=2016-01-11.22; # UTC
+
+# Copyright (C) 2007-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
+# (at your option) any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# This script is derived from GIT-VERSION-GEN from GIT: http://git.or.cz/.
+# It may be run two ways:
+# - from a git repository in which the "git describe" command below
+# produces useful output (thus requiring at least one signed tag)
+# - from a non-git-repo directory containing a .tarball-version file, which
+# presumes this script is invoked like "./git-version-gen .tarball-version".
+
+# In order to use intra-version strings in your project, you will need two
+# separate generated version string files:
+#
+# .tarball-version - present only in a distribution tarball, and not in
+# a checked-out repository. Created with contents that were learned at
+# the last time autoconf was run, and used by git-version-gen. Must not
+# be present in either $(srcdir) or $(builddir) for git-version-gen to
+# give accurate answers during normal development with a checked out tree,
+# but must be present in a tarball when there is no version control system.
+# Therefore, it cannot be used in any dependencies. GNUmakefile has
+# hooks to force a reconfigure at distribution time to get the value
+# correct, without penalizing normal development with extra reconfigures.
+#
+# .version - present in a checked-out repository and in a distribution
+# tarball. Usable in dependencies, particularly for files that don't
+# want to depend on config.h but do want to track version changes.
+# Delete this file prior to any autoconf run where you want to rebuild
+# files to pick up a version string change; and leave it stale to
+# minimize rebuild time after unrelated changes to configure sources.
+#
+# As with any generated file in a VC'd directory, you should add
+# /.version to .gitignore, so that you don't accidentally commit it.
+# .tarball-version is never generated in a VC'd directory, so needn't
+# be listed there.
+#
+# Use the following line in your configure.ac, so that $(VERSION) will
+# automatically be up-to-date each time configure is run (and note that
+# since configure.ac no longer includes a version string, Makefile rules
+# should not depend on configure.ac for version updates).
+#
+# AC_INIT([GNU project],
+# m4_esyscmd([build-aux/git-version-gen .tarball-version]),
+# [bug-project@example])
+#
+# Then use the following lines in your Makefile.am, so that .version
+# will be present for dependencies, and so that .version and
+# .tarball-version will exist in distribution tarballs.
+#
+# EXTRA_DIST = $(top_srcdir)/.version
+# BUILT_SOURCES = $(top_srcdir)/.version
+# $(top_srcdir)/.version:
+# echo $(VERSION) > $@-t && mv $@-t $@
+# dist-hook:
+# echo $(VERSION) > $(distdir)/.tarball-version
+
+
+me=$0
+
+version="git-version-gen $scriptversion
+
+Copyright 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+There is NO warranty. You may redistribute this software
+under the terms of the GNU General Public License.
+For more information about these matters, see the files named COPYING."
+
+usage="\
+Usage: $me [OPTION]... \$srcdir/.tarball-version [TAG-NORMALIZATION-SED-SCRIPT]
+Print a version string.
+
+Options:
+
+ --prefix PREFIX prefix of git tags (default 'v')
+ --fallback VERSION
+ fallback version to use if \"git --version\" fails
+
+ --help display this help and exit
+ --version output version information and exit
+
+Running without arguments will suffice in most cases."
+
+prefix=v
+fallback=
+
+while test $# -gt 0; do
+ case $1 in
+ --help) echo "$usage"; exit 0;;
+ --version) echo "$version"; exit 0;;
+ --prefix) shift; prefix="$1";;
+ --fallback) shift; fallback="$1";;
+ -*)
+ echo "$0: Unknown option '$1'." >&2
+ echo "$0: Try '--help' for more information." >&2
+ exit 1;;
+ *)
+ if test "x$tarball_version_file" = x; then
+ tarball_version_file="$1"
+ elif test "x$tag_sed_script" = x; then
+ tag_sed_script="$1"
+ else
+ echo "$0: extra non-option argument '$1'." >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi;;
+ esac
+ shift
+done
+
+if test "x$tarball_version_file" = x; then
+ echo "$usage"
+ exit 1
+fi
+
+tag_sed_script="${tag_sed_script:-s/x/x/}"
+
+nl='
+'
+
+# Avoid meddling by environment variable of the same name.
+v=
+v_from_git=
+
+# First see if there is a tarball-only version file.
+# then try "git describe", then default.
+if test -f $tarball_version_file
+then
+ v=`cat $tarball_version_file` || v=
+ case $v in
+ *$nl*) v= ;; # reject multi-line output
+ [0-9]*) ;;
+ *) v= ;;
+ esac
+ test "x$v" = x \
+ && echo "$0: WARNING: $tarball_version_file is missing or damaged" 1>&2
+fi
+
+if test "x$v" != x
+then
+ : # use $v
+# Otherwise, if there is at least one git commit involving the working
+# directory, and "git describe" output looks sensible, use that to
+# derive a version string.
+elif test "`git log -1 --pretty=format:x . 2>&1`" = x \
+ && v=`git describe --abbrev=4 --match="$prefix*" HEAD 2>/dev/null \
+ || git describe --abbrev=4 HEAD 2>/dev/null` \
+ && v=`printf '%s\n' "$v" | sed "$tag_sed_script"` \
+ && case $v in
+ $prefix[0-9]*) ;;
+ *) (exit 1) ;;
+ esac
+then
+ # Is this a new git that lists number of commits since the last
+ # tag or the previous older version that did not?
+ # Newer: v6.10-77-g0f8faeb
+ # Older: v6.10-g0f8faeb
+ case $v in
+ *-*-*) : git describe is okay three part flavor ;;
+ *-*)
+ : git describe is older two part flavor
+ # Recreate the number of commits and rewrite such that the
+ # result is the same as if we were using the newer version
+ # of git describe.
+ vtag=`echo "$v" | sed 's/-.*//'`
+ commit_list=`git rev-list "$vtag"..HEAD 2>/dev/null` \
+ || { commit_list=failed;
+ echo "$0: WARNING: git rev-list failed" 1>&2; }
+ numcommits=`echo "$commit_list" | wc -l`
+ v=`echo "$v" | sed "s/\(.*\)-\(.*\)/\1-$numcommits-\2/"`;
+ test "$commit_list" = failed && v=UNKNOWN
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Change the first '-' to a '.', so version-comparing tools work properly.
+ # Remove the "g" in git describe's output string, to save a byte.
+ v=`echo "$v" | sed 's/-/./;s/\(.*\)-g/\1-/'`;
+ v_from_git=1
+elif test "x$fallback" = x || git --version >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ v=UNKNOWN
+else
+ v=$fallback
+fi
+
+v=`echo "$v" |sed "s/^$prefix//"`
+
+# Test whether to append the "-dirty" suffix only if the version
+# string we're using came from git. I.e., skip the test if it's "UNKNOWN"
+# or if it came from .tarball-version.
+if test "x$v_from_git" != x; then
+ # Don't declare a version "dirty" merely because a time stamp has changed.
+ git update-index --refresh > /dev/null 2>&1
+
+ dirty=`exec 2>/dev/null;git diff-index --name-only HEAD` || dirty=
+ case "$dirty" in
+ '') ;;
+ *) # Append the suffix only if there isn't one already.
+ case $v in
+ *-dirty) ;;
+ *) v="$v-dirty" ;;
+ esac ;;
+ esac
+fi
+
+# Omit the trailing newline, so that m4_esyscmd can use the result directly.
+printf %s "$v"
+
+# Local variables:
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/gitlog-to-changelog b/build-aux/gitlog-to-changelog
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..a2513d0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/gitlog-to-changelog
@@ -0,0 +1,492 @@
+eval '(exit $?0)' && eval 'exec perl -wS "$0" "$@"'
+ & eval 'exec perl -wS "$0" $argv:q'
+ if 0;
+# Convert git log output to ChangeLog format.
+
+my $VERSION = '2016-01-12 23:09'; # UTC
+# The definition above must lie within the first 8 lines in order
+# for the Emacs time-stamp write hook (at end) to update it.
+# If you change this file with Emacs, please let the write hook
+# do its job. Otherwise, update this string manually.
+
+# Copyright (C) 2008-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
+# (at your option) any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# Written by Jim Meyering
+
+use strict;
+use warnings;
+use Getopt::Long;
+use POSIX qw(strftime);
+
+(my $ME = $0) =~ s|.*/||;
+
+# use File::Coda; # http://meyering.net/code/Coda/
+END {
+ defined fileno STDOUT or return;
+ close STDOUT and return;
+ warn "$ME: failed to close standard output: $!\n";
+ $? ||= 1;
+}
+
+sub usage ($)
+{
+ my ($exit_code) = @_;
+ my $STREAM = ($exit_code == 0 ? *STDOUT : *STDERR);
+ if ($exit_code != 0)
+ {
+ print $STREAM "Try '$ME --help' for more information.\n";
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ print $STREAM <<EOF;
+Usage: $ME [OPTIONS] [ARGS]
+
+Convert git log output to ChangeLog format. If present, any ARGS
+are passed to "git log". To avoid ARGS being parsed as options to
+$ME, they may be preceded by '--'.
+
+OPTIONS:
+
+ --amend=FILE FILE maps from an SHA1 to perl code (i.e., s/old/new/) that
+ makes a change to SHA1's commit log text or metadata.
+ --append-dot append a dot to the first line of each commit message if
+ there is no other punctuation or blank at the end.
+ --no-cluster never cluster commit messages under the same date/author
+ header; the default is to cluster adjacent commit messages
+ if their headers are the same and neither commit message
+ contains multiple paragraphs.
+ --srcdir=DIR the root of the source tree, from which the .git/
+ directory can be derived.
+ --since=DATE convert only the logs since DATE;
+ the default is to convert all log entries.
+ --until=DATE convert only the logs older than DATE.
+ --ignore-matching=PAT ignore commit messages whose first lines match PAT.
+ --ignore-line=PAT ignore lines of commit messages that match PAT.
+ --format=FMT set format string for commit subject and body;
+ see 'man git-log' for the list of format metacharacters;
+ the default is '%s%n%b%n'
+ --strip-tab remove one additional leading TAB from commit message lines.
+ --strip-cherry-pick remove data inserted by "git cherry-pick";
+ this includes the "cherry picked from commit ..." line,
+ and the possible final "Conflicts:" paragraph.
+ --help display this help and exit
+ --version output version information and exit
+
+EXAMPLE:
+
+ $ME --since=2008-01-01 > ChangeLog
+ $ME -- -n 5 foo > last-5-commits-to-branch-foo
+
+SPECIAL SYNTAX:
+
+The following types of strings are interpreted specially when they appear
+at the beginning of a log message line. They are not copied to the output.
+
+ Copyright-paperwork-exempt: Yes
+ Append the "(tiny change)" notation to the usual "date name email"
+ ChangeLog header to mark a change that does not require a copyright
+ assignment.
+ Co-authored-by: Joe User <user\@example.com>
+ List the specified name and email address on a second
+ ChangeLog header, denoting a co-author.
+ Signed-off-by: Joe User <user\@example.com>
+ These lines are simply elided.
+
+In a FILE specified via --amend, comment lines (starting with "#") are ignored.
+FILE must consist of <SHA,CODE+> pairs where SHA is a 40-byte SHA1 (alone on
+a line) referring to a commit in the current project, and CODE refers to one
+or more consecutive lines of Perl code. Pairs must be separated by one or
+more blank line.
+
+Here is sample input for use with --amend=FILE, from coreutils:
+
+3a169f4c5d9159283548178668d2fae6fced3030
+# fix typo in title:
+s/all tile types/all file types/
+
+1379ed974f1fa39b12e2ffab18b3f7a607082202
+# Due to a bug in vc-dwim, I mis-attributed a patch by Paul to myself.
+# Change the author to be Paul. Note the escaped "@":
+s,Jim .*>,Paul Eggert <eggert\\\@cs.ucla.edu>,
+
+EOF
+ }
+ exit $exit_code;
+}
+
+# If the string $S is a well-behaved file name, simply return it.
+# If it contains white space, quotes, etc., quote it, and return the new string.
+sub shell_quote($)
+{
+ my ($s) = @_;
+ if ($s =~ m![^\w+/.,-]!)
+ {
+ # Convert each single quote to '\''
+ $s =~ s/\'/\'\\\'\'/g;
+ # Then single quote the string.
+ $s = "'$s'";
+ }
+ return $s;
+}
+
+sub quoted_cmd(@)
+{
+ return join (' ', map {shell_quote $_} @_);
+}
+
+# Parse file F.
+# Comment lines (starting with "#") are ignored.
+# F must consist of <SHA,CODE+> pairs where SHA is a 40-byte SHA1
+# (alone on a line) referring to a commit in the current project, and
+# CODE refers to one or more consecutive lines of Perl code.
+# Pairs must be separated by one or more blank line.
+sub parse_amend_file($)
+{
+ my ($f) = @_;
+
+ open F, '<', $f
+ or die "$ME: $f: failed to open for reading: $!\n";
+
+ my $fail;
+ my $h = {};
+ my $in_code = 0;
+ my $sha;
+ while (defined (my $line = <F>))
+ {
+ $line =~ /^\#/
+ and next;
+ chomp $line;
+ $line eq ''
+ and $in_code = 0, next;
+
+ if (!$in_code)
+ {
+ $line =~ /^([0-9a-fA-F]{40})$/
+ or (warn "$ME: $f:$.: invalid line; expected an SHA1\n"),
+ $fail = 1, next;
+ $sha = lc $1;
+ $in_code = 1;
+ exists $h->{$sha}
+ and (warn "$ME: $f:$.: duplicate SHA1\n"),
+ $fail = 1, next;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ $h->{$sha} ||= '';
+ $h->{$sha} .= "$line\n";
+ }
+ }
+ close F;
+
+ $fail
+ and exit 1;
+
+ return $h;
+}
+
+# git_dir_option $SRCDIR
+#
+# From $SRCDIR, the --git-dir option to pass to git (none if $SRCDIR
+# is undef). Return as a list (0 or 1 element).
+sub git_dir_option($)
+{
+ my ($srcdir) = @_;
+ my @res = ();
+ if (defined $srcdir)
+ {
+ my $qdir = shell_quote $srcdir;
+ my $cmd = "cd $qdir && git rev-parse --show-toplevel";
+ my $qcmd = shell_quote $cmd;
+ my $git_dir = qx($cmd);
+ defined $git_dir
+ or die "$ME: cannot run $qcmd: $!\n";
+ $? == 0
+ or die "$ME: $qcmd had unexpected exit code or signal ($?)\n";
+ chomp $git_dir;
+ push @res, "--git-dir=$git_dir/.git";
+ }
+ @res;
+}
+
+{
+ my $since_date;
+ my $until_date;
+ my $format_string = '%s%n%b%n';
+ my $amend_file;
+ my $append_dot = 0;
+ my $cluster = 1;
+ my $ignore_matching;
+ my $ignore_line;
+ my $strip_tab = 0;
+ my $strip_cherry_pick = 0;
+ my $srcdir;
+ GetOptions
+ (
+ help => sub { usage 0 },
+ version => sub { print "$ME version $VERSION\n"; exit },
+ 'since=s' => \$since_date,
+ 'until=s' => \$until_date,
+ 'format=s' => \$format_string,
+ 'amend=s' => \$amend_file,
+ 'append-dot' => \$append_dot,
+ 'cluster!' => \$cluster,
+ 'ignore-matching=s' => \$ignore_matching,
+ 'ignore-line=s' => \$ignore_line,
+ 'strip-tab' => \$strip_tab,
+ 'strip-cherry-pick' => \$strip_cherry_pick,
+ 'srcdir=s' => \$srcdir,
+ ) or usage 1;
+
+ defined $since_date
+ and unshift @ARGV, "--since=$since_date";
+ defined $until_date
+ and unshift @ARGV, "--until=$until_date";
+
+ # This is a hash that maps an SHA1 to perl code (i.e., s/old/new/)
+ # that makes a correction in the log or attribution of that commit.
+ my $amend_code = defined $amend_file ? parse_amend_file $amend_file : {};
+
+ my @cmd = ('git',
+ git_dir_option $srcdir,
+ qw(log --log-size),
+ '--pretty=format:%H:%ct %an <%ae>%n%n'.$format_string, @ARGV);
+ open PIPE, '-|', @cmd
+ or die ("$ME: failed to run '". quoted_cmd (@cmd) ."': $!\n"
+ . "(Is your Git too old? Version 1.5.1 or later is required.)\n");
+
+ my $prev_multi_paragraph;
+ my $prev_date_line = '';
+ my @prev_coauthors = ();
+ my @skipshas = ();
+ while (1)
+ {
+ defined (my $in = <PIPE>)
+ or last;
+ $in =~ /^log size (\d+)$/
+ or die "$ME:$.: Invalid line (expected log size):\n$in";
+ my $log_nbytes = $1;
+
+ my $log;
+ my $n_read = read PIPE, $log, $log_nbytes;
+ $n_read == $log_nbytes
+ or die "$ME:$.: unexpected EOF\n";
+
+ # Extract leading hash.
+ my ($sha, $rest) = split ':', $log, 2;
+ defined $sha
+ or die "$ME:$.: malformed log entry\n";
+ $sha =~ /^[0-9a-fA-F]{40}$/
+ or die "$ME:$.: invalid SHA1: $sha\n";
+
+ my $skipflag = 0;
+ if (@skipshas)
+ {
+ foreach(@skipshas)
+ {
+ if ($sha =~ /^$_/)
+ {
+ $skipflag = 1;
+ ## Perhaps only warn if a pattern matches more than once?
+ warn "$ME: warning: skipping $sha due to $_\n";
+ last;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ # If this commit's log requires any transformation, do it now.
+ my $code = $amend_code->{$sha};
+ if (defined $code)
+ {
+ eval 'use Safe';
+ my $s = new Safe;
+ # Put the unpreprocessed entry into "$_".
+ $_ = $rest;
+
+ # Let $code operate on it, safely.
+ my $r = $s->reval("$code")
+ or die "$ME:$.:$sha: failed to eval \"$code\":\n$@\n";
+
+ # Note that we've used this entry.
+ delete $amend_code->{$sha};
+
+ # Update $rest upon success.
+ $rest = $_;
+ }
+
+ # Remove lines inserted by "git cherry-pick".
+ if ($strip_cherry_pick)
+ {
+ $rest =~ s/^\s*Conflicts:\n.*//sm;
+ $rest =~ s/^\s*\(cherry picked from commit [\da-f]+\)\n//m;
+ }
+
+ my @line = split /[ \t]*\n/, $rest;
+ my $author_line = shift @line;
+ defined $author_line
+ or die "$ME:$.: unexpected EOF\n";
+ $author_line =~ /^(\d+) (.*>)$/
+ or die "$ME:$.: Invalid line "
+ . "(expected date/author/email):\n$author_line\n";
+
+ # Format 'Copyright-paperwork-exempt: Yes' as a standard ChangeLog
+ # `(tiny change)' annotation.
+ my $tiny = (grep (/^(?:Copyright-paperwork-exempt|Tiny-change):\s+[Yy]es$/, @line)
+ ? ' (tiny change)' : '');
+
+ my $date_line = sprintf "%s %s$tiny\n",
+ strftime ("%Y-%m-%d", localtime ($1)), $2;
+
+ my @coauthors = grep /^Co-authored-by:.*$/, @line;
+ # Omit meta-data lines we've already interpreted.
+ @line = grep !/^(?:Signed-off-by:[ ].*>$
+ |Co-authored-by:[ ]
+ |Copyright-paperwork-exempt:[ ]
+ |Tiny-change:[ ]
+ )/x, @line;
+
+ # Remove leading and trailing blank lines.
+ if (@line)
+ {
+ while ($line[0] =~ /^\s*$/) { shift @line; }
+ while ($line[$#line] =~ /^\s*$/) { pop @line; }
+ }
+
+ # Handle Emacs gitmerge.el "skipped" commits.
+ # Yes, this should be controlled by an option. So sue me.
+ if ( grep /^(; )?Merge from /, @line )
+ {
+ my $found = 0;
+ foreach (@line)
+ {
+ if (grep /^The following commit.*skipped:$/, $_)
+ {
+ $found = 1;
+ ## Reset at each merge to reduce chance of false matches.
+ @skipshas = ();
+ next;
+ }
+ if ($found && $_ =~ /^([0-9a-fA-F]{7,}) [^ ]/)
+ {
+ push ( @skipshas, $1 );
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ # Ignore commits that match the --ignore-matching pattern, if specified.
+ if (! ($skipflag || (defined $ignore_matching
+ && @line && $line[0] =~ /$ignore_matching/)))
+ {
+ if (defined $ignore_line && @line)
+ {
+ @line = grep ! /$ignore_line/, @line;
+ while ($line[$#line] =~ /^\s*$/) { pop @line; }
+ }
+
+ # Record whether there are two or more paragraphs.
+ my $multi_paragraph = grep /^\s*$/, @line;
+
+ # Format 'Co-authored-by: A U Thor <email@example.com>' lines in
+ # standard multi-author ChangeLog format.
+ for (@coauthors)
+ {
+ s/^Co-authored-by:\s*/\t /;
+ s/\s*</ </;
+
+ /<.*?@.*\..*>/
+ or warn "$ME: warning: missing email address for "
+ . substr ($_, 5) . "\n";
+ }
+
+ # If clustering of commit messages has been disabled, if this header
+ # would be different from the previous date/name/etc. header,
+ # or if this or the previous entry consists of two or more paragraphs,
+ # then print the header.
+ if ( ! $cluster
+ || $date_line ne $prev_date_line
+ || "@coauthors" ne "@prev_coauthors"
+ || $multi_paragraph
+ || $prev_multi_paragraph)
+ {
+ $prev_date_line eq ''
+ or print "\n";
+ print $date_line;
+ @coauthors
+ and print join ("\n", @coauthors), "\n";
+ }
+ $prev_date_line = $date_line;
+ @prev_coauthors = @coauthors;
+ $prev_multi_paragraph = $multi_paragraph;
+
+ # If there were any lines
+ if (@line == 0)
+ {
+ warn "$ME: warning: empty commit message:\n $date_line\n";
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if ($append_dot)
+ {
+ # If the first line of the message has enough room, then
+ if (length $line[0] < 72)
+ {
+ # append a dot if there is no other punctuation or blank
+ # at the end.
+ $line[0] =~ /[[:punct:]\s]$/
+ or $line[0] .= '.';
+ }
+ }
+
+ # Remove one additional leading TAB from each line.
+ $strip_tab
+ and map { s/^\t// } @line;
+
+ # Prefix each non-empty line with a TAB.
+ @line = map { length $_ ? "\t$_" : '' } @line;
+
+ print "\n", join ("\n", @line), "\n";
+ }
+ }
+
+ defined ($in = <PIPE>)
+ or last;
+ $in ne "\n"
+ and die "$ME:$.: unexpected line:\n$in";
+ }
+
+ close PIPE
+ or die "$ME: error closing pipe from " . quoted_cmd (@cmd) . "\n";
+ # FIXME-someday: include $PROCESS_STATUS in the diagnostic
+
+ # Complain about any unused entry in the --amend=F specified file.
+ my $fail = 0;
+ foreach my $sha (keys %$amend_code)
+ {
+ warn "$ME:$amend_file: unused entry: $sha\n";
+ $fail = 1;
+ }
+
+ exit $fail;
+}
+
+# Local Variables:
+# mode: perl
+# indent-tabs-mode: nil
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "my $VERSION = '"
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d %02H:%02M"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "'; # UTC"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/gnu-web-doc-update b/build-aux/gnu-web-doc-update
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..ec21168
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/gnu-web-doc-update
@@ -0,0 +1,209 @@
+#!/bin/sh
+# Run this after each non-alpha release, to update the web documentation at
+# http://www.gnu.org/software/$pkg/manual/
+
+VERSION=2016-01-12.23; # UTC
+
+# Copyright (C) 2009-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
+# (at your option) any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+ME=$(basename "$0")
+warn() { printf '%s: %s\n' "$ME" "$*" >&2; }
+die() { warn "$*"; exit 1; }
+
+help()
+{
+ cat <<EOF
+Usage: $ME
+
+Run this script from top_srcdir (no arguments) after each non-alpha
+release, to update the web documentation at
+http://www.gnu.org/software/\$pkg/manual/
+
+This script assumes you're using git for revision control, and
+requires a .prev-version file as well as a Makefile, from which it
+extracts the version number and package name, respectively. Also, it
+assumes all documentation is in the doc/ sub-directory.
+
+Options:
+ -C, --builddir=DIR location of (configured) Makefile (default: .)
+ -n, --dry-run don't actually commit anything
+ -m, --mirror remove out of date files from document server
+ --help print this help, then exit
+ --version print version number, then exit
+
+Report bugs and patches to <bug-gnulib@gnu.org>.
+EOF
+ exit
+}
+
+version()
+{
+ year=$(echo "$VERSION" | sed 's/[^0-9].*//')
+ cat <<EOF
+$ME $VERSION
+Copyright (C) $year Free Software Foundation, Inc,
+License GPLv3+: GNU GPL version 3 or later <http://gnu.org/licenses/gpl.html>
+This is free software: you are free to change and redistribute it.
+There is NO WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law.
+EOF
+ exit
+}
+
+# find_tool ENVVAR NAMES...
+# -------------------------
+# Search for a required program. Use the value of ENVVAR, if set,
+# otherwise find the first of the NAMES that can be run (i.e.,
+# supports --version). If found, set ENVVAR to the program name,
+# die otherwise.
+#
+# FIXME: code duplication, see also bootstrap.
+find_tool ()
+{
+ find_tool_envvar=$1
+ shift
+ find_tool_names=$@
+ eval "find_tool_res=\$$find_tool_envvar"
+ if test x"$find_tool_res" = x; then
+ for i
+ do
+ if ($i --version </dev/null) >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ find_tool_res=$i
+ break
+ fi
+ done
+ else
+ find_tool_error_prefix="\$$find_tool_envvar: "
+ fi
+ test x"$find_tool_res" != x \
+ || die "one of these is required: $find_tool_names"
+ ($find_tool_res --version </dev/null) >/dev/null 2>&1 \
+ || die "${find_tool_error_prefix}cannot run $find_tool_res --version"
+ eval "$find_tool_envvar=\$find_tool_res"
+ eval "export $find_tool_envvar"
+}
+
+## ------ ##
+## Main. ##
+## ------ ##
+
+# Requirements: everything required to bootstrap your package, plus
+# these.
+find_tool CVS cvs
+find_tool GIT git
+find_tool RSYNC rsync
+find_tool XARGS gxargs xargs
+
+builddir=.
+dryrun=
+rm_stale='echo'
+while test $# != 0
+do
+ # Handle --option=value by splitting apart and putting back on argv.
+ case $1 in
+ --*=*)
+ opt=$(echo "$1" | sed -e 's/=.*//')
+ val=$(echo "$1" | sed -e 's/[^=]*=//')
+ shift
+ set dummy "$opt" "$val" "$@"; shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ case $1 in
+ --help|--version) ${1#--};;
+ -C|--builddir) shift; builddir=$1; shift ;;
+ -n|--dry-run) dryrun=echo; shift;;
+ -m|--mirror) rm_stale=''; shift;;
+ --*) die "unrecognized option: $1";;
+ *) break;;
+ esac
+done
+
+test $# = 0 \
+ || die "too many arguments"
+
+prev=.prev-version
+version=$(cat $prev) || die "no $prev file?"
+pkg=$(sed -n 's/^PACKAGE = \(.*\)/\1/p' $builddir/Makefile) \
+ || die "no Makefile?"
+tmp_branch=web-doc-$version-$$
+current_branch=$($GIT branch | sed -ne '/^\* /{s///;p;q;}')
+
+cleanup()
+{
+ __st=$?
+ $dryrun rm -rf "$tmp"
+ $GIT checkout "$current_branch"
+ $GIT submodule update --recursive
+ $GIT branch -d $tmp_branch
+ exit $__st
+}
+trap cleanup 0
+trap 'exit $?' 1 2 13 15
+
+# We must build using sources for which --version reports the
+# just-released version number, not some string like 7.6.18-20761.
+# That version string propagates into all documentation.
+set -e
+$GIT checkout -b $tmp_branch v$version
+$GIT submodule update --recursive
+./bootstrap
+srcdir=$(pwd)
+cd "$builddir"
+builddir=$(pwd)
+ ./config.status --recheck
+ ./config.status
+ make
+ make web-manual
+cd "$srcdir"
+set +e
+
+tmp=$(mktemp -d web-doc-update.XXXXXX) || exit 1
+( cd $tmp \
+ && $CVS -d $USER@cvs.sv.gnu.org:/webcvs/$pkg co $pkg )
+$RSYNC -avP "$builddir"/doc/manual/ $tmp/$pkg/manual
+
+(
+ cd $tmp/$pkg/manual
+
+ # Add all the files. This is simpler than trying to add only the
+ # new ones because of new directories: it would require iterating on
+ # adding the outer directories, and then their contents.
+ #
+ # find guarantees that we add outer directories first.
+ find . -name CVS -prune -o -print \
+ | $XARGS --no-run-if-empty -- $dryrun $CVS add -ko
+
+ # Report/Remove stale files
+ # excluding doc server specific files like CVS/* and .symlinks
+ if test -n "$rm_stale"; then
+ echo 'Consider the --mirror option if all of the manual is generated,' >&2
+ echo 'which will run `cvs remove` to remove stale files.' >&2
+ fi
+ { find . \( -name CVS -o -type f -name '.*' \) -prune -o -type f -print
+ (cd "$builddir"/doc/manual/ && find . -type f -print | sed p)
+ } | sort | uniq -u \
+ | $XARGS --no-run-if-empty -- ${rm_stale:-$dryrun} $CVS remove -f
+
+ $dryrun $CVS ci -m $version
+)
+
+# Local variables:
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "VERSION="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/gnupload b/build-aux/gnupload
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..8d0299d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/gnupload
@@ -0,0 +1,440 @@
+#!/bin/sh
+# Sign files and upload them.
+
+scriptversion=2016-01-11.22; # UTC
+
+# Copyright (C) 2004-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# Originally written by Alexandre Duret-Lutz <adl@gnu.org>.
+# The master copy of this file is maintained in the gnulib Git repository.
+# Please send bug reports and feature requests to bug-gnulib@gnu.org.
+
+set -e
+
+GPG='gpg --batch --no-tty'
+conffile=.gnuploadrc
+to=
+dry_run=false
+replace=
+symlink_files=
+delete_files=
+delete_symlinks=
+collect_var=
+dbg=
+nl='
+'
+
+usage="Usage: $0 [OPTION]... [CMD] FILE... [[CMD] FILE...]
+
+Sign all FILES, and process them at the destinations specified with --to.
+If CMD is not given, it defaults to uploading. See examples below.
+
+Commands:
+ --delete delete FILES from destination
+ --symlink create symbolic links
+ --rmsymlink remove symbolic links
+ -- treat the remaining arguments as files to upload
+
+Options:
+ --to DEST specify a destination DEST for FILES
+ (multiple --to options are allowed)
+ --user NAME sign with key NAME
+ --replace allow replacements of existing files
+ --symlink-regex[=EXPR] use sed script EXPR to compute symbolic link names
+ --dry-run do nothing, show what would have been done
+ (including the constructed directive file)
+ --version output version information and exit
+ --help print this help text and exit
+
+If --symlink-regex is given without EXPR, then the link target name
+is created by replacing the version information with '-latest', e.g.:
+ foo-1.3.4.tar.gz -> foo-latest.tar.gz
+
+Recognized destinations are:
+ alpha.gnu.org:DIRECTORY
+ savannah.gnu.org:DIRECTORY
+ savannah.nongnu.org:DIRECTORY
+ ftp.gnu.org:DIRECTORY
+ build directive files and upload files by FTP
+ download.gnu.org.ua:{alpha|ftp}/DIRECTORY
+ build directive files and upload files by SFTP
+ [user@]host:DIRECTORY upload files with scp
+
+Options and commands are applied in order. If the file $conffile exists
+in the current working directory, its contents are prepended to the
+actual command line options. Use this to keep your defaults. Comments
+(#) and empty lines in $conffile are allowed.
+
+<http://www.gnu.org/prep/maintain/html_node/Automated-FTP-Uploads.html>
+gives some further background.
+
+Examples:
+1. Upload foobar-1.0.tar.gz to ftp.gnu.org:
+ gnupload --to ftp.gnu.org:foobar foobar-1.0.tar.gz
+
+2. Upload foobar-1.0.tar.gz and foobar-1.0.tar.xz to ftp.gnu.org:
+ gnupload --to ftp.gnu.org:foobar foobar-1.0.tar.gz foobar-1.0.tar.xz
+
+3. Same as above, and also create symbolic links to foobar-latest.tar.*:
+ gnupload --to ftp.gnu.org:foobar \\
+ --symlink-regex \\
+ foobar-1.0.tar.gz foobar-1.0.tar.xz
+
+4. Upload foobar-0.9.90.tar.gz to two sites:
+ gnupload --to alpha.gnu.org:foobar \\
+ --to sources.redhat.com:~ftp/pub/foobar \\
+ foobar-0.9.90.tar.gz
+
+5. Delete oopsbar-0.9.91.tar.gz and upload foobar-0.9.91.tar.gz
+ (the -- terminates the list of files to delete):
+ gnupload --to alpha.gnu.org:foobar \\
+ --to sources.redhat.com:~ftp/pub/foobar \\
+ --delete oopsbar-0.9.91.tar.gz \\
+ -- foobar-0.9.91.tar.gz
+
+gnupload executes a program ncftpput to do the transfers; if you don't
+happen to have an ncftp package installed, the ncftpput-ftp script in
+the build-aux/ directory of the gnulib package
+(http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/gnulib) may serve as a replacement.
+
+Send patches and bug reports to <bug-gnulib@gnu.org>."
+
+# Read local configuration file
+if test -r "$conffile"; then
+ echo "$0: Reading configuration file $conffile"
+ conf=`sed 's/#.*$//;/^$/d' "$conffile" | tr "\015$nl" ' '`
+ eval set x "$conf \"\$@\""
+ shift
+fi
+
+while test -n "$1"; do
+ case $1 in
+ -*)
+ collect_var=
+ case $1 in
+ --help)
+ echo "$usage"
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+ --to)
+ if test -z "$2"; then
+ echo "$0: Missing argument for --to" 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ elif echo "$2" | grep 'ftp-upload\.gnu\.org' >/dev/null; then
+ echo "$0: Use ftp.gnu.org:PKGNAME or alpha.gnu.org:PKGNAME" >&2
+ echo "$0: for the destination, not ftp-upload.gnu.org (which" >&2
+ echo "$0: is used for direct ftp uploads, not with gnupload)." >&2
+ echo "$0: See --help and its examples if need be." >&2
+ exit 1
+ else
+ to="$to $2"
+ shift
+ fi
+ ;;
+ --user)
+ if test -z "$2"; then
+ echo "$0: Missing argument for --user" 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ else
+ GPG="$GPG --local-user $2"
+ shift
+ fi
+ ;;
+ --delete)
+ collect_var=delete_files
+ ;;
+ --replace)
+ replace="replace: true"
+ ;;
+ --rmsymlink)
+ collect_var=delete_symlinks
+ ;;
+ --symlink-regex=*)
+ symlink_expr=`expr "$1" : '[^=]*=\(.*\)'`
+ ;;
+ --symlink-regex)
+ symlink_expr='s|-[0-9][0-9\.]*\(-[0-9][0-9]*\)\{0,1\}\.|-latest.|'
+ ;;
+ --symlink)
+ collect_var=symlink_files
+ ;;
+ --dry-run|-n)
+ dry_run=:
+ ;;
+ --version)
+ echo "gnupload $scriptversion"
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+ --)
+ shift
+ break
+ ;;
+ -*)
+ echo "$0: Unknown option '$1', try '$0 --help'" 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ *)
+ if test -z "$collect_var"; then
+ break
+ else
+ eval "$collect_var=\"\$$collect_var $1\""
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ shift
+done
+
+dprint()
+{
+ echo "Running $* ..."
+}
+
+if $dry_run; then
+ dbg=dprint
+fi
+
+if test -z "$to"; then
+ echo "$0: Missing destination sites" >&2
+ exit 1
+fi
+
+if test -n "$symlink_files"; then
+ x=`echo "$symlink_files" | sed 's/[^ ]//g;s/ //g'`
+ if test -n "$x"; then
+ echo "$0: Odd number of symlink arguments" >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
+fi
+
+if test $# = 0; then
+ if test -z "${symlink_files}${delete_files}${delete_symlinks}"; then
+ echo "$0: No file to upload" 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
+else
+ # Make sure all files exist. We don't want to ask
+ # for the passphrase if the script will fail.
+ for file
+ do
+ if test ! -f $file; then
+ echo "$0: Cannot find '$file'" 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ elif test -n "$symlink_expr"; then
+ linkname=`echo $file | sed "$symlink_expr"`
+ if test -z "$linkname"; then
+ echo "$0: symlink expression produces empty results" >&2
+ exit 1
+ elif test "$linkname" = $file; then
+ echo "$0: symlink expression does not alter file name" >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
+ fi
+ done
+fi
+
+# Make sure passphrase is not exported in the environment.
+unset passphrase
+unset passphrase_fd_0
+GNUPGHOME=${GNUPGHOME:-$HOME/.gnupg}
+
+# Reset PATH to be sure that echo is a built-in. We will later use
+# 'echo $passphrase' to output the passphrase, so it is important that
+# it is a built-in (third-party programs tend to appear in 'ps'
+# listings with their arguments...).
+# Remember this script runs with 'set -e', so if echo is not built-in
+# it will exit now.
+if $dry_run || grep -q "^use-agent" $GNUPGHOME/gpg.conf; then :; else
+ PATH=/empty echo -n "Enter GPG passphrase: "
+ stty -echo
+ read -r passphrase
+ stty echo
+ echo
+ passphrase_fd_0="--passphrase-fd 0"
+fi
+
+if test $# -ne 0; then
+ for file
+ do
+ echo "Signing $file ..."
+ rm -f $file.sig
+ echo "$passphrase" | $dbg $GPG $passphrase_fd_0 -ba -o $file.sig $file
+ done
+fi
+
+
+# mkdirective DESTDIR BASE FILE STMT
+# Arguments: See upload, below
+mkdirective ()
+{
+ stmt="$4"
+ if test -n "$3"; then
+ stmt="
+filename: $3$stmt"
+ fi
+
+ cat >${2}.directive<<EOF
+version: 1.2
+directory: $1
+comment: gnupload v. $scriptversion$stmt
+EOF
+ if $dry_run; then
+ echo "File ${2}.directive:"
+ cat ${2}.directive
+ echo "File ${2}.directive:" | sed 's/./-/g'
+ fi
+}
+
+mksymlink ()
+{
+ while test $# -ne 0
+ do
+ echo "symlink: $1 $2"
+ shift
+ shift
+ done
+}
+
+# upload DEST DESTDIR BASE FILE STMT FILES
+# Arguments:
+# DEST Destination site;
+# DESTDIR Destination directory;
+# BASE Base name for the directive file;
+# FILE Name of the file to distribute (may be empty);
+# STMT Additional statements for the directive file;
+# FILES List of files to upload.
+upload ()
+{
+ dest=$1
+ destdir=$2
+ base=$3
+ file=$4
+ stmt=$5
+ files=$6
+
+ rm -f $base.directive $base.directive.asc
+ case $dest in
+ alpha.gnu.org:*)
+ mkdirective "$destdir" "$base" "$file" "$stmt"
+ echo "$passphrase" | $dbg $GPG $passphrase_fd_0 --clearsign $base.directive
+ $dbg ncftpput ftp-upload.gnu.org /incoming/alpha $files $base.directive.asc
+ ;;
+ ftp.gnu.org:*)
+ mkdirective "$destdir" "$base" "$file" "$stmt"
+ echo "$passphrase" | $dbg $GPG $passphrase_fd_0 --clearsign $base.directive
+ $dbg ncftpput ftp-upload.gnu.org /incoming/ftp $files $base.directive.asc
+ ;;
+ savannah.gnu.org:*)
+ if test -z "$files"; then
+ echo "$0: warning: standalone directives not applicable for $dest" >&2
+ fi
+ $dbg ncftpput savannah.gnu.org /incoming/savannah/$destdir $files
+ ;;
+ savannah.nongnu.org:*)
+ if test -z "$files"; then
+ echo "$0: warning: standalone directives not applicable for $dest" >&2
+ fi
+ $dbg ncftpput savannah.nongnu.org /incoming/savannah/$destdir $files
+ ;;
+ download.gnu.org.ua:alpha/*|download.gnu.org.ua:ftp/*)
+ destdir_p1=`echo "$destdir" | sed 's,^[^/]*/,,'`
+ destdir_topdir=`echo "$destdir" | sed 's,/.*,,'`
+ mkdirective "$destdir_p1" "$base" "$file" "$stmt"
+ echo "$passphrase" | $dbg $GPG $passphrase_fd_0 --clearsign $base.directive
+ for f in $files $base.directive.asc
+ do
+ echo put $f
+ done | $dbg sftp -b - puszcza.gnu.org.ua:/incoming/$destdir_topdir
+ ;;
+ /*)
+ dest_host=`echo "$dest" | sed 's,:.*,,'`
+ mkdirective "$destdir" "$base" "$file" "$stmt"
+ echo "$passphrase" | $dbg $GPG $passphrase_fd_0 --clearsign $base.directive
+ $dbg cp $files $base.directive.asc $dest_host
+ ;;
+ *)
+ if test -z "$files"; then
+ echo "$0: warning: standalone directives not applicable for $dest" >&2
+ fi
+ $dbg scp $files $dest
+ ;;
+ esac
+ rm -f $base.directive $base.directive.asc
+}
+
+#####
+# Process any standalone directives
+stmt=
+if test -n "$symlink_files"; then
+ stmt="$stmt
+`mksymlink $symlink_files`"
+fi
+
+for file in $delete_files
+do
+ stmt="$stmt
+archive: $file"
+done
+
+for file in $delete_symlinks
+do
+ stmt="$stmt
+rmsymlink: $file"
+done
+
+if test -n "$stmt"; then
+ for dest in $to
+ do
+ destdir=`echo $dest | sed 's/[^:]*://'`
+ upload "$dest" "$destdir" "`hostname`-$$" "" "$stmt"
+ done
+fi
+
+# Process actual uploads
+for dest in $to
+do
+ for file
+ do
+ echo "Uploading $file to $dest ..."
+ stmt=
+ #
+ # allowing file replacement is all or nothing.
+ if test -n "$replace"; then stmt="$stmt
+$replace"
+ fi
+ #
+ files="$file $file.sig"
+ destdir=`echo $dest | sed 's/[^:]*://'`
+ if test -n "$symlink_expr"; then
+ linkname=`echo $file | sed "$symlink_expr"`
+ stmt="$stmt
+symlink: $file $linkname
+symlink: $file.sig $linkname.sig"
+ fi
+ upload "$dest" "$destdir" "$file" "$file" "$stmt" "$files"
+ done
+done
+
+exit 0
+
+# Local variables:
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/install-sh b/build-aux/install-sh
index a5897de..0360b79 100755
--- a/build-aux/install-sh
+++ b/build-aux/install-sh
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
#!/bin/sh
# install - install a program, script, or datafile
-scriptversion=2006-12-25.00
+scriptversion=2016-01-11.22; # UTC
# This originates from X11R5 (mit/util/scripts/install.sh), which was
# later released in X11R6 (xc/config/util/install.sh) with the
@@ -35,25 +35,21 @@ scriptversion=2006-12-25.00
# FSF changes to this file are in the public domain.
#
# Calling this script install-sh is preferred over install.sh, to prevent
-# `make' implicit rules from creating a file called install from it
+# 'make' implicit rules from creating a file called install from it
# when there is no Makefile.
#
# This script is compatible with the BSD install script, but was written
# from scratch.
+tab=' '
nl='
'
-IFS=" "" $nl"
+IFS=" $tab$nl"
-# set DOITPROG to echo to test this script
+# Set DOITPROG to "echo" to test this script.
-# Don't use :- since 4.3BSD and earlier shells don't like it.
doit=${DOITPROG-}
-if test -z "$doit"; then
- doit_exec=exec
-else
- doit_exec=$doit
-fi
+doit_exec=${doit:-exec}
# Put in absolute file names if you don't have them in your path;
# or use environment vars.
@@ -68,17 +64,6 @@ mvprog=${MVPROG-mv}
rmprog=${RMPROG-rm}
stripprog=${STRIPPROG-strip}
-posix_glob='?'
-initialize_posix_glob='
- test "$posix_glob" != "?" || {
- if (set -f) 2>/dev/null; then
- posix_glob=
- else
- posix_glob=:
- fi
- }
-'
-
posix_mkdir=
# Desired mode of installed file.
@@ -97,7 +82,7 @@ dir_arg=
dst_arg=
copy_on_change=false
-no_target_directory=
+is_target_a_directory=possibly
usage="\
Usage: $0 [OPTION]... [-T] SRCFILE DSTFILE
@@ -137,42 +122,57 @@ while test $# -ne 0; do
-d) dir_arg=true;;
-g) chgrpcmd="$chgrpprog $2"
- shift;;
+ shift;;
--help) echo "$usage"; exit $?;;
-m) mode=$2
- case $mode in
- *' '* | *' '* | *'
-'* | *'*'* | *'?'* | *'['*)
- echo "$0: invalid mode: $mode" >&2
- exit 1;;
- esac
- shift;;
+ case $mode in
+ *' '* | *"$tab"* | *"$nl"* | *'*'* | *'?'* | *'['*)
+ echo "$0: invalid mode: $mode" >&2
+ exit 1;;
+ esac
+ shift;;
-o) chowncmd="$chownprog $2"
- shift;;
+ shift;;
-s) stripcmd=$stripprog;;
- -t) dst_arg=$2
- shift;;
+ -t)
+ is_target_a_directory=always
+ dst_arg=$2
+ # Protect names problematic for 'test' and other utilities.
+ case $dst_arg in
+ -* | [=\(\)!]) dst_arg=./$dst_arg;;
+ esac
+ shift;;
- -T) no_target_directory=true;;
+ -T) is_target_a_directory=never;;
--version) echo "$0 $scriptversion"; exit $?;;
- --) shift
- break;;
+ --) shift
+ break;;
- -*) echo "$0: invalid option: $1" >&2
- exit 1;;
+ -*) echo "$0: invalid option: $1" >&2
+ exit 1;;
*) break;;
esac
shift
done
+# We allow the use of options -d and -T together, by making -d
+# take the precedence; this is for compatibility with GNU install.
+
+if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
+ if test -n "$dst_arg"; then
+ echo "$0: target directory not allowed when installing a directory." >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
+fi
+
if test $# -ne 0 && test -z "$dir_arg$dst_arg"; then
# When -d is used, all remaining arguments are directories to create.
# When -t is used, the destination is already specified.
@@ -186,6 +186,10 @@ if test $# -ne 0 && test -z "$dir_arg$dst_arg"; then
fi
shift # arg
dst_arg=$arg
+ # Protect names problematic for 'test' and other utilities.
+ case $dst_arg in
+ -* | [=\(\)!]) dst_arg=./$dst_arg;;
+ esac
done
fi
@@ -194,13 +198,26 @@ if test $# -eq 0; then
echo "$0: no input file specified." >&2
exit 1
fi
- # It's OK to call `install-sh -d' without argument.
+ # It's OK to call 'install-sh -d' without argument.
# This can happen when creating conditional directories.
exit 0
fi
if test -z "$dir_arg"; then
- trap '(exit $?); exit' 1 2 13 15
+ if test $# -gt 1 || test "$is_target_a_directory" = always; then
+ if test ! -d "$dst_arg"; then
+ echo "$0: $dst_arg: Is not a directory." >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
+ fi
+fi
+
+if test -z "$dir_arg"; then
+ do_exit='(exit $ret); exit $ret'
+ trap "ret=129; $do_exit" 1
+ trap "ret=130; $do_exit" 2
+ trap "ret=141; $do_exit" 13
+ trap "ret=143; $do_exit" 15
# Set umask so as not to create temps with too-generous modes.
# However, 'strip' requires both read and write access to temps.
@@ -211,16 +228,16 @@ if test -z "$dir_arg"; then
*[0-7])
if test -z "$stripcmd"; then
- u_plus_rw=
+ u_plus_rw=
else
- u_plus_rw='% 200'
+ u_plus_rw='% 200'
fi
cp_umask=`expr '(' 777 - $mode % 1000 ')' $u_plus_rw`;;
*)
if test -z "$stripcmd"; then
- u_plus_rw=
+ u_plus_rw=
else
- u_plus_rw=,u+rw
+ u_plus_rw=,u+rw
fi
cp_umask=$mode$u_plus_rw;;
esac
@@ -228,9 +245,9 @@ fi
for src
do
- # Protect names starting with `-'.
+ # Protect names problematic for 'test' and other utilities.
case $src in
- -*) src=./$src;;
+ -* | [=\(\)!]) src=./$src;;
esac
if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
@@ -252,51 +269,20 @@ do
echo "$0: no destination specified." >&2
exit 1
fi
-
dst=$dst_arg
- # Protect names starting with `-'.
- case $dst in
- -*) dst=./$dst;;
- esac
# If destination is a directory, append the input filename; won't work
# if double slashes aren't ignored.
if test -d "$dst"; then
- if test -n "$no_target_directory"; then
- echo "$0: $dst_arg: Is a directory" >&2
- exit 1
+ if test "$is_target_a_directory" = never; then
+ echo "$0: $dst_arg: Is a directory" >&2
+ exit 1
fi
dstdir=$dst
dst=$dstdir/`basename "$src"`
dstdir_status=0
else
- # Prefer dirname, but fall back on a substitute if dirname fails.
- dstdir=`
- (dirname "$dst") 2>/dev/null ||
- expr X"$dst" : 'X\(.*[^/]\)//*[^/][^/]*/*$' \| \
- X"$dst" : 'X\(//\)[^/]' \| \
- X"$dst" : 'X\(//\)$' \| \
- X"$dst" : 'X\(/\)' \| . 2>/dev/null ||
- echo X"$dst" |
- sed '/^X\(.*[^/]\)\/\/*[^/][^/]*\/*$/{
- s//\1/
- q
- }
- /^X\(\/\/\)[^/].*/{
- s//\1/
- q
- }
- /^X\(\/\/\)$/{
- s//\1/
- q
- }
- /^X\(\/\).*/{
- s//\1/
- q
- }
- s/.*/./; q'
- `
-
+ dstdir=`dirname "$dst"`
test -d "$dstdir"
dstdir_status=$?
fi
@@ -307,74 +293,74 @@ do
if test $dstdir_status != 0; then
case $posix_mkdir in
'')
- # Create intermediate dirs using mode 755 as modified by the umask.
- # This is like FreeBSD 'install' as of 1997-10-28.
- umask=`umask`
- case $stripcmd.$umask in
- # Optimize common cases.
- *[2367][2367]) mkdir_umask=$umask;;
- .*0[02][02] | .[02][02] | .[02]) mkdir_umask=22;;
-
- *[0-7])
- mkdir_umask=`expr $umask + 22 \
- - $umask % 100 % 40 + $umask % 20 \
- - $umask % 10 % 4 + $umask % 2
- `;;
- *) mkdir_umask=$umask,go-w;;
- esac
-
- # With -d, create the new directory with the user-specified mode.
- # Otherwise, rely on $mkdir_umask.
- if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
- mkdir_mode=-m$mode
- else
- mkdir_mode=
- fi
-
- posix_mkdir=false
- case $umask in
- *[123567][0-7][0-7])
- # POSIX mkdir -p sets u+wx bits regardless of umask, which
- # is incompatible with FreeBSD 'install' when (umask & 300) != 0.
- ;;
- *)
- tmpdir=${TMPDIR-/tmp}/ins$RANDOM-$$
- trap 'ret=$?; rmdir "$tmpdir/d" "$tmpdir" 2>/dev/null; exit $ret' 0
-
- if (umask $mkdir_umask &&
- exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$tmpdir/d") >/dev/null 2>&1
- then
- if test -z "$dir_arg" || {
- # Check for POSIX incompatibilities with -m.
- # HP-UX 11.23 and IRIX 6.5 mkdir -m -p sets group- or
- # other-writeable bit of parent directory when it shouldn't.
- # FreeBSD 6.1 mkdir -m -p sets mode of existing directory.
- ls_ld_tmpdir=`ls -ld "$tmpdir"`
- case $ls_ld_tmpdir in
- d????-?r-*) different_mode=700;;
- d????-?--*) different_mode=755;;
- *) false;;
- esac &&
- $mkdirprog -m$different_mode -p -- "$tmpdir" && {
- ls_ld_tmpdir_1=`ls -ld "$tmpdir"`
- test "$ls_ld_tmpdir" = "$ls_ld_tmpdir_1"
- }
- }
- then posix_mkdir=:
- fi
- rmdir "$tmpdir/d" "$tmpdir"
- else
- # Remove any dirs left behind by ancient mkdir implementations.
- rmdir ./$mkdir_mode ./-p ./-- 2>/dev/null
- fi
- trap '' 0;;
- esac;;
+ # Create intermediate dirs using mode 755 as modified by the umask.
+ # This is like FreeBSD 'install' as of 1997-10-28.
+ umask=`umask`
+ case $stripcmd.$umask in
+ # Optimize common cases.
+ *[2367][2367]) mkdir_umask=$umask;;
+ .*0[02][02] | .[02][02] | .[02]) mkdir_umask=22;;
+
+ *[0-7])
+ mkdir_umask=`expr $umask + 22 \
+ - $umask % 100 % 40 + $umask % 20 \
+ - $umask % 10 % 4 + $umask % 2
+ `;;
+ *) mkdir_umask=$umask,go-w;;
+ esac
+
+ # With -d, create the new directory with the user-specified mode.
+ # Otherwise, rely on $mkdir_umask.
+ if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
+ mkdir_mode=-m$mode
+ else
+ mkdir_mode=
+ fi
+
+ posix_mkdir=false
+ case $umask in
+ *[123567][0-7][0-7])
+ # POSIX mkdir -p sets u+wx bits regardless of umask, which
+ # is incompatible with FreeBSD 'install' when (umask & 300) != 0.
+ ;;
+ *)
+ tmpdir=${TMPDIR-/tmp}/ins$RANDOM-$$
+ trap 'ret=$?; rmdir "$tmpdir/d" "$tmpdir" 2>/dev/null; exit $ret' 0
+
+ if (umask $mkdir_umask &&
+ exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$tmpdir/d") >/dev/null 2>&1
+ then
+ if test -z "$dir_arg" || {
+ # Check for POSIX incompatibilities with -m.
+ # HP-UX 11.23 and IRIX 6.5 mkdir -m -p sets group- or
+ # other-writable bit of parent directory when it shouldn't.
+ # FreeBSD 6.1 mkdir -m -p sets mode of existing directory.
+ ls_ld_tmpdir=`ls -ld "$tmpdir"`
+ case $ls_ld_tmpdir in
+ d????-?r-*) different_mode=700;;
+ d????-?--*) different_mode=755;;
+ *) false;;
+ esac &&
+ $mkdirprog -m$different_mode -p -- "$tmpdir" && {
+ ls_ld_tmpdir_1=`ls -ld "$tmpdir"`
+ test "$ls_ld_tmpdir" = "$ls_ld_tmpdir_1"
+ }
+ }
+ then posix_mkdir=:
+ fi
+ rmdir "$tmpdir/d" "$tmpdir"
+ else
+ # Remove any dirs left behind by ancient mkdir implementations.
+ rmdir ./$mkdir_mode ./-p ./-- 2>/dev/null
+ fi
+ trap '' 0;;
+ esac;;
esac
if
$posix_mkdir && (
- umask $mkdir_umask &&
- $doit_exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$dstdir"
+ umask $mkdir_umask &&
+ $doit_exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$dstdir"
)
then :
else
@@ -384,53 +370,51 @@ do
# directory the slow way, step by step, checking for races as we go.
case $dstdir in
- /*) prefix='/';;
- -*) prefix='./';;
- *) prefix='';;
+ /*) prefix='/';;
+ [-=\(\)!]*) prefix='./';;
+ *) prefix='';;
esac
- eval "$initialize_posix_glob"
-
oIFS=$IFS
IFS=/
- $posix_glob set -f
+ set -f
set fnord $dstdir
shift
- $posix_glob set +f
+ set +f
IFS=$oIFS
prefixes=
for d
do
- test -z "$d" && continue
-
- prefix=$prefix$d
- if test -d "$prefix"; then
- prefixes=
- else
- if $posix_mkdir; then
- (umask=$mkdir_umask &&
- $doit_exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$dstdir") && break
- # Don't fail if two instances are running concurrently.
- test -d "$prefix" || exit 1
- else
- case $prefix in
- *\'*) qprefix=`echo "$prefix" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"`;;
- *) qprefix=$prefix;;
- esac
- prefixes="$prefixes '$qprefix'"
- fi
- fi
- prefix=$prefix/
+ test X"$d" = X && continue
+
+ prefix=$prefix$d
+ if test -d "$prefix"; then
+ prefixes=
+ else
+ if $posix_mkdir; then
+ (umask=$mkdir_umask &&
+ $doit_exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$dstdir") && break
+ # Don't fail if two instances are running concurrently.
+ test -d "$prefix" || exit 1
+ else
+ case $prefix in
+ *\'*) qprefix=`echo "$prefix" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"`;;
+ *) qprefix=$prefix;;
+ esac
+ prefixes="$prefixes '$qprefix'"
+ fi
+ fi
+ prefix=$prefix/
done
if test -n "$prefixes"; then
- # Don't fail if two instances are running concurrently.
- (umask $mkdir_umask &&
- eval "\$doit_exec \$mkdirprog $prefixes") ||
- test -d "$dstdir" || exit 1
- obsolete_mkdir_used=true
+ # Don't fail if two instances are running concurrently.
+ (umask $mkdir_umask &&
+ eval "\$doit_exec \$mkdirprog $prefixes") ||
+ test -d "$dstdir" || exit 1
+ obsolete_mkdir_used=true
fi
fi
fi
@@ -465,15 +449,12 @@ do
# If -C, don't bother to copy if it wouldn't change the file.
if $copy_on_change &&
- old=`LC_ALL=C ls -dlL "$dst" 2>/dev/null` &&
- new=`LC_ALL=C ls -dlL "$dsttmp" 2>/dev/null` &&
-
- eval "$initialize_posix_glob" &&
- $posix_glob set -f &&
+ old=`LC_ALL=C ls -dlL "$dst" 2>/dev/null` &&
+ new=`LC_ALL=C ls -dlL "$dsttmp" 2>/dev/null` &&
+ set -f &&
set X $old && old=:$2:$4:$5:$6 &&
set X $new && new=:$2:$4:$5:$6 &&
- $posix_glob set +f &&
-
+ set +f &&
test "$old" = "$new" &&
$cmpprog "$dst" "$dsttmp" >/dev/null 2>&1
then
@@ -486,24 +467,24 @@ do
# to itself, or perhaps because mv is so ancient that it does not
# support -f.
{
- # Now remove or move aside any old file at destination location.
- # We try this two ways since rm can't unlink itself on some
- # systems and the destination file might be busy for other
- # reasons. In this case, the final cleanup might fail but the new
- # file should still install successfully.
- {
- test ! -f "$dst" ||
- $doit $rmcmd -f "$dst" 2>/dev/null ||
- { $doit $mvcmd -f "$dst" "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null &&
- { $doit $rmcmd -f "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null; :; }
- } ||
- { echo "$0: cannot unlink or rename $dst" >&2
- (exit 1); exit 1
- }
- } &&
-
- # Now rename the file to the real destination.
- $doit $mvcmd "$dsttmp" "$dst"
+ # Now remove or move aside any old file at destination location.
+ # We try this two ways since rm can't unlink itself on some
+ # systems and the destination file might be busy for other
+ # reasons. In this case, the final cleanup might fail but the new
+ # file should still install successfully.
+ {
+ test ! -f "$dst" ||
+ $doit $rmcmd -f "$dst" 2>/dev/null ||
+ { $doit $mvcmd -f "$dst" "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null &&
+ { $doit $rmcmd -f "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null; :; }
+ } ||
+ { echo "$0: cannot unlink or rename $dst" >&2
+ (exit 1); exit 1
+ }
+ } &&
+
+ # Now rename the file to the real destination.
+ $doit $mvcmd "$dsttmp" "$dst"
}
fi || exit 1
@@ -515,5 +496,6 @@ done
# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/mdate-sh b/build-aux/mdate-sh
index cd916c0..6022eff 100755
--- a/build-aux/mdate-sh
+++ b/build-aux/mdate-sh
@@ -1,10 +1,9 @@
#!/bin/sh
# Get modification time of a file or directory and pretty-print it.
-scriptversion=2005-06-29.22
+scriptversion=2016-01-11.22; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software
-# Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 1995-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, June 1995
#
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
@@ -18,8 +17,7 @@ scriptversion=2005-06-29.22
# GNU General Public License for more details.
#
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-# Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
@@ -30,16 +28,26 @@ scriptversion=2005-06-29.22
# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
+if test -n "${ZSH_VERSION+set}" && (emulate sh) >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ emulate sh
+ NULLCMD=:
+ # Pre-4.2 versions of Zsh do word splitting on ${1+"$@"}, which
+ # is contrary to our usage. Disable this feature.
+ alias -g '${1+"$@"}'='"$@"'
+ setopt NO_GLOB_SUBST
+fi
+
case $1 in
'')
- echo "$0: No file. Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
+ echo "$0: No file. Try '$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
exit 1;
;;
-h | --h*)
cat <<\EOF
Usage: mdate-sh [--help] [--version] FILE
-Pretty-print the modification time of FILE.
+Pretty-print the modification day of FILE, in the format:
+1 January 1970
Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>.
EOF
@@ -51,6 +59,13 @@ EOF
;;
esac
+error ()
+{
+ echo "$0: $1" >&2
+ exit 1
+}
+
+
# Prevent date giving response in another language.
LANG=C
export LANG
@@ -60,7 +75,7 @@ LC_TIME=C
export LC_TIME
# GNU ls changes its time format in response to the TIME_STYLE
-# variable. Since we cannot assume `unset' works, revert this
+# variable. Since we cannot assume 'unset' works, revert this
# variable to its documented default.
if test "${TIME_STYLE+set}" = set; then
TIME_STYLE=posix-long-iso
@@ -75,27 +90,32 @@ if ls -L /dev/null 1>/dev/null 2>&1; then
else
ls_command='ls -l -d'
fi
+# Avoid user/group names that might have spaces, when possible.
+if ls -n /dev/null 1>/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ ls_command="$ls_command -n"
+fi
-# A `ls -l' line looks as follows on OS/2.
+# A 'ls -l' line looks as follows on OS/2.
# drwxrwx--- 0 Aug 11 2001 foo
# This differs from Unix, which adds ownership information.
# drwxrwx--- 2 root root 4096 Aug 11 2001 foo
#
# To find the date, we split the line on spaces and iterate on words
# until we find a month. This cannot work with files whose owner is a
-# user named `Jan', or `Feb', etc. However, it's unlikely that `/'
+# user named "Jan", or "Feb", etc. However, it's unlikely that '/'
# will be owned by a user whose name is a month. So we first look at
# the extended ls output of the root directory to decide how many
# words should be skipped to get the date.
# On HPUX /bin/sh, "set" interprets "-rw-r--r--" as options, so the "x" below.
-set x`ls -l -d /`
+set x`$ls_command /`
# Find which argument is the month.
month=
command=
until test $month
do
+ test $# -gt 0 || error "failed parsing '$ls_command /' output"
shift
# Add another shift to the command.
command="$command shift;"
@@ -115,8 +135,10 @@ do
esac
done
+test -n "$month" || error "failed parsing '$ls_command /' output"
+
# Get the extended ls output of the file or directory.
-set dummy x`eval "$ls_command \"\$save_arg1\""`
+set dummy x`eval "$ls_command \"\\\$save_arg1\""`
# Remove all preceding arguments
eval $command
@@ -197,5 +219,6 @@ echo $day $month $year
# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/missing b/build-aux/missing
index 1c8ff70..f62bbae 100755
--- a/build-aux/missing
+++ b/build-aux/missing
@@ -1,11 +1,10 @@
#! /bin/sh
-# Common stub for a few missing GNU programs while installing.
+# Common wrapper for a few potentially missing GNU programs.
-scriptversion=2006-05-10.23
+scriptversion=2013-10-28.13; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
-# Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-# Originally by Fran,cois Pinard <pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>, 1996.
+# Copyright (C) 1996-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Originally written by Fran,cois Pinard <pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>, 1996.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
@@ -18,9 +17,7 @@ scriptversion=2006-05-10.23
# GNU General Public License for more details.
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
-# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
-# 02110-1301, USA.
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
@@ -28,66 +25,40 @@ scriptversion=2006-05-10.23
# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
if test $# -eq 0; then
- echo 1>&2 "Try \`$0 --help' for more information"
+ echo 1>&2 "Try '$0 --help' for more information"
exit 1
fi
-run=:
-sed_output='s/.* --output[ =]\([^ ]*\).*/\1/p'
-sed_minuso='s/.* -o \([^ ]*\).*/\1/p'
-
-# In the cases where this matters, `missing' is being run in the
-# srcdir already.
-if test -f configure.ac; then
- configure_ac=configure.ac
-else
- configure_ac=configure.in
-fi
+case $1 in
-msg="missing on your system"
+ --is-lightweight)
+ # Used by our autoconf macros to check whether the available missing
+ # script is modern enough.
+ exit 0
+ ;;
-case $1 in
---run)
- # Try to run requested program, and just exit if it succeeds.
- run=
- shift
- "$@" && exit 0
- # Exit code 63 means version mismatch. This often happens
- # when the user try to use an ancient version of a tool on
- # a file that requires a minimum version. In this case we
- # we should proceed has if the program had been absent, or
- # if --run hadn't been passed.
- if test $? = 63; then
- run=:
- msg="probably too old"
- fi
- ;;
+ --run)
+ # Back-compat with the calling convention used by older automake.
+ shift
+ ;;
-h|--h|--he|--hel|--help)
echo "\
$0 [OPTION]... PROGRAM [ARGUMENT]...
-Handle \`PROGRAM [ARGUMENT]...' for when PROGRAM is missing, or return an
-error status if there is no known handling for PROGRAM.
+Run 'PROGRAM [ARGUMENT]...', returning a proper advice when this fails due
+to PROGRAM being missing or too old.
Options:
-h, --help display this help and exit
-v, --version output version information and exit
- --run try to run the given command, and emulate it if it fails
Supported PROGRAM values:
- aclocal touch file \`aclocal.m4'
- autoconf touch file \`configure'
- autoheader touch file \`config.h.in'
- autom4te touch the output file, or create a stub one
- automake touch all \`Makefile.in' files
- bison create \`y.tab.[ch]', if possible, from existing .[ch]
- flex create \`lex.yy.c', if possible, from existing .c
- help2man touch the output file
- lex create \`lex.yy.c', if possible, from existing .c
- makeinfo touch the output file
- tar try tar, gnutar, gtar, then tar without non-portable flags
- yacc create \`y.tab.[ch]', if possible, from existing .[ch]
+ aclocal autoconf autoheader autom4te automake makeinfo
+ bison yacc flex lex help2man
+
+Version suffixes to PROGRAM as well as the prefixes 'gnu-', 'gnu', and
+'g' are ignored when checking the name.
Send bug reports to <bug-automake@gnu.org>."
exit $?
@@ -99,269 +70,146 @@ Send bug reports to <bug-automake@gnu.org>."
;;
-*)
- echo 1>&2 "$0: Unknown \`$1' option"
- echo 1>&2 "Try \`$0 --help' for more information"
+ echo 1>&2 "$0: unknown '$1' option"
+ echo 1>&2 "Try '$0 --help' for more information"
exit 1
;;
esac
-# Now exit if we have it, but it failed. Also exit now if we
-# don't have it and --version was passed (most likely to detect
-# the program).
-case $1 in
- lex|yacc)
- # Not GNU programs, they don't have --version.
- ;;
-
- tar)
- if test -n "$run"; then
- echo 1>&2 "ERROR: \`tar' requires --run"
- exit 1
- elif test "x$2" = "x--version" || test "x$2" = "x--help"; then
- exit 1
- fi
- ;;
-
- *)
- if test -z "$run" && ($1 --version) > /dev/null 2>&1; then
- # We have it, but it failed.
- exit 1
- elif test "x$2" = "x--version" || test "x$2" = "x--help"; then
- # Could not run --version or --help. This is probably someone
- # running `$TOOL --version' or `$TOOL --help' to check whether
- # $TOOL exists and not knowing $TOOL uses missing.
- exit 1
- fi
- ;;
-esac
-
-# If it does not exist, or fails to run (possibly an outdated version),
-# try to emulate it.
-case $1 in
- aclocal*)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
- you modified \`acinclude.m4' or \`${configure_ac}'. You might want
- to install the \`Automake' and \`Perl' packages. Grab them from
- any GNU archive site."
- touch aclocal.m4
- ;;
-
- autoconf)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
- you modified \`${configure_ac}'. You might want to install the
- \`Autoconf' and \`GNU m4' packages. Grab them from any GNU
- archive site."
- touch configure
- ;;
-
- autoheader)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
- you modified \`acconfig.h' or \`${configure_ac}'. You might want
- to install the \`Autoconf' and \`GNU m4' packages. Grab them
- from any GNU archive site."
- files=`sed -n 's/^[ ]*A[CM]_CONFIG_HEADER(\([^)]*\)).*/\1/p' ${configure_ac}`
- test -z "$files" && files="config.h"
- touch_files=
- for f in $files; do
- case $f in
- *:*) touch_files="$touch_files "`echo "$f" |
- sed -e 's/^[^:]*://' -e 's/:.*//'`;;
- *) touch_files="$touch_files $f.in";;
- esac
- done
- touch $touch_files
- ;;
-
- automake*)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
- you modified \`Makefile.am', \`acinclude.m4' or \`${configure_ac}'.
- You might want to install the \`Automake' and \`Perl' packages.
- Grab them from any GNU archive site."
- find . -type f -name Makefile.am -print |
- sed 's/\.am$/.in/' |
- while read f; do touch "$f"; done
- ;;
-
- autom4te)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' is needed, but is $msg.
- You might have modified some files without having the
- proper tools for further handling them.
- You can get \`$1' as part of \`Autoconf' from any GNU
- archive site."
-
- file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_output"`
- test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_minuso"`
- if test -f "$file"; then
- touch $file
- else
- test -z "$file" || exec >$file
- echo "#! /bin/sh"
- echo "# Created by GNU Automake missing as a replacement of"
- echo "# $ $@"
- echo "exit 0"
- chmod +x $file
- exit 1
- fi
- ;;
-
- bison|yacc)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' $msg. You should only need it if
- you modified a \`.y' file. You may need the \`Bison' package
- in order for those modifications to take effect. You can get
- \`Bison' from any GNU archive site."
- rm -f y.tab.c y.tab.h
- if test $# -ne 1; then
- eval LASTARG="\${$#}"
- case $LASTARG in
- *.y)
- SRCFILE=`echo "$LASTARG" | sed 's/y$/c/'`
- if test -f "$SRCFILE"; then
- cp "$SRCFILE" y.tab.c
- fi
- SRCFILE=`echo "$LASTARG" | sed 's/y$/h/'`
- if test -f "$SRCFILE"; then
- cp "$SRCFILE" y.tab.h
- fi
- ;;
- esac
- fi
- if test ! -f y.tab.h; then
- echo >y.tab.h
- fi
- if test ! -f y.tab.c; then
- echo 'main() { return 0; }' >y.tab.c
- fi
- ;;
-
- lex|flex)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
- you modified a \`.l' file. You may need the \`Flex' package
- in order for those modifications to take effect. You can get
- \`Flex' from any GNU archive site."
- rm -f lex.yy.c
- if test $# -ne 1; then
- eval LASTARG="\${$#}"
- case $LASTARG in
- *.l)
- SRCFILE=`echo "$LASTARG" | sed 's/l$/c/'`
- if test -f "$SRCFILE"; then
- cp "$SRCFILE" lex.yy.c
- fi
- ;;
- esac
- fi
- if test ! -f lex.yy.c; then
- echo 'main() { return 0; }' >lex.yy.c
- fi
- ;;
-
- help2man)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
- you modified a dependency of a manual page. You may need the
- \`Help2man' package in order for those modifications to take
- effect. You can get \`Help2man' from any GNU archive site."
-
- file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_output"`
- test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_minuso"`
- if test -f "$file"; then
- touch $file
- else
- test -z "$file" || exec >$file
- echo ".ab help2man is required to generate this page"
- exit 1
- fi
- ;;
-
- makeinfo)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
- you modified a \`.texi' or \`.texinfo' file, or any other file
- indirectly affecting the aspect of the manual. The spurious
- call might also be the consequence of using a buggy \`make' (AIX,
- DU, IRIX). You might want to install the \`Texinfo' package or
- the \`GNU make' package. Grab either from any GNU archive site."
- # The file to touch is that specified with -o ...
- file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_output"`
- test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_minuso"`
- if test -z "$file"; then
- # ... or it is the one specified with @setfilename ...
- infile=`echo "$*" | sed 's/.* \([^ ]*\) *$/\1/'`
- file=`sed -n '
- /^@setfilename/{
- s/.* \([^ ]*\) *$/\1/
- p
- q
- }' $infile`
- # ... or it is derived from the source name (dir/f.texi becomes f.info)
- test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$infile" | sed 's,.*/,,;s,.[^.]*$,,'`.info
- fi
- # If the file does not exist, the user really needs makeinfo;
- # let's fail without touching anything.
- test -f $file || exit 1
- touch $file
- ;;
-
- tar)
- shift
-
- # We have already tried tar in the generic part.
- # Look for gnutar/gtar before invocation to avoid ugly error
- # messages.
- if (gnutar --version > /dev/null 2>&1); then
- gnutar "$@" && exit 0
- fi
- if (gtar --version > /dev/null 2>&1); then
- gtar "$@" && exit 0
- fi
- firstarg="$1"
- if shift; then
- case $firstarg in
- *o*)
- firstarg=`echo "$firstarg" | sed s/o//`
- tar "$firstarg" "$@" && exit 0
- ;;
- esac
- case $firstarg in
- *h*)
- firstarg=`echo "$firstarg" | sed s/h//`
- tar "$firstarg" "$@" && exit 0
- ;;
- esac
- fi
-
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: I can't seem to be able to run \`tar' with the given arguments.
- You may want to install GNU tar or Free paxutils, or check the
- command line arguments."
- exit 1
- ;;
-
- *)
- echo 1>&2 "\
-WARNING: \`$1' is needed, and is $msg.
- You might have modified some files without having the
- proper tools for further handling them. Check the \`README' file,
- it often tells you about the needed prerequisites for installing
- this package. You may also peek at any GNU archive site, in case
- some other package would contain this missing \`$1' program."
- exit 1
- ;;
-esac
+# Run the given program, remember its exit status.
+"$@"; st=$?
+
+# If it succeeded, we are done.
+test $st -eq 0 && exit 0
+
+# Also exit now if we it failed (or wasn't found), and '--version' was
+# passed; such an option is passed most likely to detect whether the
+# program is present and works.
+case $2 in --version|--help) exit $st;; esac
+
+# Exit code 63 means version mismatch. This often happens when the user
+# tries to use an ancient version of a tool on a file that requires a
+# minimum version.
+if test $st -eq 63; then
+ msg="probably too old"
+elif test $st -eq 127; then
+ # Program was missing.
+ msg="missing on your system"
+else
+ # Program was found and executed, but failed. Give up.
+ exit $st
+fi
-exit 0
+perl_URL=http://www.perl.org/
+flex_URL=http://flex.sourceforge.net/
+gnu_software_URL=http://www.gnu.org/software
+
+program_details ()
+{
+ case $1 in
+ aclocal|automake)
+ echo "The '$1' program is part of the GNU Automake package:"
+ echo "<$gnu_software_URL/automake>"
+ echo "It also requires GNU Autoconf, GNU m4 and Perl in order to run:"
+ echo "<$gnu_software_URL/autoconf>"
+ echo "<$gnu_software_URL/m4/>"
+ echo "<$perl_URL>"
+ ;;
+ autoconf|autom4te|autoheader)
+ echo "The '$1' program is part of the GNU Autoconf package:"
+ echo "<$gnu_software_URL/autoconf/>"
+ echo "It also requires GNU m4 and Perl in order to run:"
+ echo "<$gnu_software_URL/m4/>"
+ echo "<$perl_URL>"
+ ;;
+ esac
+}
+
+give_advice ()
+{
+ # Normalize program name to check for.
+ normalized_program=`echo "$1" | sed '
+ s/^gnu-//; t
+ s/^gnu//; t
+ s/^g//; t'`
+
+ printf '%s\n' "'$1' is $msg."
+
+ configure_deps="'configure.ac' or m4 files included by 'configure.ac'"
+ case $normalized_program in
+ autoconf*)
+ echo "You should only need it if you modified 'configure.ac',"
+ echo "or m4 files included by it."
+ program_details 'autoconf'
+ ;;
+ autoheader*)
+ echo "You should only need it if you modified 'acconfig.h' or"
+ echo "$configure_deps."
+ program_details 'autoheader'
+ ;;
+ automake*)
+ echo "You should only need it if you modified 'Makefile.am' or"
+ echo "$configure_deps."
+ program_details 'automake'
+ ;;
+ aclocal*)
+ echo "You should only need it if you modified 'acinclude.m4' or"
+ echo "$configure_deps."
+ program_details 'aclocal'
+ ;;
+ autom4te*)
+ echo "You might have modified some maintainer files that require"
+ echo "the 'autom4te' program to be rebuilt."
+ program_details 'autom4te'
+ ;;
+ bison*|yacc*)
+ echo "You should only need it if you modified a '.y' file."
+ echo "You may want to install the GNU Bison package:"
+ echo "<$gnu_software_URL/bison/>"
+ ;;
+ lex*|flex*)
+ echo "You should only need it if you modified a '.l' file."
+ echo "You may want to install the Fast Lexical Analyzer package:"
+ echo "<$flex_URL>"
+ ;;
+ help2man*)
+ echo "You should only need it if you modified a dependency" \
+ "of a man page."
+ echo "You may want to install the GNU Help2man package:"
+ echo "<$gnu_software_URL/help2man/>"
+ ;;
+ makeinfo*)
+ echo "You should only need it if you modified a '.texi' file, or"
+ echo "any other file indirectly affecting the aspect of the manual."
+ echo "You might want to install the Texinfo package:"
+ echo "<$gnu_software_URL/texinfo/>"
+ echo "The spurious makeinfo call might also be the consequence of"
+ echo "using a buggy 'make' (AIX, DU, IRIX), in which case you might"
+ echo "want to install GNU make:"
+ echo "<$gnu_software_URL/make/>"
+ ;;
+ *)
+ echo "You might have modified some files without having the proper"
+ echo "tools for further handling them. Check the 'README' file, it"
+ echo "often tells you about the needed prerequisites for installing"
+ echo "this package. You may also peek at any GNU archive site, in"
+ echo "case some other package contains this missing '$1' program."
+ ;;
+ esac
+}
+
+give_advice "$1" | sed -e '1s/^/WARNING: /' \
+ -e '2,$s/^/ /' >&2
+
+# Propagate the correct exit status (expected to be 127 for a program
+# not found, 63 for a program that failed due to version mismatch).
+exit $st
# Local variables:
# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/prefix-gnulib-mk b/build-aux/prefix-gnulib-mk
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..62caca8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/prefix-gnulib-mk
@@ -0,0 +1,238 @@
+eval '(exit $?0)' && eval 'exec perl -wS "$0" "$@"'
+ & eval 'exec perl -wS "$0" $argv:q'
+ if 0;
+
+use strict;
+use IO::File;
+use Getopt::Long;
+use File::Basename; # for dirname
+
+my $VERSION = '2012-01-21 17:13'; # UTC
+(my $ME = $0) =~ s|.*/||;
+
+my $prefix;
+my $lib_name;
+
+sub usage ($)
+{
+ my ($exit_code) = @_;
+ my $STREAM = ($exit_code == 0 ? *STDOUT : *STDERR);
+ if ($exit_code != 0)
+ {
+ print $STREAM "Try '$ME --help' for more information.\n";
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ print $STREAM <<EOF;
+Usage: $ME --lib-name=NAME FILE
+ or: $ME [--help|--version]
+Rewrite a gnulib-tool-generated FILE like lib/gnulib.mk to work with
+automake's subdir-objects.
+
+OPTIONS:
+
+This option must be specified:
+
+ --lib-name=NAME library name, often "lib\$project"
+
+The following are optional:
+
+ --help display this help and exit
+ --version output version information and exit
+
+EOF
+ }
+ exit $exit_code;
+}
+
+# contents ($FILE_NAME)
+# ---------------------
+sub contents ($)
+{
+ my ($file) = @_;
+ local $/; # Turn on slurp-mode.
+ my $f = new IO::File "< $file" or die "$file";
+ my $contents = $f->getline or die "$file";
+ $f->close;
+ return $contents;
+}
+
+# prefix_word ($WORD)
+# -------------------
+# Do not prefix special words such as variable dereferences. Also,
+# "Makefile" is really "Makefile", since precisely there is no
+# lib/Makefile.
+sub prefix_word ($)
+{
+ local ($_) = @_;
+ $_ = $prefix . $_
+ unless (/^-/ || m{^\$\(\w+\)} || $_ eq "Makefile" || $_ eq '\\'
+ || $_ eq '@ALLOCA@');
+ return $_;
+}
+
+
+# prefix_words ($TEXT)
+# --------------------
+sub prefix_words ($)
+{
+ local ($_) = @_;
+ s{(\S+)}{prefix_word($1)}gem;
+ return $_;
+}
+
+
+# prefix_assignment ($LHS-AND-ASSIGN-OP, $RHS)
+# --------------------------------------------
+sub prefix_assignment ($$)
+{
+ my ($lhs_and_assign_op, $rhs) = @_;
+ my $res;
+
+ # Some variables are initialized by gnulib.mk, and we don't want
+ # that. Change '=' to '+='.
+ if ($lhs_and_assign_op =~ /^(GPERF|V_GPERF.*) =$/)
+ {
+ # Do not change the RHS, which specifies the GPERF program.
+ }
+ elsif ($lhs_and_assign_op =~
+ /^(SUBDIRS|EXTRA_DIST|BUILT_SOURCES|SUFFIXES|MOSTLYCLEANFILES
+ |CLEANFILES|DISTCLEANFILES|MAINTAINERCLEANFILES|AM_CFLAGS
+ |AM_CPPFLAGS|AM_GNU_GETTEXT)\ =/x)
+ {
+ $lhs_and_assign_op =~ s/=/+=/;
+ }
+ # We don't want to inherit gnulib's AUTOMAKE_OPTIONS, comment them.
+ elsif ($lhs_and_assign_op =~ /^AUTOMAKE_OPTIONS =/)
+ {
+ $lhs_and_assign_op =~ s/^/# /;
+ }
+ elsif ($lhs_and_assign_op =~ /^SUFFIXES /)
+ {
+ # Elide any SUFFIXES assignment or concatenation.
+ $lhs_and_assign_op =~ s/^/# /;
+ }
+ # The words are (probably) paths to files in lib/: prefix them.
+ else
+ {
+ $rhs = prefix_words($rhs)
+ }
+
+ # Variables which name depend on the location: libbison_a_SOURCES =>
+ # lib_libbison_a_SOURCES.
+ $lhs_and_assign_op =~ s/($lib_name)/lib_$1/g;
+
+ return $lhs_and_assign_op . $rhs;
+}
+
+# prefix $CONTENTS
+# ----------------
+# $CONTENTS is a Makefile content. Post-process it so that each file-name
+# is prefixed with $prefix (e.g., "lib/").
+#
+# Relies heavily on the regularity of the file generated by gnulib-tool.
+sub prefix ($)
+{
+ # Work on $_.
+ local ($_) = @_;
+
+ # Prefix all the occurrence of files in rules. If there is nothing
+ # after in the :, it's probably a phony target, or a suffix rule.
+ # Don't touch it.
+ s{^([-\w+/]+\.[-\w.]+ *: *\S.*)$}
+ {prefix_words($1)}gem;
+
+ # Prefix files in variables.
+ s{^([\w.]+\s*\+?=)(.*)$}
+ {prefix_assignment($1, $2)}gem;
+
+ # These three guys escape all the other regular rules.
+ # Require the leading white space to avoid inserting the prefix
+ # on a line like this:
+ # charset_alias = $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/charset.alias
+ # With $(libdir), it would be erroneous.
+ s{(\s)(charset\.alias|ref-add\.sed|ref-del\.sed)}{$1$prefix$2}g;
+ # Unfortunately, as a result we sometimes have lib/lib.
+ s{($prefix){2}}{$1}g;
+
+ # $(srcdir)/ is actually $(top_srcdir)/$prefix/.
+ # The trailing slash is required to avoid matching this rule:
+ # test '$(srcdir)' = . || rm -f $(top_builddir)/GNUmakefile
+ s{\$\(srcdir\)/}{\$(top_srcdir)/$prefix}g;
+
+ # Sometimes, t-$@ is used instead of $@-t, which, of course, does
+ # not work when we have a $@ with a directory in it.
+ s{t-\$\@}{\$\@-t}g;
+
+ # Some AC_SUBST patterns remain and would better be Make macros.
+ s{\@(MKDIR_P)\@}{\$($1)}g;
+
+ # Adjust paths in mkdir.
+ s{(\$\(MKDIR_P\))\s*(\w+)}{$1 $prefix$2}g;
+
+ return $_;
+}
+
+# process ($IN)
+# -------------
+sub process ($)
+{
+ my ($file) = @_;
+ my ($bak) = "$file.bak";
+ rename ($file, $bak) or die "$ME: rename $file $bak failed: $!\n";
+ my $contents = contents ($bak);
+ $contents = prefix ($contents);
+ my $out = new IO::File(">$file")
+ or die "$ME: $file: failed to open for writing: $!\n";
+ print $out $contents;
+}
+
+{
+ GetOptions
+ (
+ 'lib-name=s' => \$lib_name,
+ help => sub { usage 0 },
+ version => sub { print "$ME version $VERSION\n"; exit },
+ ) or usage 1;
+
+ my $fail = 0;
+ defined $lib_name
+ or (warn "$ME: no library name; use --lib-name=NAME\n"), $fail = 1;
+
+ # There must be exactly one argument.
+ @ARGV == 0
+ and (warn "$ME: missing FILE argument\n"), $fail = 1;
+ 1 < @ARGV
+ and (warn "$ME: too many arguments:\n", join ("\n", @ARGV), "\n"),
+ $fail = 1;
+ $fail
+ and usage 1;
+
+ my $file = $ARGV[0];
+ $prefix = (dirname $file) . '/';
+ warn "prefix=$prefix\n";
+
+ process $file;
+}
+
+### Setup "GNU" style for perl-mode and cperl-mode.
+## Local Variables:
+## perl-indent-level: 2
+## perl-continued-statement-offset: 2
+## perl-continued-brace-offset: 0
+## perl-brace-offset: 0
+## perl-brace-imaginary-offset: 0
+## perl-label-offset: -2
+## cperl-indent-level: 2
+## cperl-brace-offset: 0
+## cperl-continued-brace-offset: 0
+## cperl-label-offset: -2
+## cperl-extra-newline-before-brace: t
+## cperl-merge-trailing-else: nil
+## cperl-continued-statement-offset: 2
+## eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+## time-stamp-start: "my $VERSION = '"
+## time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d %02H:%02M"
+## time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+## time-stamp-end: "'; # UTC"
+## End:
diff --git a/build-aux/snippet/_Noreturn.h b/build-aux/snippet/_Noreturn.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c44ad89
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/snippet/_Noreturn.h
@@ -0,0 +1,10 @@
+#if !defined _Noreturn && __STDC_VERSION__ < 201112
+# if (3 <= __GNUC__ || (__GNUC__ == 2 && 8 <= __GNUC_MINOR__) \
+ || 0x5110 <= __SUNPRO_C)
+# define _Noreturn __attribute__ ((__noreturn__))
+# elif 1200 <= _MSC_VER
+# define _Noreturn __declspec (noreturn)
+# else
+# define _Noreturn
+# endif
+#endif
diff --git a/build-aux/snippet/arg-nonnull.h b/build-aux/snippet/arg-nonnull.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..584649f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/snippet/arg-nonnull.h
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+/* A C macro for declaring that specific arguments must not be NULL.
+ Copyright (C) 2009-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
+
+/* _GL_ARG_NONNULL((n,...,m)) tells the compiler and static analyzer tools
+ that the values passed as arguments n, ..., m must be non-NULL pointers.
+ n = 1 stands for the first argument, n = 2 for the second argument etc. */
+#ifndef _GL_ARG_NONNULL
+# if (__GNUC__ == 3 && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= 3) || __GNUC__ > 3
+# define _GL_ARG_NONNULL(params) __attribute__ ((__nonnull__ params))
+# else
+# define _GL_ARG_NONNULL(params)
+# endif
+#endif
diff --git a/build-aux/snippet/c++defs.h b/build-aux/snippet/c++defs.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..813f2e2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/snippet/c++defs.h
@@ -0,0 +1,271 @@
+/* C++ compatible function declaration macros.
+ Copyright (C) 2010-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
+
+#ifndef _GL_CXXDEFS_H
+#define _GL_CXXDEFS_H
+
+/* The three most frequent use cases of these macros are:
+
+ * For providing a substitute for a function that is missing on some
+ platforms, but is declared and works fine on the platforms on which
+ it exists:
+
+ #if @GNULIB_FOO@
+ # if !@HAVE_FOO@
+ _GL_FUNCDECL_SYS (foo, ...);
+ # endif
+ _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS (foo, ...);
+ _GL_CXXALIASWARN (foo);
+ #elif defined GNULIB_POSIXCHECK
+ ...
+ #endif
+
+ * For providing a replacement for a function that exists on all platforms,
+ but is broken/insufficient and needs to be replaced on some platforms:
+
+ #if @GNULIB_FOO@
+ # if @REPLACE_FOO@
+ # if !(defined __cplusplus && defined GNULIB_NAMESPACE)
+ # undef foo
+ # define foo rpl_foo
+ # endif
+ _GL_FUNCDECL_RPL (foo, ...);
+ _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL (foo, ...);
+ # else
+ _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS (foo, ...);
+ # endif
+ _GL_CXXALIASWARN (foo);
+ #elif defined GNULIB_POSIXCHECK
+ ...
+ #endif
+
+ * For providing a replacement for a function that exists on some platforms
+ but is broken/insufficient and needs to be replaced on some of them and
+ is additionally either missing or undeclared on some other platforms:
+
+ #if @GNULIB_FOO@
+ # if @REPLACE_FOO@
+ # if !(defined __cplusplus && defined GNULIB_NAMESPACE)
+ # undef foo
+ # define foo rpl_foo
+ # endif
+ _GL_FUNCDECL_RPL (foo, ...);
+ _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL (foo, ...);
+ # else
+ # if !@HAVE_FOO@ or if !@HAVE_DECL_FOO@
+ _GL_FUNCDECL_SYS (foo, ...);
+ # endif
+ _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS (foo, ...);
+ # endif
+ _GL_CXXALIASWARN (foo);
+ #elif defined GNULIB_POSIXCHECK
+ ...
+ #endif
+*/
+
+/* _GL_EXTERN_C declaration;
+ performs the declaration with C linkage. */
+#if defined __cplusplus
+# define _GL_EXTERN_C extern "C"
+#else
+# define _GL_EXTERN_C extern
+#endif
+
+/* _GL_FUNCDECL_RPL (func, rettype, parameters_and_attributes);
+ declares a replacement function, named rpl_func, with the given prototype,
+ consisting of return type, parameters, and attributes.
+ Example:
+ _GL_FUNCDECL_RPL (open, int, (const char *filename, int flags, ...)
+ _GL_ARG_NONNULL ((1)));
+ */
+#define _GL_FUNCDECL_RPL(func,rettype,parameters_and_attributes) \
+ _GL_FUNCDECL_RPL_1 (rpl_##func, rettype, parameters_and_attributes)
+#define _GL_FUNCDECL_RPL_1(rpl_func,rettype,parameters_and_attributes) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C rettype rpl_func parameters_and_attributes
+
+/* _GL_FUNCDECL_SYS (func, rettype, parameters_and_attributes);
+ declares the system function, named func, with the given prototype,
+ consisting of return type, parameters, and attributes.
+ Example:
+ _GL_FUNCDECL_SYS (open, int, (const char *filename, int flags, ...)
+ _GL_ARG_NONNULL ((1)));
+ */
+#define _GL_FUNCDECL_SYS(func,rettype,parameters_and_attributes) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C rettype func parameters_and_attributes
+
+/* _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL (func, rettype, parameters);
+ declares a C++ alias called GNULIB_NAMESPACE::func
+ that redirects to rpl_func, if GNULIB_NAMESPACE is defined.
+ Example:
+ _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL (open, int, (const char *filename, int flags, ...));
+ */
+#define _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL(func,rettype,parameters) \
+ _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL_1 (func, rpl_##func, rettype, parameters)
+#if defined __cplusplus && defined GNULIB_NAMESPACE
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL_1(func,rpl_func,rettype,parameters) \
+ namespace GNULIB_NAMESPACE \
+ { \
+ rettype (*const func) parameters = ::rpl_func; \
+ } \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#else
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL_1(func,rpl_func,rettype,parameters) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#endif
+
+/* _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL_CAST_1 (func, rpl_func, rettype, parameters);
+ is like _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL_1 (func, rpl_func, rettype, parameters);
+ except that the C function rpl_func may have a slightly different
+ declaration. A cast is used to silence the "invalid conversion" error
+ that would otherwise occur. */
+#if defined __cplusplus && defined GNULIB_NAMESPACE
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL_CAST_1(func,rpl_func,rettype,parameters) \
+ namespace GNULIB_NAMESPACE \
+ { \
+ rettype (*const func) parameters = \
+ reinterpret_cast<rettype(*)parameters>(::rpl_func); \
+ } \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#else
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL_CAST_1(func,rpl_func,rettype,parameters) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#endif
+
+/* _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS (func, rettype, parameters);
+ declares a C++ alias called GNULIB_NAMESPACE::func
+ that redirects to the system provided function func, if GNULIB_NAMESPACE
+ is defined.
+ Example:
+ _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS (open, int, (const char *filename, int flags, ...));
+ */
+#if defined __cplusplus && defined GNULIB_NAMESPACE
+ /* If we were to write
+ rettype (*const func) parameters = ::func;
+ like above in _GL_CXXALIAS_RPL_1, the compiler could optimize calls
+ better (remove an indirection through a 'static' pointer variable),
+ but then the _GL_CXXALIASWARN macro below would cause a warning not only
+ for uses of ::func but also for uses of GNULIB_NAMESPACE::func. */
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS(func,rettype,parameters) \
+ namespace GNULIB_NAMESPACE \
+ { \
+ static rettype (*func) parameters = ::func; \
+ } \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#else
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS(func,rettype,parameters) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#endif
+
+/* _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS_CAST (func, rettype, parameters);
+ is like _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS (func, rettype, parameters);
+ except that the C function func may have a slightly different declaration.
+ A cast is used to silence the "invalid conversion" error that would
+ otherwise occur. */
+#if defined __cplusplus && defined GNULIB_NAMESPACE
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS_CAST(func,rettype,parameters) \
+ namespace GNULIB_NAMESPACE \
+ { \
+ static rettype (*func) parameters = \
+ reinterpret_cast<rettype(*)parameters>(::func); \
+ } \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#else
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS_CAST(func,rettype,parameters) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#endif
+
+/* _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS_CAST2 (func, rettype, parameters, rettype2, parameters2);
+ is like _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS (func, rettype, parameters);
+ except that the C function is picked among a set of overloaded functions,
+ namely the one with rettype2 and parameters2. Two consecutive casts
+ are used to silence the "cannot find a match" and "invalid conversion"
+ errors that would otherwise occur. */
+#if defined __cplusplus && defined GNULIB_NAMESPACE
+ /* The outer cast must be a reinterpret_cast.
+ The inner cast: When the function is defined as a set of overloaded
+ functions, it works as a static_cast<>, choosing the designated variant.
+ When the function is defined as a single variant, it works as a
+ reinterpret_cast<>. The parenthesized cast syntax works both ways. */
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS_CAST2(func,rettype,parameters,rettype2,parameters2) \
+ namespace GNULIB_NAMESPACE \
+ { \
+ static rettype (*func) parameters = \
+ reinterpret_cast<rettype(*)parameters>( \
+ (rettype2(*)parameters2)(::func)); \
+ } \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#else
+# define _GL_CXXALIAS_SYS_CAST2(func,rettype,parameters,rettype2,parameters2) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#endif
+
+/* _GL_CXXALIASWARN (func);
+ causes a warning to be emitted when ::func is used but not when
+ GNULIB_NAMESPACE::func is used. func must be defined without overloaded
+ variants. */
+#if defined __cplusplus && defined GNULIB_NAMESPACE
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN(func) \
+ _GL_CXXALIASWARN_1 (func, GNULIB_NAMESPACE)
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN_1(func,namespace) \
+ _GL_CXXALIASWARN_2 (func, namespace)
+/* To work around GCC bug <http://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=43881>,
+ we enable the warning only when not optimizing. */
+# if !__OPTIMIZE__
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN_2(func,namespace) \
+ _GL_WARN_ON_USE (func, \
+ "The symbol ::" #func " refers to the system function. " \
+ "Use " #namespace "::" #func " instead.")
+# elif __GNUC__ >= 3 && GNULIB_STRICT_CHECKING
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN_2(func,namespace) \
+ extern __typeof__ (func) func
+# else
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN_2(func,namespace) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+# endif
+#else
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN(func) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#endif
+
+/* _GL_CXXALIASWARN1 (func, rettype, parameters_and_attributes);
+ causes a warning to be emitted when the given overloaded variant of ::func
+ is used but not when GNULIB_NAMESPACE::func is used. */
+#if defined __cplusplus && defined GNULIB_NAMESPACE
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN1(func,rettype,parameters_and_attributes) \
+ _GL_CXXALIASWARN1_1 (func, rettype, parameters_and_attributes, \
+ GNULIB_NAMESPACE)
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN1_1(func,rettype,parameters_and_attributes,namespace) \
+ _GL_CXXALIASWARN1_2 (func, rettype, parameters_and_attributes, namespace)
+/* To work around GCC bug <http://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=43881>,
+ we enable the warning only when not optimizing. */
+# if !__OPTIMIZE__
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN1_2(func,rettype,parameters_and_attributes,namespace) \
+ _GL_WARN_ON_USE_CXX (func, rettype, parameters_and_attributes, \
+ "The symbol ::" #func " refers to the system function. " \
+ "Use " #namespace "::" #func " instead.")
+# elif __GNUC__ >= 3 && GNULIB_STRICT_CHECKING
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN1_2(func,rettype,parameters_and_attributes,namespace) \
+ extern __typeof__ (func) func
+# else
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN1_2(func,rettype,parameters_and_attributes,namespace) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+# endif
+#else
+# define _GL_CXXALIASWARN1(func,rettype,parameters_and_attributes) \
+ _GL_EXTERN_C int _gl_cxxalias_dummy
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _GL_CXXDEFS_H */
diff --git a/build-aux/snippet/unused-parameter.h b/build-aux/snippet/unused-parameter.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..843db76
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/snippet/unused-parameter.h
@@ -0,0 +1,36 @@
+/* A C macro for declaring that specific function parameters are not used.
+ Copyright (C) 2008-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
+
+/* _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER is a marker that can be appended to function parameter
+ declarations for parameters that are not used. This helps to reduce
+ warnings, such as from GCC -Wunused-parameter. The syntax is as follows:
+ type param _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER
+ or more generally
+ param_decl _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER
+ For example:
+ int param _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER
+ int *(*param)(void) _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER
+ Other possible, but obscure and discouraged syntaxes:
+ int _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER *(*param)(void)
+ _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER int *(*param)(void)
+ */
+#ifndef _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER
+# if __GNUC__ >= 3 || (__GNUC__ == 2 && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= 7)
+# define _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER __attribute__ ((__unused__))
+# else
+# define _GL_UNUSED_PARAMETER
+# endif
+#endif
diff --git a/build-aux/snippet/warn-on-use.h b/build-aux/snippet/warn-on-use.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2948b47
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/snippet/warn-on-use.h
@@ -0,0 +1,109 @@
+/* A C macro for emitting warnings if a function is used.
+ Copyright (C) 2010-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
+
+/* _GL_WARN_ON_USE (function, "literal string") issues a declaration
+ for FUNCTION which will then trigger a compiler warning containing
+ the text of "literal string" anywhere that function is called, if
+ supported by the compiler. If the compiler does not support this
+ feature, the macro expands to an unused extern declaration.
+
+ This macro is useful for marking a function as a potential
+ portability trap, with the intent that "literal string" include
+ instructions on the replacement function that should be used
+ instead. However, one of the reasons that a function is a
+ portability trap is if it has the wrong signature. Declaring
+ FUNCTION with a different signature in C is a compilation error, so
+ this macro must use the same type as any existing declaration so
+ that programs that avoid the problematic FUNCTION do not fail to
+ compile merely because they included a header that poisoned the
+ function. But this implies that _GL_WARN_ON_USE is only safe to
+ use if FUNCTION is known to already have a declaration. Use of
+ this macro implies that there must not be any other macro hiding
+ the declaration of FUNCTION; but undefining FUNCTION first is part
+ of the poisoning process anyway (although for symbols that are
+ provided only via a macro, the result is a compilation error rather
+ than a warning containing "literal string"). Also note that in
+ C++, it is only safe to use if FUNCTION has no overloads.
+
+ For an example, it is possible to poison 'getline' by:
+ - adding a call to gl_WARN_ON_USE_PREPARE([[#include <stdio.h>]],
+ [getline]) in configure.ac, which potentially defines
+ HAVE_RAW_DECL_GETLINE
+ - adding this code to a header that wraps the system <stdio.h>:
+ #undef getline
+ #if HAVE_RAW_DECL_GETLINE
+ _GL_WARN_ON_USE (getline, "getline is required by POSIX 2008, but"
+ "not universally present; use the gnulib module getline");
+ #endif
+
+ It is not possible to directly poison global variables. But it is
+ possible to write a wrapper accessor function, and poison that
+ (less common usage, like &environ, will cause a compilation error
+ rather than issue the nice warning, but the end result of informing
+ the developer about their portability problem is still achieved):
+ #if HAVE_RAW_DECL_ENVIRON
+ static char ***rpl_environ (void) { return &environ; }
+ _GL_WARN_ON_USE (rpl_environ, "environ is not always properly declared");
+ # undef environ
+ # define environ (*rpl_environ ())
+ #endif
+ */
+#ifndef _GL_WARN_ON_USE
+
+# if 4 < __GNUC__ || (__GNUC__ == 4 && 3 <= __GNUC_MINOR__)
+/* A compiler attribute is available in gcc versions 4.3.0 and later. */
+# define _GL_WARN_ON_USE(function, message) \
+extern __typeof__ (function) function __attribute__ ((__warning__ (message)))
+# elif __GNUC__ >= 3 && GNULIB_STRICT_CHECKING
+/* Verify the existence of the function. */
+# define _GL_WARN_ON_USE(function, message) \
+extern __typeof__ (function) function
+# else /* Unsupported. */
+# define _GL_WARN_ON_USE(function, message) \
+_GL_WARN_EXTERN_C int _gl_warn_on_use
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* _GL_WARN_ON_USE_CXX (function, rettype, parameters_and_attributes, "string")
+ is like _GL_WARN_ON_USE (function, "string"), except that the function is
+ declared with the given prototype, consisting of return type, parameters,
+ and attributes.
+ This variant is useful for overloaded functions in C++. _GL_WARN_ON_USE does
+ not work in this case. */
+#ifndef _GL_WARN_ON_USE_CXX
+# if 4 < __GNUC__ || (__GNUC__ == 4 && 3 <= __GNUC_MINOR__)
+# define _GL_WARN_ON_USE_CXX(function,rettype,parameters_and_attributes,msg) \
+extern rettype function parameters_and_attributes \
+ __attribute__ ((__warning__ (msg)))
+# elif __GNUC__ >= 3 && GNULIB_STRICT_CHECKING
+/* Verify the existence of the function. */
+# define _GL_WARN_ON_USE_CXX(function,rettype,parameters_and_attributes,msg) \
+extern rettype function parameters_and_attributes
+# else /* Unsupported. */
+# define _GL_WARN_ON_USE_CXX(function,rettype,parameters_and_attributes,msg) \
+_GL_WARN_EXTERN_C int _gl_warn_on_use
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* _GL_WARN_EXTERN_C declaration;
+ performs the declaration with C linkage. */
+#ifndef _GL_WARN_EXTERN_C
+# if defined __cplusplus
+# define _GL_WARN_EXTERN_C extern "C"
+# else
+# define _GL_WARN_EXTERN_C extern
+# endif
+#endif
diff --git a/build-aux/test-driver b/build-aux/test-driver
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..8e575b0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/test-driver
@@ -0,0 +1,148 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+# test-driver - basic testsuite driver script.
+
+scriptversion=2013-07-13.22; # UTC
+
+# Copyright (C) 2011-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
+# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
+# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
+# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
+
+# This file is maintained in Automake, please report
+# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
+# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
+
+# Make unconditional expansion of undefined variables an error. This
+# helps a lot in preventing typo-related bugs.
+set -u
+
+usage_error ()
+{
+ echo "$0: $*" >&2
+ print_usage >&2
+ exit 2
+}
+
+print_usage ()
+{
+ cat <<END
+Usage:
+ test-driver --test-name=NAME --log-file=PATH --trs-file=PATH
+ [--expect-failure={yes|no}] [--color-tests={yes|no}]
+ [--enable-hard-errors={yes|no}] [--]
+ TEST-SCRIPT [TEST-SCRIPT-ARGUMENTS]
+The '--test-name', '--log-file' and '--trs-file' options are mandatory.
+END
+}
+
+test_name= # Used for reporting.
+log_file= # Where to save the output of the test script.
+trs_file= # Where to save the metadata of the test run.
+expect_failure=no
+color_tests=no
+enable_hard_errors=yes
+while test $# -gt 0; do
+ case $1 in
+ --help) print_usage; exit $?;;
+ --version) echo "test-driver $scriptversion"; exit $?;;
+ --test-name) test_name=$2; shift;;
+ --log-file) log_file=$2; shift;;
+ --trs-file) trs_file=$2; shift;;
+ --color-tests) color_tests=$2; shift;;
+ --expect-failure) expect_failure=$2; shift;;
+ --enable-hard-errors) enable_hard_errors=$2; shift;;
+ --) shift; break;;
+ -*) usage_error "invalid option: '$1'";;
+ *) break;;
+ esac
+ shift
+done
+
+missing_opts=
+test x"$test_name" = x && missing_opts="$missing_opts --test-name"
+test x"$log_file" = x && missing_opts="$missing_opts --log-file"
+test x"$trs_file" = x && missing_opts="$missing_opts --trs-file"
+if test x"$missing_opts" != x; then
+ usage_error "the following mandatory options are missing:$missing_opts"
+fi
+
+if test $# -eq 0; then
+ usage_error "missing argument"
+fi
+
+if test $color_tests = yes; then
+ # Keep this in sync with 'lib/am/check.am:$(am__tty_colors)'.
+ red='' # Red.
+ grn='' # Green.
+ lgn='' # Light green.
+ blu='' # Blue.
+ mgn='' # Magenta.
+ std='' # No color.
+else
+ red= grn= lgn= blu= mgn= std=
+fi
+
+do_exit='rm -f $log_file $trs_file; (exit $st); exit $st'
+trap "st=129; $do_exit" 1
+trap "st=130; $do_exit" 2
+trap "st=141; $do_exit" 13
+trap "st=143; $do_exit" 15
+
+# Test script is run here.
+"$@" >$log_file 2>&1
+estatus=$?
+
+if test $enable_hard_errors = no && test $estatus -eq 99; then
+ tweaked_estatus=1
+else
+ tweaked_estatus=$estatus
+fi
+
+case $tweaked_estatus:$expect_failure in
+ 0:yes) col=$red res=XPASS recheck=yes gcopy=yes;;
+ 0:*) col=$grn res=PASS recheck=no gcopy=no;;
+ 77:*) col=$blu res=SKIP recheck=no gcopy=yes;;
+ 99:*) col=$mgn res=ERROR recheck=yes gcopy=yes;;
+ *:yes) col=$lgn res=XFAIL recheck=no gcopy=yes;;
+ *:*) col=$red res=FAIL recheck=yes gcopy=yes;;
+esac
+
+# Report the test outcome and exit status in the logs, so that one can
+# know whether the test passed or failed simply by looking at the '.log'
+# file, without the need of also peaking into the corresponding '.trs'
+# file (automake bug#11814).
+echo "$res $test_name (exit status: $estatus)" >>$log_file
+
+# Report outcome to console.
+echo "${col}${res}${std}: $test_name"
+
+# Register the test result, and other relevant metadata.
+echo ":test-result: $res" > $trs_file
+echo ":global-test-result: $res" >> $trs_file
+echo ":recheck: $recheck" >> $trs_file
+echo ":copy-in-global-log: $gcopy" >> $trs_file
+
+# Local Variables:
+# mode: shell-script
+# sh-indentation: 2
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/texinfo.tex b/build-aux/texinfo.tex
index 629b88b..936c32d 100644
--- a/build-aux/texinfo.tex
+++ b/build-aux/texinfo.tex
@@ -1,18 +1,19 @@
% texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
-%
+%
% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
%
-\def\texinfoversion{2007-03-14.11}
+\def\texinfoversion{2016-01-11.19}
%
-% Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
+% Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
% 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
-% 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+% 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016
+% Free Software Foundation, Inc.
%
-% This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+% This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
% modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
-% published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
-% your option) any later version.
+% published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
+% License, or (at your option) any later version.
%
% This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
% useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
@@ -20,19 +21,18 @@
% General Public License for more details.
%
% You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-% along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write
-% to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
-% Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
+% along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
%
% As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
% a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
-% restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
+% restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
+% of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
%
% Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
% reports; you can get the latest version from:
-% http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
-% ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
-% (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
+% http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or
+% http://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or
+% http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page)
% The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
%
@@ -67,7 +67,6 @@
\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
\catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
-
\chardef\other=12
% We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
@@ -95,10 +94,15 @@
\let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
\let\ptexplus=+
+\let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright
\let\ptexrbrace=\}
\let\ptexslash=\/
+\let\ptexsp=\sp
\let\ptexstar=\*
+\let\ptexsup=\sup
\let\ptext=\t
+\let\ptextop=\top
+{\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode
% If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
% starts a new line in the output.
@@ -116,10 +120,11 @@
% Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
+\ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi
\ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
\ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
-\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
-\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
+\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
+\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
\ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
\ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
\ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
@@ -153,20 +158,11 @@
\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
-% Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
-\chardef\spacecat = 10
-\def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
+% Give the space character the catcode for a space.
+\def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =10\relax}
-% sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
-\chardef\colonChar = `\:
-\chardef\commaChar = `\,
\chardef\dashChar = `\-
-\chardef\dotChar = `\.
-\chardef\exclamChar= `\!
-\chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
-\chardef\questChar = `\?
-\chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
-\chardef\semiChar = `\;
+\chardef\slashChar = `\/
\chardef\underChar = `\_
% Ignore a token.
@@ -188,46 +184,6 @@
wide-spread wrap-around
}
-% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
-\newdimen\bindingoffset
-\newdimen\normaloffset
-\newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
-
-% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
-% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
-% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
-%
-\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
-
-% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
-% surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
-% change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
-% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
-% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
-%
-\def\|{%
- % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
- \leavevmode
- %
- % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
- \vadjust{%
- % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
- % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
- \vskip-\baselineskip
- %
- % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
- % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
- \llap{%
- %
- % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
- \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
- %
- % This is the space between the bar and the text.
- \hskip 12pt
- }%
- }%
-}
-
% Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
% and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
% since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
@@ -244,7 +200,7 @@
\tracingmacros2
\tracingrestores1
\showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
- \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
+ \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
\tracingscantokens1
\tracingifs1
\tracinggroups1
@@ -255,6 +211,13 @@
\errorcontextlines16
}%
+% @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
+% aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
+% after all.
+%
+\def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
+\def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
+
% add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
% we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
%
@@ -265,7 +228,15 @@
\def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
\removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
-% For @cropmarks command.
+% Output routine
+%
+
+% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
+% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
+% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
+%
+\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt }
+
% Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
%
\newif\ifcropmarks
@@ -279,27 +250,119 @@
\newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
+% Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
+% We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
+% This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
+%
+% A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
+% \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
+%
+% Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
+% (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
+% of a page, or that at the bottom of a page.
+
+% \domark is called twice inside \chapmacro, to add one
+% mark before the section break, and one after.
+% In the second call \prevchapterdefs is the same as \lastchapterdefs,
+% and \prevsectiondefs is the same as \lastsectiondefs.
+% Then if the page is not broken at the mark, some of the previous
+% section appears on the page, and we can get the name of this section
+% from \firstmark for @everyheadingmarks top.
+% @everyheadingmarks bottom uses \botmark.
+%
+% See page 260 of The TeXbook.
+\def\domark{%
+ \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
+ \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
+ \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
+ \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
+ \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
+ \mark{%
+ \the\toks0 \the\toks2 % 0: marks for @everyheadingmarks top
+ \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 % 1: for @everyheadingmarks bottom
+ \noexpand\else \the\toks8 % 2: color marks
+ }%
+}
+
+% \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks,
+% \getcolormarks - extract needed part of mark.
+%
+% \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
+% page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
+% the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
+% @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
+% first @chapter.
+\def\gettopheadingmarks{%
+ \ifcase0\topmark\fi
+ \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
+}
+\def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
+\def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
+
+% Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
+\def\lastchapterdefs{}
+\def\lastsectiondefs{}
+\def\lastsection{}
+\def\prevchapterdefs{}
+\def\prevsectiondefs{}
+\def\lastcolordefs{}
+
+% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
+\newdimen\bindingoffset
+\newdimen\normaloffset
+\newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
+
% Main output routine.
+%
\chardef\PAGE = 255
\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
\newbox\headlinebox
\newbox\footlinebox
-% \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
-% does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
+% \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument.
+% \shipout a vbox for a single page, adding an optional header, footer,
+% cropmarks, and footnote. This also causes index entries for this page
+% to be written to the auxiliary files.
+%
\def\onepageout#1{%
\ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
%
\ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
\else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
%
+ % Common context changes for both heading and footing.
% Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
% the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
- \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
- \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
+ \def\commmonheadfootline{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \texinfochars}
+ %
+ % Retrieve the information for the headings from the marks in the page,
+ % and call Plain TeX's \makeheadline and \makefootline, which use the
+ % values in \headline and \footline.
+ %
+ % This is used to check if we are on the first page of a chapter.
+ \ifcase1\topmark\fi
+ \let\prevchaptername\thischaptername
+ \ifcase0\firstmark\fi
+ \let\curchaptername\thischaptername
+ %
+ \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
+ \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
+ %
+ \ifx\curchaptername\prevchaptername
+ \let\thischapterheading\thischapter
+ \else
+ % \thischapterheading is the same as \thischapter except it is blank
+ % for the first page of a chapter. This is to prevent the chapter name
+ % being shown twice.
+ \def\thischapterheading{}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ \global\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makeheadline}%
+ \global\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makefootline}%
%
{%
+ % Set context for writing to auxiliary files like index files.
% Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
% take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
% before the \shipout runs.
@@ -308,10 +371,10 @@
\normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
% the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
% We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
- % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
+ % \entry{{\indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
% "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
- % it needs to be
- % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
+ % it needs to be
+ % {\code {{\backslashcurfont }acronym}
\shipout\vbox{%
% Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
\ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
@@ -369,13 +432,14 @@
\newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
+% Main part of page, including any footnotes
\def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
{\catcode`\@ =11
\gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
% marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
\ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
\rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
-\dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1
+\dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
\ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
\ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
}
@@ -391,9 +455,13 @@
\def\nsbot{\vbox
{\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
+
+% Argument parsing
+
% Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
% the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
% macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
+% For example, \def\foo{\parsearg\fooxxx}.
%
\def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
\def\parseargusing#1#2{%
@@ -412,11 +480,13 @@
}%
}
-% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
+% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. Also remove a @texinfoc
+% comment (see \scanmacro for details). Pass the result on to \argcheckspaces.
\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
-\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
+\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argremovetexinfoc #1\texinfoc\ArgTerm}
+\def\argremovetexinfoc#1\texinfoc#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
-% Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
+% Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
%
% \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
% @end itemize @c foo
@@ -441,7 +511,7 @@
% to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
% We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
% just before passing the control to \argtorun.
-% (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
+% (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
% either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
% that a pair of braces would be stripped.
%
@@ -449,14 +519,13 @@
%
\def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
+
+% \parseargdef - define a command taking an argument on the line
+%
% \parseargdef\foo{...}
% is roughly equivalent to
% \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
% \def\Xfoo#1{...}
-%
-% Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
-% favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
-
\def\parseargdef#1{%
\expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
}
@@ -498,12 +567,12 @@
% used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
%
% Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
-% are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The
+% are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
% implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
% special case.)
-% At runtime, environments start with this:
+% At run-time, environments start with this:
\def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
% initialize
\let\thisenv\empty
@@ -521,7 +590,7 @@
\fi
}
-% Evironment mismatch, #1 expected:
+% Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
\def\badenverr{%
\errhelp = \EMsimple
\errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
@@ -529,7 +598,7 @@
}
\def\inenvironment#1{%
\ifx#1\empty
- out of any environment%
+ outside of any environment%
\else
in environment \expandafter\string#1%
\fi
@@ -541,7 +610,7 @@
\parseargdef\end{%
\if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
\else
- % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
+ % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
\expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
\csname E#1\endcsname
\endgroup
@@ -551,85 +620,6 @@
\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
-%% Simple single-character @ commands
-
-% @@ prints an @
-% Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
-\def\@{{\tt\char64}}
-
-% This is turned off because it was never documented
-% and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
-%% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
-%% but suppressing ligatures.
-%\def\`{{`}}
-%\def\'{{'}}
-
-% Used to generate quoted braces.
-\def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
-\def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
-\let\{=\mylbrace
-\let\}=\myrbrace
-\begingroup
- % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
- % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
- \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
- \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
- \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
- !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
- !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
- !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
- !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
-!endgroup
-
-% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
-\let\comma = ,
-
-% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
-% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
-\let\, = \c
-\let\dotaccent = \.
-\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
-\let\tieaccent = \t
-\let\ubaraccent = \b
-\let\udotaccent = \d
-
-% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
-% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
-\def\questiondown{?`}
-\def\exclamdown{!`}
-\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
-\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
-
-% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
-\def\imacro{i}
-\def\jmacro{j}
-\def\dotless#1{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi
- \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j
- \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
-% period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
-%
-\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
-
-% @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
-% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
-% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
-% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
-% \scriptscriptstyle).
-%
-\def\LaTeX{%
- L\kern-.36em
- {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
- \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
- \kern-.15em
- \TeX
-}
-
% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
@@ -646,7 +636,7 @@
\def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
% @* forces a line break.
-\def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
+\def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
% @/ allows a line break.
\let\/=\allowbreak
@@ -661,7 +651,7 @@
\def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
% @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
-%
+%
\def\onword{on}
\def\offword{off}
%
@@ -671,7 +661,7 @@
\else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
\else
\errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}%
+ \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}%
\fi\fi
}
@@ -725,6 +715,12 @@
\endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
\global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
\egroup % End the \vtop.
+ \addgroupbox
+ \prevdepth = \dimen1
+ \checkinserts
+}
+
+\def\addgroupbox{
% \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
\dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
% \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
@@ -737,9 +733,8 @@
\fi
\fi
\box\groupbox
- \prevdepth = \dimen1
- \checkinserts
}
+
%
% TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
% message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
@@ -753,15 +748,6 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.}
\newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
-% Old definition--didn't work.
-%\parseargdef\need{\par %
-%% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
-%% if the depth of the box does not fit.
-%{\baselineskip=0pt%
-%\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
-%\prevdepth=-1000pt
-%}}
-
\parseargdef\need{%
% Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
% paragraph.
@@ -825,7 +811,7 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.}
% @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
% paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
-% class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
+% class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual.
%
\newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
\def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
@@ -872,15 +858,51 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.}
\temp
}
-% @include file insert text of that file as input.
+% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
+% surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
+% change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
+% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
+% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). This command
+% is not documented, not supported, and doesn't work.
+%
+\def\|{%
+ % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
+ \leavevmode
+ %
+ % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
+ \vadjust{%
+ % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
+ % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
+ \vskip-\baselineskip
+ %
+ % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
+ % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
+ \llap{%
+ %
+ % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
+ \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
+ %
+ % This is the space between the bar and the text.
+ \hskip 12pt
+ }%
+ }%
+}
+
+% @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
%
\def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
\def\includezzz#1{%
\pushthisfilestack
\def\thisfile{#1}%
{%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \def\temp{\input #1 }%
+ \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
+ \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
+ \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
+ \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}%
+ \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
+ %
+ % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
+ % definitions, etc.
\expandafter
}\temp
\popthisfilestack
@@ -895,6 +917,8 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.}
\catcode`>=\other
\catcode`+=\other
\catcode`-=\other
+ \catcode`\`=\other
+ \catcode`\'=\other
}
\def\pushthisfilestack{%
@@ -910,7 +934,7 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.}
\def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
\def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
the stack of filenames is empty.}}
-
+%
\def\thisfile{}
% @center line
@@ -918,37 +942,55 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.}
%
\parseargdef\center{%
\ifhmode
- \let\next\centerH
+ \let\centersub\centerH
\else
- \let\next\centerV
+ \let\centersub\centerV
\fi
- \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
+ \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
+ \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case
}
-\def\centerH#1{%
- {%
- \hfil\break
- \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
- \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
- \line{#1}%
- \break
- }%
+\def\centerH#1{{%
+ \hfil\break
+ \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
+ \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
+ \line{#1}%
+ \break
+}}
+%
+\newcount\centerpenalty
+\def\centerV#1{%
+ % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if
+ % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe
+ % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still
+ % prevent a page break here.
+ \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty
+ \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
+ \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi
+ \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}%
}
-\def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
% @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
-
+%
\parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
% @comment ...line which is ignored...
% @c is the same as @comment
% @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
+%
+\def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\active%
+\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other\commentxxx}%
-\def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
-\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
-\commentxxx}
-{\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
+{\catcode`\^^M=\active%
+\gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup%
+\futurelet\nexttoken\commentxxxx}%
+\gdef\commentxxxx{\ifx\nexttoken\aftermacro\expandafter\comment\fi}%
+}
-\let\c=\comment
+\def\c{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\active%
+\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
+\cxxx}
+{\catcode`\^^M=\active \gdef\cxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
+% See comment in \scanmacro about why the definitions of @c and @comment differ
% @paragraphindent NCHARS
% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
@@ -1019,158 +1061,23 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.}
% paragraph.
%
\gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
- \gdef\indent{%
- \restorefirstparagraphindent
- \indent
- }%
- \gdef\noindent{%
- \restorefirstparagraphindent
- \noindent
- }%
- \global\everypar = {%
- \kern -\parindent
- \restorefirstparagraphindent
- }%
+ \gdef\indent {\restorefirstparagraphindent \indent}%
+ \gdef\noindent{\restorefirstparagraphindent \noindent}%
+ \global\everypar = {\kern -\parindent \restorefirstparagraphindent}%
}
-
-\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
- \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
- \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
- \global \everypar = {}%
-}
-
-
-% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
%
-\def\asis#1{#1}
-
-% @math outputs its argument in math mode.
-%
-% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
-% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
-% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
-% which is what @var uses.
-{
- \catcode`\_ = \active
- \gdef\mathunderscore{%
- \catcode`\_=\active
- \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
- }
-}
-% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
-% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
-% this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
-% otherwise define @\.
-%
-% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
-\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
-%
-\def\math{%
- \tex
- \mathunderscore
- \let\\ = \mathbackslash
- \mathactive
- $\finishmath
-}
-\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
-
-% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
-% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
-% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
-%
-{
- \catcode`^ = \active
- \catcode`< = \active
- \catcode`> = \active
- \catcode`+ = \active
- \gdef\mathactive{%
- \let^ = \ptexhat
- \let< = \ptexless
- \let> = \ptexgtr
- \let+ = \ptexplus
- }
-}
-
-% @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
-\def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
-\def\minus{$-$}
-
-% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
-% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
-% typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
-% in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
-% whichever is larger.
-%
-\def\dots{%
- \leavevmode
- \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
- \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
- \dimen0 = \wd0
- \else
- \dimen0 = 1.5em
- \fi
- \hbox to \dimen0{%
- \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
- .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
- .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
- .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
- }%
-}
-
-% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
-%
-\def\enddots{%
- \dots
- \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
+\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
+ \global\let\indent = \ptexindent
+ \global\let\noindent = \ptexnoindent
+ \global\everypar = {}%
}
-% @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
-% Texinfo's parsing.
-%
-\let\comma = ,
% @refill is a no-op.
\let\refill=\relax
-% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
-% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
-% This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
-%
-\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
-\let\novalidate = \linksfalse
-
-% @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
-% So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
-% This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
-\def\setfilename{%
- \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
- \iflinks
- \tryauxfile
- % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
- \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
- \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
- \openindices
- \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
- %
- % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
- % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
- \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
- \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
- \closein 1
- %
- \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
-}
-
-% Called from \setfilename.
-%
-\def\openindices{%
- \newindex{cp}%
- \newcodeindex{fn}%
- \newcodeindex{vr}%
- \newcodeindex{tp}%
- \newcodeindex{ky}%
- \newcodeindex{pg}%
-}
+% @setfilename INFO-FILENAME - ignored
+\let\setfilename=\comment
% @bye.
\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
@@ -1188,14 +1095,14 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.}
\newtoks\toksC
\newtoks\toksD
\newbox\boxA
+\newbox\boxB
\newcount\countA
\newif\ifpdf
\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
% when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
-% can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
-% borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
-\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
+% can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
+\ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
\else
\ifx\pdfoutput\relax
\else
@@ -1210,50 +1117,24 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.}
% for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
% double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
% interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
-% http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
-% (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
-% user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
-% that's what we do).
-
-% double active backslashes.
-%
-{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
- @gdef@activebackslashdouble{%
- @catcode`@\=@active
- @let\=@doublebackslash}
-}
-
-% To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
-% not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
-% us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens, with minor
-% changes for Texinfo. It is included here under the GPL by permission
-% from the author, Heiko Oberdiek.
-%
-% #1 is the tokens to replace.
-% #2 is the replacement.
-% #3 is the control sequence with the string.
%
-\def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
- \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{%
- ##1%
- \ifx\\##2\\%
- \else
- #2%
- \HyReturnAfterFi{%
- \HyPsdReplace##2\END
- }%
- \fi
- }%
- \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
-}
-\long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
-
-% #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
-\def\backslashparens#1{%
- \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
- % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
- \HyPsdSubst{(}{\realbackslash(}{#1}%
- \HyPsdSubst{)}{\realbackslash)}{#1}%
+% See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
+% related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
+% to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
+% that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
+% do this reliably, so we use it.
+
+% #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
+% which we \xdef.
+\def\txiescapepdf#1{%
+ \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined
+ % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
+ % Many times it won't matter.
+ \else
+ % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
+ % backslashes, and other special chars.
+ \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
+ \fi
}
\newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
@@ -1262,47 +1143,99 @@ be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
output) for that.)}
\ifpdf
- \input pdfcolor
+ %
+ % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex,
+ % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
+ % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
+ % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as
+ % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. We use
+ % black by default, though.
+ \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
+ \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
+ %
+ % rg sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
+ % RG sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
+ \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}}
+ %
+ % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
+ % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
+ \def\setcolor#1{%
+ \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
+ \domark
+ \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
+ }
+ %
+ \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
+ \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
+ \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
+ \def\lastcolordefs{}
+ %
+ \def\makefootline{%
+ \baselineskip24pt
+ \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
+ }
+ %
+ \def\makeheadline{%
+ \vbox to 0pt{%
+ \vskip-22.5pt
+ \line{%
+ \vbox to8.5pt{}%
+ % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
+ \getcolormarks
+ % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
+ \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
+ }%
+ \vss
+ }%
+ \nointerlineskip
+ }
+ %
+ %
\pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
%
% #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
\def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
- \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
+ \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
+ \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
%
- % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .png, .jpg, .pdf (among
- % others). Let's try in that order.
+ % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
+ % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
+ % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
+ % bitmap.
\let\pdfimgext=\empty
\begingroup
- \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
- \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
- \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
+ \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
+ \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
+ \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
+ \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
+ \fi
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
\fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
\fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
\fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
\fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
+ \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
\fi
\closein 1
\endgroup
%
- % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is
+ % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
% included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
\ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
\immediate\pdfimage
\else
\immediate\pdfximage
\fi
- \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \imagewidth \fi
- \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \imageheight \fi
+ \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi
+ \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi
\ifnum\pdftexversion<13
#1.\pdfimgext
\else
@@ -1317,18 +1250,19 @@ output) for that.)}
% such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
\indexnofonts
\turnoffactive
- \activebackslashdouble
\makevalueexpandable
\def\pdfdestname{#1}%
- \backslashparens\pdfdestname
- \pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz%
+ \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
+ \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
}}
%
% used to mark target names; must be expandable.
\def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
%
- \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light?
- \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink}
+ % by default, use black for everything.
+ \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
+ \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
+ \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
%
% Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
% come from Petr Olsak
@@ -1349,29 +1283,24 @@ output) for that.)}
% page number. We could generate a destination for the section
% text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
% seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
- \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
+ \edef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
\ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
\def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
\else
- % Doubled backslashes in the name.
- {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
- \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
+ \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinedest
\fi
%
- % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
- {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
- \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
+ % Also escape PDF chars in the display string.
+ \edef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
+ \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
%
\pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
}
%
\def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
\begingroup
- % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
- \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
- \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
- %
% Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
+ \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
\def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
\def\thischapnum{##2}%
\def\thissecnum{0}%
@@ -1425,25 +1354,41 @@ output) for that.)}
% Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
% Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
%
- % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
- % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
- % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
+ % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
+ % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too
+ % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents
+ % we use for the index sort strings.
+ %
\indexnofonts
\setupdatafile
+ % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
+ % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
+ \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
+ \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
\catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
- \input \jobname.toc
+ \input \tocreadfilename
\endgroup
}
+ {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
+ \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
+ \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
+ \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
+ ]
%
\def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
\ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
\else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
- \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
- \advance\filenamelength by 1
- \fi
+ \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
+ \advance\filenamelength by 1
\fi
\nextsp}
- \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax}
+ \def\getfilename#1{%
+ \filenamelength=0
+ % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
+ % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
+ \edef\temp{#1}%
+ \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
+ }
\ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
\let \startlink \pdfannotlink
\else
@@ -1456,12 +1401,16 @@ output) for that.)}
% tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
% of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
% people have actually reported a problem with.
- %
+ %
\normalturnoffactive
\def\@{@}%
\let\/=\empty
\makevalueexpandable
- \leavevmode\Red
+ % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
+ % special-casing \var here?
+ \def\var##1{##1}%
+ %
+ \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
\startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
\endgroup}
@@ -1488,13 +1437,15 @@ output) for that.)}
{\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
\def\pdflink#1{%
\startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
- \linkcolor #1\endlink}
+ \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
\def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
\else
+ % non-pdf mode
\let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
\let\pdfurl = \gobble
\let\endlink = \relax
- \let\linkcolor = \relax
+ \let\setcolor = \gobble
+ \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
\let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
@@ -1520,6 +1471,10 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
\def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
+% Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since
+% in those cases "rm" is bold. Sigh.
+\def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf}}
+
% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
% So we set up a \sf.
\newfam\sffam
@@ -1530,9 +1485,6 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
-% Default leading.
-\newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt
-
% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
@@ -1541,8 +1493,13 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
%
+% can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
+\def\baselinefactor{1}
+%
+\newdimen\textleading
\def\setleading#1{%
- \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax
+ \dimen0 = #1\relax
+ \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
\normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
\normalbaselines
\setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
@@ -1551,22 +1508,295 @@ output) for that.)}
}%
}
+% PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
+%
+% do nothing with this by default.
+\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
+\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
+\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
+
+% if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
+% (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
+% older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
+\ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
+ \begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
+ \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
+%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
+%%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
+%%Version: 1.000
+%%EndComments
+/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
+12 dict begin
+begincmap
+/CIDSystemInfo
+<< /Registry (TeX)
+/Ordering (OT1)
+/Supplement 0
+>> def
+/CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
+/CMapType 2 def
+1 begincodespacerange
+<00> <7F>
+endcodespacerange
+8 beginbfrange
+<00> <01> <0393>
+<09> <0A> <03A8>
+<23> <26> <0023>
+<28> <3B> <0028>
+<3F> <5B> <003F>
+<5D> <5E> <005D>
+<61> <7A> <0061>
+<7B> <7C> <2013>
+endbfrange
+40 beginbfchar
+<02> <0398>
+<03> <039B>
+<04> <039E>
+<05> <03A0>
+<06> <03A3>
+<07> <03D2>
+<08> <03A6>
+<0B> <00660066>
+<0C> <00660069>
+<0D> <0066006C>
+<0E> <006600660069>
+<0F> <00660066006C>
+<10> <0131>
+<11> <0237>
+<12> <0060>
+<13> <00B4>
+<14> <02C7>
+<15> <02D8>
+<16> <00AF>
+<17> <02DA>
+<18> <00B8>
+<19> <00DF>
+<1A> <00E6>
+<1B> <0153>
+<1C> <00F8>
+<1D> <00C6>
+<1E> <0152>
+<1F> <00D8>
+<21> <0021>
+<22> <201D>
+<27> <2019>
+<3C> <00A1>
+<3D> <003D>
+<3E> <00BF>
+<5C> <201C>
+<5F> <02D9>
+<60> <2018>
+<7D> <02DD>
+<7E> <007E>
+<7F> <00A8>
+endbfchar
+endcmap
+CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
+end
+end
+%%EndResource
+%%EOF
+ }\endgroup
+ \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
+ \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
+ }%
+%
+% \cmapOT1IT
+ \begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
+ \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
+%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
+%%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
+%%Version: 1.000
+%%EndComments
+/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
+12 dict begin
+begincmap
+/CIDSystemInfo
+<< /Registry (TeX)
+/Ordering (OT1IT)
+/Supplement 0
+>> def
+/CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
+/CMapType 2 def
+1 begincodespacerange
+<00> <7F>
+endcodespacerange
+8 beginbfrange
+<00> <01> <0393>
+<09> <0A> <03A8>
+<25> <26> <0025>
+<28> <3B> <0028>
+<3F> <5B> <003F>
+<5D> <5E> <005D>
+<61> <7A> <0061>
+<7B> <7C> <2013>
+endbfrange
+42 beginbfchar
+<02> <0398>
+<03> <039B>
+<04> <039E>
+<05> <03A0>
+<06> <03A3>
+<07> <03D2>
+<08> <03A6>
+<0B> <00660066>
+<0C> <00660069>
+<0D> <0066006C>
+<0E> <006600660069>
+<0F> <00660066006C>
+<10> <0131>
+<11> <0237>
+<12> <0060>
+<13> <00B4>
+<14> <02C7>
+<15> <02D8>
+<16> <00AF>
+<17> <02DA>
+<18> <00B8>
+<19> <00DF>
+<1A> <00E6>
+<1B> <0153>
+<1C> <00F8>
+<1D> <00C6>
+<1E> <0152>
+<1F> <00D8>
+<21> <0021>
+<22> <201D>
+<23> <0023>
+<24> <00A3>
+<27> <2019>
+<3C> <00A1>
+<3D> <003D>
+<3E> <00BF>
+<5C> <201C>
+<5F> <02D9>
+<60> <2018>
+<7D> <02DD>
+<7E> <007E>
+<7F> <00A8>
+endbfchar
+endcmap
+CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
+end
+end
+%%EndResource
+%%EOF
+ }\endgroup
+ \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
+ \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
+ }%
+%
+% \cmapOT1TT
+ \begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
+ \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
+%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
+%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
+%%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
+%%Version: 1.000
+%%EndComments
+/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
+12 dict begin
+begincmap
+/CIDSystemInfo
+<< /Registry (TeX)
+/Ordering (OT1TT)
+/Supplement 0
+>> def
+/CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
+/CMapType 2 def
+1 begincodespacerange
+<00> <7F>
+endcodespacerange
+5 beginbfrange
+<00> <01> <0393>
+<09> <0A> <03A8>
+<21> <26> <0021>
+<28> <5F> <0028>
+<61> <7E> <0061>
+endbfrange
+32 beginbfchar
+<02> <0398>
+<03> <039B>
+<04> <039E>
+<05> <03A0>
+<06> <03A3>
+<07> <03D2>
+<08> <03A6>
+<0B> <2191>
+<0C> <2193>
+<0D> <0027>
+<0E> <00A1>
+<0F> <00BF>
+<10> <0131>
+<11> <0237>
+<12> <0060>
+<13> <00B4>
+<14> <02C7>
+<15> <02D8>
+<16> <00AF>
+<17> <02DA>
+<18> <00B8>
+<19> <00DF>
+<1A> <00E6>
+<1B> <0153>
+<1C> <00F8>
+<1D> <00C6>
+<1E> <0152>
+<1F> <00D8>
+<20> <2423>
+<27> <2019>
+<60> <2018>
+<7F> <00A8>
+endbfchar
+endcmap
+CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
+end
+end
+%%EndResource
+%%EOF
+ }\endgroup
+ \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
+ \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
+ }%
+\fi\fi
-% Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
-% specified font prefix (normally `cm').
-% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor
-\def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4}
+% Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2.
+% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
+% encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit).
+% Example:
+% #1 = \textrm
+% #2 = \rmshape
+% #3 = 10
+% #4 = \mainmagstep
+% #5 = OT1
+%
+\def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
+ \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
+ \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
+}
+% This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
+\let\cmap\gobble
+%
+% (end of cmaps)
% Use cm as the default font prefix.
% To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
% before you read in texinfo.tex.
-\ifx\fontprefix\undefined
+\ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
\def\fontprefix{cm}
\fi
% Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
\def\rmshape{r}
-\def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold
+\def\rmbshape{bx} % where the normal face is bold
\def\bfshape{b}
\def\bxshape{bx}
\def\ttshape{tt}
@@ -1581,271 +1811,286 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\scshape{csc}
\def\scbshape{csc}
-% Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in
-% Texinfo.
-%
+% Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. (The default in Texinfo.)
+%
\def\definetextfontsizexi{%
% Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
\def\textnominalsize{11pt}
\edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
+\def\textecsize{1095}
% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
-\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}
-\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
+\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf
+\let\tenttsl=\defttsl \let\tensl=\defsl \bf}
% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}
-\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}
-\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}
+\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
\font\smalli=cmmi9
\font\smallsy=cmsy9
+\def\smallecsize{0900}
% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
-\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}
-\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}
-\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}
+\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
\font\smalleri=cmmi8
\font\smallersy=cmsy8
+\def\smallerecsize{0800}
% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
-\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}
-\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}
-\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}
-\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
+\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
+\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
\let\titlebf=\titlerm
-\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
-\def\authorrm{\secrm}
-\def\authortt{\sectt}
+\def\titleecsize{2074}
% Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
\def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
-\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}
+\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
+\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
+\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
\let\chapbf=\chaprm
-\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
+\def\chapecsize{1728}
% Section fonts (14.4pt).
\def\secnominalsize{14pt}
-\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\secrmnotbold\rmshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
+\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
\let\secbf\secrm
-\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
\font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
+\def\sececsize{1440}
% Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
\def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
-\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}
-\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}
-\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}
-\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
-\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}
+\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
\font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
+\def\ssececsize{1200}
% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
\def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
-\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
\font\reducedi=cmmi10
\font\reducedsy=cmsy10
+\def\reducedecsize{1000}
-% reset the current fonts
-\textfonts
+\textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM
+\textfonts % reset the current fonts
\rm
-} % end of 11pt text font size definitions
+} % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi
% Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
% section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
% Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
% future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
-%
+%
\def\definetextfontsizex{%
% Text fonts (10pt).
\def\textnominalsize{10pt}
\edef\mainmagstep{1000}
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
-\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
+\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
+\def\textecsize{1000}
% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
-\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}
-\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
+\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
+\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
+\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf
+\let\tensl=\defsl \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}
-\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}
-\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}
+\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
\font\smalli=cmmi9
\font\smallsy=cmsy9
+\def\smallecsize{0900}
% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
-\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}
-\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}
-\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}
-\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}
+\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
+\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
\font\smalleri=cmmi8
\font\smallersy=cmsy8
+\def\smallerecsize{0800}
% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
-\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}
-\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}
-\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}
-\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}
-\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
+\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
+\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
\let\titlebf=\titlerm
-\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
-\def\authorrm{\secrm}
-\def\authortt{\sectt}
+\def\titleecsize{2074}
% Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
\def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
-\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}
-\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
+\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
\let\chapbf\chaprm
-\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
+\def\chapecsize{1440}
% Section fonts (12pt).
\def\secnominalsize{12pt}
-\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}
-\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}
-\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}
-\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}
+\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
\let\secbf\secrm
-\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}
-\font\seci=cmmi12
+\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\font\seci=cmmi12
\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
+\def\sececsize{1200}
% Subsection fonts (10pt).
\def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
-\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}
-\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
-\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
\font\sseci=cmmi10
\font\ssecsy=cmsy10
+\def\ssececsize{1000}
% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
\def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}
-\setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}
-\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}
-\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}
+\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
+\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
+\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
\font\reducedi=cmmi9
\font\reducedsy=cmsy9
+\def\reducedecsize{0900}
-% reduce space between paragraphs
-\divide\parskip by 2
-
-% reset the current fonts
-\textfonts
+\divide\parskip by 2 % reduce space between paragraphs
+\textleading = 12pt % line spacing for 10pt CM
+\textfonts % reset the current fonts
\rm
-} % end of 10pt text font size definitions
+} % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex
% We provide the user-level command
% @fonttextsize 10
% (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
-%
-\def\xword{10}
+%
\def\xiword{11}
+\def\xword{10}
+\def\xwordpt{10pt}
%
\parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
\def\textsizearg{#1}%
- \wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
+ %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
%
% Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
% makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
- %
+ %
\begingroup \globaldefs=1
\ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
\else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
@@ -1856,12 +2101,9 @@ output) for that.)}
\endgroup
}
-
% In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
-% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
-% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
-% in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
-% \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
+% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. We don't
+% bother to reset \scriptfont and \scriptscriptfont; awaiting user need.
%
\def\resetmathfonts{%
\textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
@@ -1875,8 +2117,8 @@ output) for that.)}
% \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
%
% Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
-% and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
-% the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
+% and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used
+% in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
%
% This all needs generalizing, badly.
%
@@ -1895,8 +2137,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
\def\curfontsize{title}%
\def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
-\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{27pt}}
+\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}}
\def\chapfonts{%
\let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
\let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
@@ -1912,7 +2154,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\let\tenttsl=\secttsl
\def\curfontsize{sec}%
\def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{17pt}}
\def\subsecfonts{%
\let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
\let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
@@ -1947,6 +2189,16 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
\resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
+% Fonts for short table of contents.
+\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
+\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
+
+% Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
+\def\angleleft{$\langle$}
+\def\angleright{$\rangle$}
+
% Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
\let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
@@ -1960,53 +2212,215 @@ output) for that.)}
%
% By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
% 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
-%
-% I wish the USA used A4 paper.
% --karl, 24jan03.
-
% Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
%
\definetextfontsizexi
-% Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
-\def\angleleft{$\langle$}
-\def\angleright{$\rangle$}
+
+\message{markup,}
+
+% Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
+% Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
+% shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
+% this property, we can check that font parameter.
+%
+\def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
+
+% Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
+% define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
+% \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
+% style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles
+% currently in effect.
+\newif\ifmarkupvar
+\newif\ifmarkupsamp
+\newif\ifmarkupkey
+%\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp.
+%\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp.
+\newif\ifmarkupcode
+\newif\ifmarkupkbd
+%\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code.
+%\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code.
+\newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now).
+\newif\ifmarkupexample
+\newif\ifmarkupverb
+\newif\ifmarkupverbatim
+
+\let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
+
+\def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
+ \csname markup#1true\endcsname
+ \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
+ \markupstylesetup
+}
+
+\let\markupstylesetup\empty
+
+\def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
+ \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
+ \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
+ \def#1%
+}
+
+% Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
+\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
+ \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
+ \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
+}
+
+\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
+ \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
+ \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
+}
+
+{
+\catcode`\'=\active
+\catcode`\`=\active
+
+\gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
+\gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
+
+\gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
+\gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
+}
+
+\let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
+\let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
+%
+\let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
+\let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
+%
+\let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetcodequoteleft
+\let\markupsetuprqkbd \markupsetcodequoteright
+%
+\let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
+\let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
+%
+\let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
+\let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
+%
+\let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
+\let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
+
+% Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
+% (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
+% The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
+% works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
+% lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
+%
+\def\codequoteright{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
+ '%
+ \else \char'15 \fi
+ \else \char'15 \fi
+}
+%
+% and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
+% Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
+% the code environments to do likewise.
+%
+\def\codequoteleft{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
+ % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
+ % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
+ \relax`%
+ \else \char'22 \fi
+ \else \char'22 \fi
+}
+
+% Commands to set the quote options.
+%
+\parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\onword
+ \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
+ = t%
+ \else\ifx\temp\offword
+ \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
+ = \relax
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+%
+\parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\onword
+ \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
+ = t%
+ \else\ifx\temp\offword
+ \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
+ = \relax
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+
+% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
+\def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
% Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
\newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
-% Fonts for short table of contents.
-\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}
-\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} % no cmb12
-\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}
-\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}
-
-%% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
-%% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
-
-% \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
-% unless the following character is such as not to need one.
-\def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else
- \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
-\def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-\def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-
-% like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
-% @var is set to this for defun arguments.
-\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-
-% like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
+% Font commands.
+
+% #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
+% If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
+% and 2) do not add an italic correction.
+\def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
+ \ifusingtt
+ {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}%
+ {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
+ \next
+}
+\def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
+\def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
+
+% Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
+% character) is such as not to need one.
+\def\smartitaliccorrection{%
+ \ifx\next,%
+ \else\ifx\next-%
+ \else\ifx\next.%
+ \else\ifx\next\.%
+ \else\ifx\next\comma%
+ \else\ptexslash
+ \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
+ \aftersmartic
+}
+
+% Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic. @var is set to this for defuns.
+\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
+
+% @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
% ttsl for book titles, do we?
-\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
+
+\def\aftersmartic{}
+\def\var#1{%
+ \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic
+ \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}%
+ \smartslanted{#1}%
+}
\let\i=\smartitalic
\let\slanted=\smartslanted
-\let\var=\smartslanted
\let\dfn=\smartslanted
\let\emph=\smartitalic
-% @b, explicit bold.
+% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
+\def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
+\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
+\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
+
+% @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
\def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
\let\strong=\b
@@ -2026,8 +2440,8 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\catcode`@=11
\def\plainfrenchspacing{%
- \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
- \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
+ \sfcode`\.=\@m \sfcode`\?=\@m \sfcode`\!=\@m
+ \sfcode`\:=\@m \sfcode`\;=\@m \sfcode`\,=\@m
\def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
}
\def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
@@ -2038,30 +2452,21 @@ output) for that.)}
\catcode`@=\other
\def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
+% @t, explicit typewriter.
\def\t#1{%
{\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
\null
}
-\def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null}
-\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
-\font\keysy=cmsy9
-\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
- \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
- \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
- \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
- \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
- \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
-\def\key #1{{\nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
-% The old definition, with no lozenge:
-%\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
-\def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
-
-% @file, @option are the same as @samp.
-\let\file=\samp
-\let\option=\samp
-
-% @code is a modification of @t,
-% which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
+
+% @samp.
+\def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
+
+% @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes.
+\let\indicateurl=\samp
+
+% @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same
+% size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc.
+% This is a subroutine for that.
\def\tclose#1{%
{%
% Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
@@ -2080,40 +2485,63 @@ output) for that.)}
\plainfrenchspacing
#1%
}%
- \null
+ \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
}
% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
+% (But see \codedashfinish below.)
% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
% in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
-
+%
% Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
% both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
% We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
-% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
-% -- rms.
+% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms.
{
\catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
\catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
+ \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions
%
\global\def\code{\begingroup
- \catcode\rquoteChar=\active \catcode\lquoteChar=\active
- \let'\codequoteright \let`\codequoteleft
- %
+ \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
+ % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
\catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
\ifallowcodebreaks
\let-\codedash
\let_\codeunder
\else
- \let-\realdash
+ \let-\normaldash
\let_\realunder
\fi
+ % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break
+ % after the hyphen.
+ \global\let\codedashprev=\codedash
+ %
\codex
}
+ %
+ \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish}
+ \gdef\codedashfinish{%
+ \normaldash % always output the dash character itself.
+ %
+ % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless
+ % (a) the next character is a -, or
+ % (b) the preceding character is a -.
+ % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -.
+ % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b.
+ \ifx\next\codedash \else
+ \ifx\codedashprev\codedash
+ \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi
+ \fi
+ % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a
+ % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise. As in @code{- a}.
+ \global\let\codedashprev= \next
+ }
}
+\def\normaldash{-}
+%
+\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
-\def\realdash{-}
-\def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
\def\codeunder{%
% this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
% is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
@@ -2125,13 +2553,12 @@ output) for that.)}
\discretionary{}{}{}}%
{\_}%
}
-\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
% An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
-% each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
-% some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
-% general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
-%
+% each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is bad.
+% @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at -
+% and _ on and off.
+%
\newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
\def\keywordtrue{true}
@@ -2145,75 +2572,135 @@ output) for that.)}
\allowcodebreaksfalse
\else
\errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}%
+ \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}%
\fi\fi
}
-% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
-% then @kbd has no effect.
-
-% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
-% `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
-% or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
-\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
- \def\txiarg{#1}%
- \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
- \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
- \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
- \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
- \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
- \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}%
- \fi\fi\fi
-}
-\def\worddistinct{distinct}
-\def\wordexample{example}
-\def\wordcode{code}
-
-% Default is `distinct.'
-\kbdinputstyle distinct
-
-\def\xkey{\key}
-\def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
-\ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
-\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
-\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
-
-% For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
-\let\indicateurl=\code
-\let\env=\code
+% For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary,
+% so use \code rather than \samp.
\let\command=\code
-
-% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
-% second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
-% arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
-% itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
-% a hypertex \special here.
-%
-\def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish}
-\def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup
+\let\env=\code
+\let\file=\code
+\let\option=\code
+
+% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional
+% (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and
+% an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in
+% addition to) the url itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url.
+
+% TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second
+% arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target).
+\newif\ifurefurlonlylink
+
+% The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected
+% places within the url. (There used to be another version, which
+% didn't support automatic breaking.)
+\def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
+\let\uref=\urefbreak
+%
+\def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish}
+\def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
\unsepspaces
\pdfurl{#1}%
\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
\unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
\else
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg
\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
\ifpdf
- \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
+ \ifurefurlonlylink
+ % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
+ \unhbox0
+ \else
+ % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
+ % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
+ \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
+ \fi
\else
- \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
+ \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI, always show arg and url
\fi
\else
- \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
+ \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
\fi
\fi
\endlink
\endgroup}
+% Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
+\def\urefcatcodes{%
+ \catcode`\&=\active \catcode`\.=\active
+ \catcode`\#=\active \catcode`\?=\active
+ \catcode`\/=\active
+}
+{
+ \urefcatcodes
+ %
+ \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
+ \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
+ \urefcatcodes
+ \let&\urefcodeamp
+ \let.\urefcodedot
+ \let#\urefcodehash
+ \let?\urefcodequest
+ \let/\urefcodeslash
+ \codex
+ }
+ %
+ % By default, they are just regular characters.
+ \global\def&{\normalamp}
+ \global\def.{\normaldot}
+ \global\def#{\normalhash}
+ \global\def?{\normalquest}
+ \global\def/{\normalslash}
+}
+
+% we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help
+% line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in
+% cmtt at least, especially for dots.
+\def\urefprestretchamount{.13em}
+\def\urefpoststretchamount{.1em}
+\def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
+\def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
+%
+\def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&\urefpoststretch}
+\def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .\urefpoststretch}
+\def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#\urefpoststretch}
+\def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?\urefpoststretch}
+\def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
+{
+ \catcode`\/=\active
+ \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
+ \urefprestretch \slashChar
+ % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
+ % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
+ \ifx\next/\else \urefpoststretch \fi
+ }
+}
+
+% One more complication: by default we'll break after the special
+% characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so
+% allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control.
+%
+\parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
+ \def\txiarg{#1}%
+ \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
+ \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
+ \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
+ \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak}
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+}
+\def\wordafter{after}
+\def\wordbefore{before}
+\def\wordnone{none}
+
+\urefbreakstyle after
+
% @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
%
\let\url=\uref
@@ -2235,34 +2722,76 @@ output) for that.)}
\let\email=\uref
\fi
-% Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
-% Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
-% shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
-% this property, we can check that font parameter.
-%
-\def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
+% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
+% `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
+% or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
+\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
+ \def\txiarg{#1}%
+ \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
+ \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
+ \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
+ \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+}
+\def\worddistinct{distinct}
+\def\wordexample{example}
+\def\wordcode{code}
+
+% Default is `distinct'.
+\kbdinputstyle distinct
+
+% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
+% then @kbd has no effect.
+\def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}}
+
+\def\xkey{\key}
+\def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{%
+ \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
+ \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
+ \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
+ \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
+}
+
+% definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
+%\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+%\font\keysy=cmsy9
+%\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
+% \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
+% \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
+% \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
+% \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
+% \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
+
+% definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
+% monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
+% if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
+%
+\def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}%
+ \nohyphenation
+ \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
+ #1}\null}
+
+% @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
+\def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
+
+% @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
+\parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
+\def\click{\arrow}
% Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
%
\def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
-\def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}
-
-% @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
-% and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
-% Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
-%\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
-
-% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
-\def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
-\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
-\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
-
% @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
% We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
% all-uppercase.
-%
+%
\def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
\def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
{\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
@@ -2270,11 +2799,12 @@ output) for that.)}
\ifx\temp\empty \else
\space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
\fi
+ \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
}
% @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
% No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
-%
+%
\def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
\def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
{\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
@@ -2282,8 +2812,301 @@ output) for that.)}
\ifx\temp\empty \else
\space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
\fi
+ \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
+}
+
+% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
+%
+\def\asis#1{#1}
+
+% @math outputs its argument in math mode.
+%
+% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
+% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
+% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
+% which is what @var uses.
+{
+ \catcode`\_ = \active
+ \gdef\mathunderscore{%
+ \catcode`\_=\active
+ \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
+ }
+}
+% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
+% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
+% particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
+%
+% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
+\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
+%
+\def\math{%
+ \ifmmode\else % only go into math if not in math mode already
+ \tex
+ \mathunderscore
+ \let\\ = \mathbackslash
+ \mathactive
+ % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
+ \let\"=\ddot
+ \let\'=\acute
+ \let\==\bar
+ \let\^=\hat
+ \let\`=\grave
+ \let\u=\breve
+ \let\v=\check
+ \let\~=\tilde
+ \let\dotaccent=\dot
+ % have to provide another name for sup operator
+ \let\mathopsup=\sup
+ $\expandafter\finishmath\fi
+}
+\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
+
+% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
+% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
+% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
+%
+{
+ \catcode`^ = \active
+ \catcode`< = \active
+ \catcode`> = \active
+ \catcode`+ = \active
+ \catcode`' = \active
+ \gdef\mathactive{%
+ \let^ = \ptexhat
+ \let< = \ptexless
+ \let> = \ptexgtr
+ \let+ = \ptexplus
+ \let' = \ptexquoteright
+ }
+}
+
+% for @sub and @sup, if in math mode, just do a normal sub/superscript.
+% If in text, use math to place as sub/superscript, but switch
+% into text mode, with smaller fonts. This is a different font than the
+% one used for real math sub/superscripts (8pt vs. 7pt), but let's not
+% fix it (significant additions to font machinery) until someone notices.
+%
+\def\sub{\ifmmode \expandafter\sb \else \expandafter\finishsub\fi}
+\def\finishsub#1{$\sb{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize #1}}$}%
+%
+\def\sup{\ifmmode \expandafter\ptexsp \else \expandafter\finishsup\fi}
+\def\finishsup#1{$\ptexsp{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize #1}}$}%
+
+% @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
+% Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
+% except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
+%
+\def\outfmtnametex{tex}
+%
+\long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish}
+\long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{%
+ \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
+ \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
+}
+%
+% @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if
+% FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT.
+\long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,\finish}
+\long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,#2,#3,#4,\finish{%
+ \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
+ \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi
+}
+%
+% For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
+% setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for
+% example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
+% ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal
+% *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
+% well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the
+% delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
+%
+\long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
+\long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish}
+\def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{%
+ \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
+ \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
+ \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
+}
+
+% @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set.
+%
+\long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,\finish}
+\long\def\doinlineifset#1,#2,\finish{%
+ \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax
+ \else\ignorespaces#2\fi
+}
+
+% @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set.
+%
+\long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,\finish}
+\long\def\doinlineifclear#1,#2,\finish{%
+ \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi
+}
+
+
+\message{glyphs,}
+% and logos.
+
+% @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
+\def\@{\char64 }
+\let\atchar=\@
+
+% @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
+% Unless we're in typewriter, use \ecfont because the CM text fonts do
+% not have braces, and we don't want to switch into math.
+\def\mylbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char123}}
+\def\myrbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char125}}
+\let\{=\mylbrace \let\lbracechar=\{
+\let\}=\myrbrace \let\rbracechar=\}
+\begingroup
+ % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
+ % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
+ \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
+ \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
+ \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
+ !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
+ !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
+ !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
+ !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
+!endgroup
+
+% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
+\let\comma = ,
+
+% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
+% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
+\let\, = \ptexc
+\let\dotaccent = \ptexdot
+\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
+\let\tieaccent = \ptext
+\let\ubaraccent = \ptexb
+\let\udotaccent = \d
+
+% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
+% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
+\def\questiondown{?`}
+\def\exclamdown{!`}
+\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
+\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
+
+% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
+\def\imacro{i}
+\def\jmacro{j}
+\def\dotless#1{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
+ \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
+ \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+
+% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
+% period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
+%
+\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
+
+% @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
+% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
+% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
+% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
+% \scriptscriptstyle).
+%
+\def\LaTeX{%
+ L\kern-.36em
+ {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
+ \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{%
+ \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
+ % for 10pt running text, \lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
+ % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
+ \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$%
+ \else
+ % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
+ \selectfonts\lllsize A%
+ \fi
+ }%
+ \vss
+ }}%
+ \kern-.15em
+ \TeX
+}
+
+% Some math mode symbols. Define \ensuremath to switch into math mode
+% unless we are already there. Expansion tricks may not be needed here,
+% but safer, and can't hurt.
+\def\ensuremath{\ifmmode \expandafter\asis \else\expandafter\ensuredmath \fi}
+\def\ensuredmath#1{$\relax#1$}
+%
+\def\bullet{\ensuremath\ptexbullet}
+\def\geq{\ensuremath\ge}
+\def\leq{\ensuremath\le}
+\def\minus{\ensuremath-}
+
+% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
+% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
+% typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
+% in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
+% whichever is larger.
+%
+\def\dots{%
+ \leavevmode
+ \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
+ \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
+ \dimen0 = \wd0
+ \else
+ \dimen0 = 1.5em
+ \fi
+ \hbox to \dimen0{%
+ \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
+ .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
+ .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
+ .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
+ }%
+}
+
+% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
+%
+\def\enddots{%
+ \dots
+ \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
}
+% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
+%
+% Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
+% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
+%
+\def\point{$\star$}
+\def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
+\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
+\def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
+\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
+\def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
+
+% The @error{} command.
+% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
+%
+\newbox\errorbox
+%
+{\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
+\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
+% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
+\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt}
+%
+\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
+ \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
+ \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
+ \vbox{%
+ \hrule height\dimen2
+ \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
+ \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
+ \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
+ \hrule height\dimen2}
+ \hfil}
+%
+\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
+
% @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
%
\def\pounds{{\it\$}}
@@ -2293,49 +3116,125 @@ output) for that.)}
% Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
% "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
% It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
-%
+%
% Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
% that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
% font height.
-%
+%
% feymr - regular
% feymo - slanted
% feybr - bold
% feybo - bold slanted
-%
+%
% There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
% A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
% Hmm.
-%
+%
% Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
% Hope not.
-%
-%
+%
+%
\def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
\def\eurofont{%
% We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
% \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
% installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
% font installed.
- %
+ %
% There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
% that to the current nominal size.
- %
+ %
% By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
% does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
- %
+ %
\def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
%
- \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
+ \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
% bold:
\font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
- \else
+ \else
% regular:
\font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
\fi
\thiseurofont
}
+% Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
+% sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
+% the redefinition.
+%
+% Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
+\def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth
+\def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth
+\def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn
+\def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn
+%
+\def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
+\def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
+\def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
+\def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
+\def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
+\def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
+\def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
+\def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
+%
+% This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
+% we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
+% tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
+% dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
+%
+% ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
+% the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
+% the same EC font.
+\def\ogonek#1{{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
+ \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
+ \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
+ \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
+ \else
+ \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
+ \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
+ \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
+ \fi
+ \fi\fi\fi\fi
+ }%
+}
+\def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
+\def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
+\def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
+\def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
+%
+% Use the European Computer Modern fonts (cm-super in outline format)
+% for non-CM glyphs. That is ec* for regular text and tc* for the text
+% companion symbols (LaTeX TS1 encoding). Both are part of the ec
+% package and follow the same conventions.
+%
+\def\ecfont{\etcfont{e}}
+\def\tcfont{\etcfont{t}}
+%
+\def\etcfont#1{%
+ % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
+ % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
+ % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
+ % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
+ \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
+ \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
+ \ifmonospace
+ % typewriter:
+ \font\thisecfont = #1ctt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
+ \else
+ \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
+ % bold:
+ \font\thisecfont = #1cb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
+ \else
+ % regular:
+ \font\thisecfont = #1c\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \thisecfont
+}
+
% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
% be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
% Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
@@ -2353,11 +3252,17 @@ output) for that.)}
% Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
% Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
% so we'll define it if necessary.
-%
-\ifx\Orb\undefined
+%
+\ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
\def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
\fi
+% Quotes.
+\chardef\quotedblleft="5C
+\chardef\quotedblright=`\"
+\chardef\quoteleft=`\`
+\chardef\quoteright=`\'
+
\message{page headings,}
@@ -2376,8 +3281,9 @@ output) for that.)}
\newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
\let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
-\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
- \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
+\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
+ \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
+ \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
\envdef\titlepage{%
% Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
@@ -2437,17 +3343,28 @@ output) for that.)}
\finishedtitlepagetrue
}
-%%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
+% Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation,
+% don't worry much about spacing, ragged right. This should be used
+% inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. Because
+% it is always used for titles, nothing else, we call \rmisbold. \par
+% should be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group.
+%
+\def\raggedtitlesettings{%
+ \rmisbold
+ \hyphenpenalty=10000
+ \parindent=0pt
+ \tolerance=5000
+ \ptexraggedright
+}
+
+% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
\let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
\def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
-\def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines
- \let\tt=\authortt}
-
\parseargdef\title{%
\checkenv\titlepage
- \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
+ \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
% print a rule at the page bottom also.
\finishedtitlepagefalse
\vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
@@ -2468,12 +3385,12 @@ output) for that.)}
\else
\checkenv\titlepage
\ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
- {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
+ {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}%
\fi
}
-%%% Set up page headings and footings.
+% Set up page headings and footings.
\let\thispage=\folio
@@ -2482,7 +3399,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
\newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
-% Now make TeX use those variables
+% Now make \makeheadline and \makefootline in Plain TeX use those variables
\headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
\else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
\footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
@@ -2527,6 +3444,37 @@ output) for that.)}
\parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
+% @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
+% @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
+%
+% The same set of arguments for:
+%
+% @oddheadingmarks
+% @evenfootingmarks
+% @oddfootingmarks
+% @everyheadingmarks
+% @everyfootingmarks
+
+% These define \getoddheadingmarks, \getevenheadingmarks,
+% \getoddfootingmarks, and \getevenfootingmarks, each to one of
+% \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks.
+%
+\def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
+\def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
+\def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
+\def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
+\def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
+ \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
+\def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
+ \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
+% #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
+\def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
+ \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
+}
+
+\everyheadingmarks bottom
+\everyfootingmarks bottom
% @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
% @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
@@ -2540,10 +3488,14 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
-\def\HEADINGSoff{%
-\global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
-\global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
-\HEADINGSoff
+\def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
+ \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
+ \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
+}
+
+\def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
+\HEADINGSoff % it's the default
+
% When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
% For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
% chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
@@ -2554,7 +3506,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
}
\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
@@ -2565,8 +3517,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\global\pageno=1
\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
-\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
}
\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
@@ -2577,7 +3529,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
}
@@ -2585,8 +3537,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
-\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
}
@@ -2594,7 +3546,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% This produces Day Month Year style of output.
% Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
% up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
-\ifx\today\undefined
+\ifx\today\thisisundefined
\def\today{%
\number\day\space
\ifcase\month
@@ -2655,7 +3607,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\begingroup
\advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
\advance\hsize by\tableindent
- \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
+ \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax
\leavevmode\unhbox0\par
\endgroup
%
@@ -2669,7 +3621,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
% bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
% \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
- %
+ %
\penalty 10001
\endgroup
\itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
@@ -2763,9 +3715,18 @@ output) for that.)}
\parindent=0pt
\parskip=\smallskipamount
\ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
+ %
+ % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says
+ % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
+ % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
+ % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
+ % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
\def\itemcontents{#1}%
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}%
+ %
% @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
\ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
+ %
\let\item=\itemizeitem
}
@@ -2786,7 +3747,13 @@ output) for that.)}
\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
\noindent
\hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
- \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
+ %
+ \ifinner\else
+ \vadjust{\penalty 1200}% not good to break after first line of item.
+ \fi
+ % We can be in inner vertical mode in a footnote, although an
+ % @itemize looks awful there.
+ }%
\flushcr
}
@@ -3004,15 +3971,26 @@ output) for that.)}
}
% multitable-only commands.
+%
+% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. Assignments
+% have to be global since we are inside the implicit group of an
+% alignment entry. \everycr below resets \everytab so we don't have to
+% undo it ourselves.
+\def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
+\def\headitem{%
+ \checkenv\multitable
+ \crcr
+ \gdef\headitemcrhook{\nobreak}% attempt to avoid page break after headings
+ \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
+ \the\everytab % for the first item
+}%
%
-% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
-% Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
-% of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
-\def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}%
+% default for tables with no headings.
+\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
%
% A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
% line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
-% we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
+% we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
% --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
\def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
@@ -3040,15 +4018,15 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\everycr = {%
\noalign{%
- \global\everytab={}%
+ \global\everytab={}% Reset from possible headitem.
\global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
- % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
+ %
+ % Check for saved footnotes, etc.:
\checkinserts
- % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
- %\filbreak
- % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
- % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
- % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
+ %
+ % Perhaps a \nobreak, then reset:
+ \headitemcrhook
+ \global\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
}%
}%
%
@@ -3124,18 +4102,18 @@ output) for that.)}
\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
\fi
-%% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
-%% table. If not, do nothing.
-%% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
+% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
+% table. If not, do nothing.
+% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
\ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
-\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
- %% than skip between lines in the table.
+\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
+ % than skip between lines in the table.
\fi%
\ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
-\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
- %% than skip between lines in the table.
+\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
+ % than skip between lines in the table.
\fi}
@@ -3287,7 +4265,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
{
- \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
+ \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
%
\gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
\let\value = \expandablevalue
@@ -3296,7 +4274,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
% we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
% So \let them to their normal equivalents.
- \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
+ \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore
}
}
@@ -3307,7 +4285,12 @@ output) for that.)}
% variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
% it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
% to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
-%
+%
+% Unfortunately, this has the consequence that when _ is in the *value*
+% of an @set, it does not print properly in the roman fonts (get the cmr
+% dot accent at position 126 instead). No fix comes to mind, and it's
+% been this way since 2003 or earlier, so just ignore it.
+%
\def\expandablevalue#1{%
\expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
{[No value for ``#1'']}%
@@ -3319,8 +4302,9 @@ output) for that.)}
% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
% with @set.
-%
-% To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
+%
+% To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call
+% \makecond and then redefine.
%
\makecond{ifset}
\def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
@@ -3336,7 +4320,7 @@ output) for that.)}
}
\def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
-% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
+% @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been
% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
%
% The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
@@ -3347,6 +4331,35 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
\def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
+% @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written
+% without the @) is in fact defined. We can only feasibly check at the
+% TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered
+% defined even though it is not a Texinfo command.
+%
+\makecond{ifcommanddefined}
+\def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}}
+%
+\def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \let\next=\empty
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax
+ #1% If not defined, \let\next as above.
+ \fi
+ \expandafter
+ }\next
+}
+\def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}}
+
+% @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above.
+\makecond{ifcommandnotdefined}
+\def\ifcommandnotdefined{%
+ \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}}
+\def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}}
+
+% Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to
+% test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available.
+\set txicommandconditionals
+
% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
\let\dircategory=\comment
@@ -3362,19 +4375,16 @@ output) for that.)}
% except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
\edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
-% \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
-% It automatically defines \fooindex such that
-% \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
-% It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
-% the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
+% \newindex {foo} defines an index named IX.
+% It automatically defines \IXindex such that
+% \IXindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index IX.
+% It also defines \IXindfile to be the number of the output channel for
+% the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is IX.
% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
% for the sake of vms.
%
\def\newindex#1{%
- \iflinks
- \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
- \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
- \fi
+ \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
\noexpand\doindex{#1}}
}
@@ -3388,14 +4398,19 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
%
\def\newcodeindex#1{%
- \iflinks
- \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
- \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
- \fi
+ \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
\noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
}
+% The default indices:
+\newindex{cp}% concepts,
+\newcodeindex{fn}% functions,
+\newcodeindex{vr}% variables,
+\newcodeindex{tp}% types,
+\newcodeindex{ky}% keys
+\newcodeindex{pg}% and programs.
+
% @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
@@ -3411,11 +4426,11 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
% Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
% closing the target index.
- \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined
+ \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \relax
% The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
% Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
\expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
+ \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
\fi
% redefine \fooindfile:
\expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
@@ -3424,63 +4439,33 @@ output) for that.)}
\expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
}
-% Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
+% Define \doindex, the driver for all index macros.
% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
-% and it is "foo", the name of the index.
-
-% \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
-% This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
+% and it the two-letter name of the index.
-% There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
-% which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
-
-\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
-\def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
+\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\doindexxxx}
+\def\doindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
-\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
-\def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
+\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\docodeindexxxx}
+\def\docodeindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
-% Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
-% Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
-% we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
+% Used when writing an index entry out to an index file, to prevent
+% expansion of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
%
\def\indexdummies{%
\escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
\def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
\def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
%
- % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
- % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
- % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
- \let\{ = \mylbrace
- \let\} = \myrbrace
- %
- % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
- % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
- % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
- % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
- % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
- % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
- % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
- % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
- % is still getting written without apparent harm.
- %
- % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
- % help-texinfo, 22may06):
- % @macro funindex {WORD}
- % @findex xyz
- % @end macro
- % ...
- % @funindex commtest
- %
- % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
- %
- % Sample whatsit resulting:
- % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
- %
- % So:
- \let\endinput = \empty
+ % Need these unexpandable (because we define \tt as a dummy)
+ % definitions when @{ or @} appear in index entry text. Also, more
+ % complicated, when \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
+ % We can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
+ % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. Perhaps we
+ % should use @lbracechar and @rbracechar?
+ \def\{{{\tt\char123}}%
+ \def\}{{\tt\char125}}%
%
% Do the redefinitions.
\commondummies
@@ -3505,9 +4490,8 @@ output) for that.)}
% Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
%
\def\commondummies{%
- %
% \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
- % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
+ % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words,
% not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
% control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
% from whatever follows.
@@ -3526,23 +4510,28 @@ output) for that.)}
\commondummiesnofonts
%
\definedummyletter\_%
+ \definedummyletter\-%
%
% Non-English letters.
\definedummyword\AA
\definedummyword\AE
+ \definedummyword\DH
\definedummyword\L
- \definedummyword\OE
\definedummyword\O
+ \definedummyword\OE
+ \definedummyword\TH
\definedummyword\aa
\definedummyword\ae
+ \definedummyword\dh
+ \definedummyword\exclamdown
\definedummyword\l
- \definedummyword\oe
\definedummyword\o
- \definedummyword\ss
- \definedummyword\exclamdown
- \definedummyword\questiondown
+ \definedummyword\oe
\definedummyword\ordf
\definedummyword\ordm
+ \definedummyword\questiondown
+ \definedummyword\ss
+ \definedummyword\th
%
% Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
\definedummyword\bf
@@ -3558,21 +4547,41 @@ output) for that.)}
\definedummyword\TeX
%
% Assorted special characters.
+ \definedummyword\arrow
\definedummyword\bullet
\definedummyword\comma
\definedummyword\copyright
\definedummyword\registeredsymbol
\definedummyword\dots
\definedummyword\enddots
+ \definedummyword\entrybreak
\definedummyword\equiv
\definedummyword\error
\definedummyword\euro
\definedummyword\expansion
+ \definedummyword\geq
+ \definedummyword\guillemetleft
+ \definedummyword\guillemetright
+ \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
+ \definedummyword\guilsinglright
+ \definedummyword\lbracechar
+ \definedummyword\leq
+ \definedummyword\mathopsup
\definedummyword\minus
+ \definedummyword\ogonek
\definedummyword\pounds
\definedummyword\point
\definedummyword\print
+ \definedummyword\quotedblbase
+ \definedummyword\quotedblleft
+ \definedummyword\quotedblright
+ \definedummyword\quoteleft
+ \definedummyword\quoteright
+ \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
+ \definedummyword\rbracechar
\definedummyword\result
+ \definedummyword\sub
+ \definedummyword\sup
\definedummyword\textdegree
%
% We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
@@ -3586,6 +4595,8 @@ output) for that.)}
}
% \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
+% Define \definedumyletter, \definedummyaccent and \definedummyword before
+% using.
%
\def\commondummiesnofonts{%
% Control letters and accents.
@@ -3606,6 +4617,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\definedummyword\v
\definedummyword\H
\definedummyword\dotaccent
+ \definedummyword\ogonek
\definedummyword\ringaccent
\definedummyword\tieaccent
\definedummyword\ubaraccent
@@ -3616,18 +4628,27 @@ output) for that.)}
\definedummyword\b
\definedummyword\i
\definedummyword\r
+ \definedummyword\sansserif
\definedummyword\sc
+ \definedummyword\slanted
\definedummyword\t
%
% Commands that take arguments.
+ \definedummyword\abbr
\definedummyword\acronym
+ \definedummyword\anchor
\definedummyword\cite
\definedummyword\code
\definedummyword\command
\definedummyword\dfn
+ \definedummyword\dmn
+ \definedummyword\email
\definedummyword\emph
\definedummyword\env
\definedummyword\file
+ \definedummyword\image
+ \definedummyword\indicateurl
+ \definedummyword\inforef
\definedummyword\kbd
\definedummyword\key
\definedummyword\math
@@ -3637,6 +4658,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\definedummyword\samp
\definedummyword\strong
\definedummyword\tie
+ \definedummyword\U
\definedummyword\uref
\definedummyword\url
\definedummyword\var
@@ -3645,6 +4667,52 @@ output) for that.)}
\definedummyword\xref
}
+% For testing: output @{ and @} in index sort strings as \{ and \}.
+\newif\ifusebracesinindexes
+
+\let\indexlbrace\relax
+\let\indexrbrace\relax
+
+{\catcode`\@=0
+\catcode`\\=13
+ @gdef@backslashdisappear{@def\{}}
+}
+
+{
+\catcode`\<=13
+\catcode`\-=13
+\catcode`\`=13
+ \gdef\indexnonalnumdisappear{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax\else
+ % @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us ignore left quotes in the sort term.
+ % (Introduced for FSFS 2nd ed.)
+ \let`=\empty
+ \fi
+ %
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexbackslashignore\endcsname\relax\else
+ \backslashdisappear
+ \fi
+ %
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexhyphenignore\endcsname\relax\else
+ \def-{}%
+ \fi
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlessthanignore\endcsname\relax\else
+ \def<{}%
+ \fi
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexatsignignore\endcsname\relax\else
+ \def\@{}%
+ \fi
+ }
+
+ \gdef\indexnonalnumreappear{%
+ \useindexbackslash
+ \let-\normaldash
+ \let<\normalless
+ \def\@{@}%
+ }
+}
+
+
% \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
% by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
% control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
@@ -3655,9 +4723,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
% We can just ignore other control letters.
\def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
- % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
+ % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
\let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
- %
\commondummiesnofonts
%
% Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
@@ -3667,69 +4734,96 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\def\ { }%
\def\@{@}%
- % how to handle braces?
\def\_{\normalunderscore}%
+ \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
+ %
+ \def\lbracechar{{\indexlbrace}}%
+ \def\rbracechar{{\indexrbrace}}%
+ \let\{=\lbracechar
+ \let\}=\rbracechar
+ %
%
% Non-English letters.
\def\AA{AA}%
\def\AE{AE}%
+ \def\DH{DZZ}%
\def\L{L}%
\def\OE{OE}%
\def\O{O}%
+ \def\TH{TH}%
\def\aa{aa}%
\def\ae{ae}%
+ \def\dh{dzz}%
+ \def\exclamdown{!}%
\def\l{l}%
\def\oe{oe}%
- \def\o{o}%
- \def\ss{ss}%
- \def\exclamdown{!}%
- \def\questiondown{?}%
\def\ordf{a}%
\def\ordm{o}%
+ \def\o{o}%
+ \def\questiondown{?}%
+ \def\ss{ss}%
+ \def\th{th}%
%
\def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
\def\TeX{TeX}%
%
% Assorted special characters.
% (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
+ \def\arrow{->}%
\def\bullet{bullet}%
\def\comma{,}%
\def\copyright{copyright}%
- \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
\def\dots{...}%
\def\enddots{...}%
\def\equiv{==}%
\def\error{error}%
\def\euro{euro}%
\def\expansion{==>}%
+ \def\geq{>=}%
+ \def\guillemetleft{<<}%
+ \def\guillemetright{>>}%
+ \def\guilsinglleft{<}%
+ \def\guilsinglright{>}%
+ \def\leq{<=}%
\def\minus{-}%
- \def\pounds{pounds}%
\def\point{.}%
+ \def\pounds{pounds}%
\def\print{-|}%
+ \def\quotedblbase{"}%
+ \def\quotedblleft{"}%
+ \def\quotedblright{"}%
+ \def\quoteleft{`}%
+ \def\quoteright{'}%
+ \def\quotesinglbase{,}%
+ \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
\def\result{=>}%
- \def\textdegree{degrees}%
+ \def\textdegree{o}%
%
% We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
% Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
% makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
% writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
% that starts with \.
- %
+ %
% Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
% to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
% goes to end-of-line is not handled.
- %
+ %
\macrolist
}
-\let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
+
\let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
% Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
% #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
\def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
-% Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
+% There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
+% which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
+% TODO: Two-level index? Operation index?
+
+% Workhorse for all indexes.
% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
% empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
% is with most defuns, which call us directly).
@@ -3737,6 +4831,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
\iflinks
{%
+ \requireopenindexfile{#1}%
% Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
\toks0 = {#2}%
% If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
@@ -3747,16 +4842,54 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
%
- \ifvmode
- \dosubindsanitize
- \else
- \dosubindwrite
- \fi
+ \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
}%
\fi
}
-% Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
+% Check if an index file has been opened, and if not, open it.
+\def\requireopenindexfile#1{%
+\ifnum\csname #1indfile\endcsname=0
+ \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
+ \edef\suffix{#1}%
+ % A .fls suffix would conflict with the file extension for the output
+ % of -recorder, so use .f1s instead.
+ \ifx\suffix\indexisfl\def\suffix{f1}\fi
+ % Open the file
+ \immediate\openout\csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.\suffix
+ % Using \immediate here prevents an object entering into the current box,
+ % which could confound checks such as those in \safewhatsit for preceding
+ % skips.
+\fi}
+\def\indexisfl{fl}
+
+% Output \ as {\indexbackslash}, because \ is an escape character in
+% the index files.
+\let\indexbackslash=\relax
+{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
+ @gdef@useindexbackslash{@def\{{@indexbackslash}}}
+}
+
+% Definition for writing index entry text.
+\def\sortas#1{\ignorespaces}%
+
+% Definition for writing index entry sort key. Should occur at the at
+% the beginning of the index entry, like
+% @cindex @sortas{september} \september
+% The \ignorespaces takes care of following space, but there's no way
+% to remove space before it.
+{
+\catcode`\-=13
+\gdef\indexwritesortas{%
+ \begingroup
+ \indexnonalnumreappear
+ \indexwritesortasxxx}
+\gdef\indexwritesortasxxx#1{%
+ \xdef\indexsortkey{#1}\endgroup}
+}
+
+
+% Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file.
%
\def\dosubindwrite{%
% Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
@@ -3766,14 +4899,20 @@ output) for that.)}
%
% Remember, we are within a group.
\indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
- \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
- % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
- %
- % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
- % get the string to sort by.
+ \useindexbackslash % \indexbackslash isn't defined now so it will be output
+ % as is; and it will print as backslash.
+ % Get the string to sort by, by processing the index entry with all
+ % font commands turned off.
{\indexnofonts
- \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
- \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
+ \indexnonalnumdisappear
+ \xdef\indexsortkey{}%
+ \let\sortas=\indexwritesortas
+ \edef\temp{\the\toks0}%
+ \setbox\dummybox = \hbox{\temp}% Make sure to execute any \sortas
+ \ifx\indexsortkey\empty
+ \xdef\indexsortkey{\temp}%
+ \ifx\indexsortkey\empty\xdef\indexsortkey{ }\fi
+ \fi
}%
%
% Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
@@ -3783,18 +4922,19 @@ output) for that.)}
% sorted result.
\edef\temp{%
\write\writeto{%
- \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
+ \string\entry{\indexsortkey}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
}%
\temp
}
+\newbox\dummybox % used above
-% Take care of unwanted page breaks:
+% Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
%
% If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
% by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
% the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
-% \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences
-% like this:
+% \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
+% sequences like this:
% @end defun
% @tindex whatever
% @defun ...
@@ -3818,25 +4958,30 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
%
+\newskip\whatsitskip
+\newcount\whatsitpenalty
+%
% ..., ready, GO:
%
-\def\dosubindsanitize{%
+\def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode
+ #1%
+ \else
% \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
- \skip0 = \lastskip
+ \whatsitskip = \lastskip
\edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
- \count255 = \lastpenalty
+ \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
%
% If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
% skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
- % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a
+ % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
% non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
% breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
\ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
\else
- \vskip-\skip0
+ \vskip-\whatsitskip
\fi
%
- \dosubindwrite
+ #1%
%
\ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
% If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
@@ -3844,20 +4989,19 @@ output) for that.)}
% to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
% signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
% following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
- %
% @deffn deffn-whatever
% @vindex index-whatever
% Description.
% would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
% and the "Description." paragraph.
- \ifnum\count255>9999 \penalty\count255 \fi
+ \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
\else
% On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
% this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
% (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
- \nobreak\vskip\skip0
+ \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
\fi
-}
+\fi}
% The index entry written in the file actually looks like
% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
@@ -3899,6 +5043,7 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\smallfonts \rm
\tolerance = 9500
+ \plainfrenchspacing
\everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
%
% See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
@@ -3907,7 +5052,9 @@ output) for that.)}
% as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
% (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
\catcode`\@ = 11
- \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
+ % See comment in \requireopenindexfile.
+ \def\indexname{#1}\ifx\indexname\indexisfl\def\indexname{f1}\fi
+ \openin 1 \jobname.\indexname s
\ifeof 1
% \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
% and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
@@ -3915,43 +5062,96 @@ output) for that.)}
% there is some text.
\putwordIndexNonexistent
\else
+ \catcode`\\ = 0
+ \escapechar = `\\
%
% If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
% false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
% it can discover if there is anything in it.
- \read 1 to \temp
+ \read 1 to \thisline
\ifeof 1
\putwordIndexIsEmpty
\else
% Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
% character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
% to make right now.
- \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
- \catcode`\\ = 0
- \escapechar = `\\
+ \def\indexbackslash{\ttbackslash}%
+ \let\indexlbrace\{ % Likewise, set these sequences for braces
+ \let\indexrbrace\} % used in the sort key.
\begindoublecolumns
- \input \jobname.#1s
+ \let\entryorphanpenalty=\indexorphanpenalty
+ %
+ % Read input from the index file line by line.
+ \loopdo
+ \ifeof1
+ \let\firsttoken\relax
+ \else
+ \read 1 to \nextline
+ \edef\act{\gdef\noexpand\firsttoken{\getfirsttoken\nextline}}%
+ \act
+ \fi
+ \thisline
+ %
+ \ifeof1\else
+ \let\thisline\nextline
+ \repeat
+ %%
\enddoublecolumns
\fi
\fi
\closein 1
\endgroup}
+\def\getfirsttoken#1{\expandafter\getfirsttokenx#1\endfirsttoken}
+\long\def\getfirsttokenx#1#2\endfirsttoken{\noexpand#1}
+
+\def\loopdo#1\repeat{\def\body{#1}\loopdoxxx}
+\def\loopdoxxx{\let\next=\relax\body\let\next=\loopdoxxx\fi\next}
+
% These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
% Change them to control the appearance of the index.
-\def\initial#1{{%
- % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
- \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
- %
+{\catcode`\/=13 \catcode`\-=13 \catcode`\^=13 \catcode`\~=13 \catcode`\_=13
+\catcode`\|=13 \catcode`\<=13 \catcode`\>=13 \catcode`\+=13 \catcode`\"=13
+\catcode`\$=3
+\gdef\initialglyphs{%
+ % Some changes for non-alphabetic characters. Using the glyphs from the
+ % math fonts looks more consistent than the typewriter font used elsewhere
+ % for these characters.
+ \def\indexbackslash{\math{\backslash}}%
+ \let\\=\indexbackslash
+ %
+ % Can't get bold backslash so don't use bold forward slash
+ \catcode`\/=13
+ \def/{{\secrmnotbold \normalslash}}%
+ \def-{{\normaldash\normaldash}}% en dash `--'
+ \def^{{\chapbf \normalcaret}}%
+ \def~{{\chapbf \normaltilde}}%
+ \def\_{%
+ \leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }%
+ \def|{$\vert$}%
+ \def<{$\less$}%
+ \def>{$\gtr$}%
+ \def+{$\normalplus$}%
+}}
+
+\def\initial{%
+ \bgroup
+ \initialglyphs
+ \initialx
+}
+
+\def\initialx#1{%
% Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
\removelastskip
%
% We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
+ % The glue before the bonus allows a little bit of space at the
+ % bottom of a column to reduce an increase in inter-line spacing.
\nobreak
- \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
- \penalty 0
- \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
+ \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
+ \penalty -300
+ \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
%
% Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
% baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
@@ -3959,25 +5159,24 @@ output) for that.)}
% we need before each entry, but it's better.
%
% No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
- \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
- \leftline{\secbf #1}%
+ \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus 1\baselineskip
+ \leftline{\secfonts \kern-0.05em \secbf #1}%
+ % \secfonts is inside the argument of \leftline so that the change of
+ % \baselineskip will not affect any glue inserted before the vbox that
+ % \leftline creates.
% Do our best not to break after the initial.
\nobreak
\vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
-}}
+ \egroup % \initialglyphs
+}
+
+\newdimen\entryrightmargin
+\entryrightmargin=0pt
% \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
% then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
% and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
%
-% A straightforward implementation would start like this:
-% \def\entry#1#2{...
-% But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
-% @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
-% ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
-%
-% The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
-% --kasal, 21nov03
\def\entry{%
\begingroup
%
@@ -3985,80 +5184,181 @@ output) for that.)}
% affect previous text.
\par
%
- % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
- \parfillskip = 0in
- %
% No extra space above this paragraph.
\parskip = 0in
%
- % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
- \finalhyphendemerits = 0
- %
- % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
- % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
- % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
- % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
- % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
- %
- % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
- % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
- \hangindent = 2em
- %
- % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
- % with blank space.
- \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
+ % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
+ % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section
+ % titles, for instance.
+ \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
+ \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}% An undocumented command
%
% A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
% columns.
- \vskip 0pt plus1pt
+ \vskip 0pt plus0.5pt
%
% Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
\afterassignment\doentry
\let\temp =
}
+\def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
\def\doentry{%
+ % Save the text of the entry
+ \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup
\bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
\noindent
\aftergroup\finishentry
% And now comes the text of the entry.
+ % Not absorbing as a macro argument reduces the chance of problems
+ % with catcodes occurring.
}
-\def\finishentry#1{%
+{\catcode`\@=11
+\gdef\finishentry#1{%
+ \egroup % end box A
+ \dimen@ = \wd\boxA % Length of text of entry
+ \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup\unhbox\boxA
% #1 is the page number.
%
- % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
- % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
- % cursed by a Unix daemon.
- \def\tempa{{\rm }}%
- \def\tempb{#1}%
- \edef\tempc{\tempa}%
- \edef\tempd{\tempb}%
- \ifx\tempc\tempd
- \ %
+ % Get the width of the page numbers, and only use
+ % leaders if they are present.
+ \global\setbox\boxB = \hbox{#1}%
+ \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
+ \null\nobreak\hfill\ %
\else
%
- % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
- % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
- % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
- \hfil\penalty50
\null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
%
- % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
- % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
- % \hbox ensues.
\ifpdf
- \pdfgettoks#1.%
- \ \the\toksA
+ \pdfgettoks#1.%
+ \bgroup\let\domark\relax
+ \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
+ \egroup
+ % The redefinion of \domark stops marks being added in \pdflink to
+ % preserve coloured links across page boundaries. Otherwise the marks
+ % would get in the way of \lastbox in \insertindexentrybox.
\else
- \ #1%
+ \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable #1%
\fi
\fi
- \par
+ \egroup % end \boxA
+ \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
+ \global\setbox\entryindexbox=\vbox{\unhbox\boxA}%
+ \else
+ \global\setbox\entryindexbox=\vbox\bgroup
+ \prevdepth=\entrylinedepth
+ \noindent
+ % We want the text of the entries to be aligned to the left, and the
+ % page numbers to be aligned to the right.
+ %
+ \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fil
+ \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus -1fill
+ \rightskip = 0pt plus -1fil
+ \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fill
+ % Cause last line, which could consist of page numbers on their own
+ % if the list of page numbers is long, to be aligned to the right.
+ \parfillskip=0pt plus -1fill
+ %
+ \hangindent=1em
+ %
+ \advance\rightskip by \entryrightmargin
+ % Determine how far we can stretch into the margin.
+ % This allows, e.g., "Appendix H GNU Free Documentation License" to
+ % fit on one line in @letterpaper format.
+ \ifdim\entryrightmargin>2.1em
+ \dimen@i=2.1em
+ \else
+ \dimen@i=0em
+ \fi
+ \advance \parfillskip by 0pt minus 1\dimen@i
+ %
+ \dimen@ii = \hsize
+ \advance\dimen@ii by -1\leftskip
+ \advance\dimen@ii by -1\entryrightmargin
+ \advance\dimen@ii by 1\dimen@i
+ \ifdim\wd\boxA > \dimen@ii % If the entry doesn't fit in one line
+ \ifdim\dimen@ > 0.8\dimen@ii % due to long index text
+ \dimen@ = 0.7\dimen@ % Try to split the text roughly evenly
+ \dimen@ii = \hsize
+ \advance \dimen@ii by -1em
+ \ifnum\dimen@>\dimen@ii
+ % If the entry is too long, use the whole line
+ \dimen@ = \dimen@ii
+ \fi
+ \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill % ragged right
+ \advance \dimen@ by 1\rightskip
+ \parshape = 2 0pt \dimen@ 1em \dimen@ii
+ % Ideally we'd add a finite glue at the end of the first line only, but
+ % TeX doesn't seem to provide a way to do such a thing.
+ \fi\fi
+ \unhbox\boxA
+ %
+ % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
+ \finalhyphendemerits = 0
+ %
+ % Word spacing - no stretch
+ \spaceskip=\fontdimen2\font minus \fontdimen4\font
+ %
+ \linepenalty=1000 % Discourage line breaks.
+ \hyphenpenalty=5000 % Discourage hyphenation.
+ %
+ \par % format the paragraph
+ \egroup % The \vbox
+ \fi
\endgroup
+ % delay text of entry until after penalty
+ \bgroup\aftergroup\insertindexentrybox
+ \entryorphanpenalty
+}}
+
+\newskip\thinshrinkable
+\skip\thinshrinkable=.15em minus .15em
+
+\newbox\entryindexbox
+\def\insertindexentrybox{%
+ \copy\entryindexbox
+ % The following gets the depth of the last box. This is for even
+ % line spacing when entries span several lines.
+ \setbox\dummybox\vbox{%
+ \unvbox\entryindexbox
+ \nointerlineskip
+ \lastbox
+ \global\entrylinedepth=\prevdepth
+ }%
+ % Note that we couldn't simply \unvbox\entryindexbox followed by
+ % \nointerlineskip\lastbox to remove the last box and then reinstate it,
+ % because this resets how far the box has been \moveleft'ed to 0. \unvbox
+ % doesn't affect \prevdepth either.
+}
+\newdimen\entrylinedepth
+
+% Default is no penalty
+\let\entryorphanpenalty\egroup
+
+% Used from \printindex. \firsttoken should be the first token
+% after the \entry. If it's not another \entry, we are at the last
+% line of a group of index entries, so insert a penalty to discourage
+% orphaned index entries.
+\long\def\indexorphanpenalty{%
+ \def\isentry{\entry}%
+ \ifx\firsttoken\isentry
+ \else
+ \unskip\penalty 9000
+ % The \unskip here stops breaking before the glue. It relies on the
+ % \vskip above being there, otherwise there is an error
+ % "You can't use `\unskip' in vertical mode". There has to be glue
+ % in the current vertical list that hasn't been added to the
+ % "current page". See Chapter 24 of the TeXbook. This contradicts
+ % Section 8.3.7 in "TeX by Topic," though.
+ \fi
+ \egroup % now comes the box added with \aftergroup
}
% Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
+% The filll stretch here overpowers both the fil and fill stretch to push
+% the page number to the right.
\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
- \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
+ \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1filll}
+
\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
@@ -4080,12 +5380,39 @@ output) for that.)}
% Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
% the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
-\catcode`\@=11
+\catcode`\@=11 % private names
\newbox\partialpage
\newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
+\newdimen\doublecolumntopgap
+\doublecolumntopgap = 0pt
+
+% Use inside an output routine to save \topmark and \firstmark
+\def\savemarks{%
+ \global\savedtopmark=\expandafter{\topmark }%
+ \global\savedfirstmark=\expandafter{\firstmark }%
+}
+\newtoks\savedtopmark
+\newtoks\savedfirstmark
+
+% Set \topmark and \firstmark for next time \output runs.
+% Can't be run from withinside \output (because any material
+% added while an output routine is active, including
+% penalties, is saved for after it finishes). The page so far
+% should be empty, otherwise what's on it will be thrown away.
+\def\restoremarks{%
+ \mark{\the\savedtopmark}%
+ \bgroup\output = {%
+ \setbox\dummybox=\box\PAGE
+ }abc\eject\egroup
+ % "abc" because output routine doesn't fire for a completely empty page.
+ \mark{\the\savedfirstmark}%
+}
\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
+ % If not much space left on page, start a new page.
+ \ifdim\pagetotal>0.8\vsize\vfill\eject\fi
+ %
% Grab any single-column material above us.
\output = {%
%
@@ -4105,8 +5432,15 @@ output) for that.)}
\unvbox\PAGE
\kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
}%
+ \savemarks
}%
\eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
+ \restoremarks
+ %
+ % We recover the two marks that the last output routine saved in order
+ % to propagate the information in marks added around a chapter heading,
+ % which could be otherwise be lost by the time the final page is output.
+ %
%
% Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
\output = {\doublecolumnout}%
@@ -4134,13 +5468,19 @@ output) for that.)}
%
% Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
% since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
+ \global\doublecolumntopgap = \topskip
+ \global\advance\doublecolumntopgap by -1\baselineskip
+ \advance\vsize by -1\doublecolumntopgap
\vsize = 2\vsize
+ \topskip=0pt
+ \global\entrylinedepth=0pt\relax
}
% The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
-% the last.
+% the last, which is done by \balancecolumns.
%
\def\doublecolumnout{%
+ %
\splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
% Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
% (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
@@ -4163,10 +5503,13 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
\wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
- \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
+ \vbox{%
+ \vskip\doublecolumntopgap
+ \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}}%
}
-%
-% All done with double columns.
+
+
+% Finished with with double columns.
\def\enddoublecolumns{%
% The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
% _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
@@ -4197,21 +5540,21 @@ output) for that.)}
\penalty0
%
\output = {%
- % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
- % current page, no automatic page break.
+ % Split the last of the double-column material.
+ \savemarks
\balancecolumns
%
- % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
- % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
- % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
+ % Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
% want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
- % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
- % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
- % the output somewhat more palatable.)
+ % definition right away.
\global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
}%
\eject
\endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
+ \restoremarks
+ % Leave the double-column material on the current page, no automatic
+ % page break.
+ \box\balancedcolumns
%
% \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
% the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
@@ -4219,31 +5562,52 @@ output) for that.)}
% \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
\pagegoal = \vsize
}
+\newbox\balancedcolumns
+\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{shouldnt see this}%
%
-% Called at the end of the double column material.
+% Only called for the last of the double column material. \doublecolumnout
+% does the others.
\def\balancecolumns{%
\setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
\dimen@ = \ht0
\advance\dimen@ by \topskip
\advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
- \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
- %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
- \splittopskip = \topskip
- % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
- {%
- \vbadness = 10000
- \loop
- \global\setbox3 = \copy0
- \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
- \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
- \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
- \repeat
- }%
- %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
- \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
- \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
+ \ifdim\dimen@<14\baselineskip
+ % Don't split a short final column in two.
+ \setbox2=\vbox{}%
+ \else
+ \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
+ \dimen@ii = \dimen@
+ \splittopskip = \topskip
+ % Loop until the second column is no higher than the first
+ {%
+ \vbadness = 10000
+ \loop
+ \global\setbox3 = \copy0
+ \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
+ % Remove glue from bottom of first column to
+ % make sure it is higher than the second.
+ \global\setbox1 = \vbox{\unvbox1\unpenalty\unskip}%
+ \ifdim\ht3>\ht1
+ \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
+ \repeat
+ }%
+ \multiply\dimen@ii by 4
+ \divide\dimen@ii by 5
+ \ifdim\ht3<\dimen@ii
+ % Column heights are too different, so don't make their bottoms
+ % flush with each other. The glue at the end of the second column
+ % allows a second column to stretch, reducing the difference in
+ % height between the two.
+ \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1\vfill}%
+ \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3\vskip 0pt plus 0.3\ht0}%
+ \else
+ \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
+ \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
+ \fi
+ \fi
%
- \pagesofar
+ \global\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{\pagesofar}%
}
\catcode`\@ = \other
@@ -4251,7 +5615,26 @@ output) for that.)}
\message{sectioning,}
% Chapters, sections, etc.
-% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
+% Let's start with @part.
+\outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
+\def\partzzz#1{%
+ \chapoddpage
+ \null
+ \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit
+ \begingroup
+ \noindent \titlefonts\rmisbold #1\par % the text
+ \let\lastnode=\empty % no node to associate with
+ \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
+ \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page
+ % This outputs a mark at the end of the page that clears \thischapter
+ % and \thissection, as is done in \startcontents.
+ \let\pchapsepmacro\relax
+ \chapmacro{}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
+ \chapoddpage
+ \endgroup
+}
+
+% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered
% sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
% outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
% numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
@@ -4305,11 +5688,15 @@ output) for that.)}
\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
-% Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter.
-% page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise.
-% However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks.
+% Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
+% and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
+% these. @section does likewise.
\def\thischapter{}
+\def\thischapternum{}
+\def\thischaptername{}
\def\thissection{}
+\def\thissectionnum{}
+\def\thissectionname{}
\newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
@@ -4326,8 +5713,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\chardef\maxseclevel = 3
%
% A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
-% To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
-\chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
+% To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
+\chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel
%
% Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
% \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
@@ -4352,8 +5739,8 @@ output) for that.)}
% The heading type:
\def\headtype{#1}%
\if \headtype U%
- \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
- \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
+ \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel
+ \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel
\fi
\else
% Check for appendix sections:
@@ -4365,10 +5752,10 @@ output) for that.)}
\fi\fi
\fi
% Check for numbered within unnumbered:
- \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
+ \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel
\def\headtype{U}%
\else
- \chardef\unmlevel = 3
+ \chardef\unnlevel = 3
\fi
\fi
% Now print the heading:
@@ -4422,7 +5809,9 @@ output) for that.)}
\gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
\resetallfloatnos
%
- \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
+ % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
+ \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
+ \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
%
% Write the actual heading.
\chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
@@ -4433,15 +5822,17 @@ output) for that.)}
\global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
}
-\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
+\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
+%
\def\appendixzzz#1{%
\global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
\global\advance\appendixno by 1
\gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
\resetallfloatnos
%
- \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
- \message{\appendixnum}%
+ % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
+ \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
+ \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
%
\chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
%
@@ -4450,7 +5841,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
}
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
+% normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
\def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
\global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
\global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
@@ -4482,9 +5874,6 @@ output) for that.)}
% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
\outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
- % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
- % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
- % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
\let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
\unnmhead0{#1}%
\let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
@@ -4494,40 +5883,47 @@ output) for that.)}
\let\top\unnumbered
% Sections.
+%
\outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
\def\seczzz#1{%
\global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
}
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
+% normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
+\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
\def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
\global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
}
\let\appendixsec\appendixsection
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
+% normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
\def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
\global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
}
% Subsections.
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
+%
+% normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
+\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
\def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
\global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
}
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
+% normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
+\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
\def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
\global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
{\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
}
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
+% normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
\def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
\global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
@@ -4535,21 +5931,25 @@ output) for that.)}
}
% Subsubsections.
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
+%
+% normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
+\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
\def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
\global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
}
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
+% normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
+\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
\def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
\global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
{\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
}
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
+% normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
\global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
@@ -4565,15 +5965,6 @@ output) for that.)}
% Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
-% NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
-% 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
-% overlong headings to fold.
-% 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
-% heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
-% 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
-% if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
-
-
\def\majorheading{%
{\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
\parsearg\chapheadingzzz
@@ -4581,10 +5972,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
\def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
- {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
- \parindent=0pt\raggedright
- \rm #1\hfill}}%
- \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
+ \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
+ \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
\suppressfirstparagraphindent
}
@@ -4600,17 +5989,32 @@ output) for that.)}
% (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
% given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
-%%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
+% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
\def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
-%%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
% Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
-
\newskip\chapheadingskip
+% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
\def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
+
+% Start a new page
\def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
-\def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi}
+
+% \chapoddpage - start on an odd page for a new chapter
+% Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
+% get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
+% care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
+\def\chapoddpage{%
+ \chappager
+ \ifodd\pageno \else
+ \begingroup
+ \headingsoff
+ \null
+ \chappager
+ \endgroup
+ \fi
+}
\def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
@@ -4633,56 +6037,93 @@ output) for that.)}
\CHAPPAGon
-% Chapter opening.
+% \chapmacro - Chapter opening.
%
% #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
% Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
+% Not used for @heading series.
%
% To test against our argument.
\def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
-\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
\def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
+\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
%
\def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
+ \checkenv{}% chapters, etc., should not start inside an environment.
+ %
+ % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
+ \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
+ \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
+ \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
+ \gdef\thissection{}}%
+ %
+ \def\temptype{#2}%
+ \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
+ \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
+ \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
+ \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
+ \gdef\thischapter{}}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
+ % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
+ % commands in some of the translations.
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
+ \noexpand\thischapternum:
+ \noexpand\thischaptername}%
+ }%
+ \else
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
+ % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
+ % commands in some of the translations.
+ \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
+ \noexpand\thischapternum:
+ \noexpand\thischaptername}%
+ }%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+ %
+ % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
+ % the preceding space.
+ \safewhatsit\domark
+ %
+ % Insert the chapter heading break.
\pchapsepmacro
+ %
+ % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
+ % between here and the heading.
+ \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
+ \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
+ \domark
+ %
{%
- \chapfonts \rm
+ \chapfonts \rmisbold
+ \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading % give better error message
%
- % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the
+ % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
% xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
% after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
- \gdef\thissection{#1}%
- \gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
+ \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
%
% Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
% number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
- \def\temptype{#2}%
\ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
\setbox0 = \hbox{}%
\def\toctype{unnchap}%
- \gdef\thischapternum{}%
- \gdef\thischapter{#1}%
\else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
\setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
\def\toctype{omit}%
- \gdef\thischapternum{}%
- \gdef\thischapter{}%
\else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
\setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
\def\toctype{app}%
- \xdef\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
- % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter
- % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't
- % use \thissection because that changes with each section.
- %
- \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter:
- \noexpand\thischaptername}%
\else
\setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
\def\toctype{numchap}%
- \xdef\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
- \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno:
- \noexpand\thischaptername}%
\fi\fi\fi
%
% Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
@@ -4698,8 +6139,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\donoderef{#2}%
%
% Typeset the actual heading.
- \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
- \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
+ \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
+ \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
\unhbox0 #1\par}%
}%
\nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
@@ -4721,18 +6162,18 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
%
\def\unnchfopen #1{%
-\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
- \parindent=0pt\raggedright
- \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
+ \chapoddpage
+ \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
+ \nobreak\bigskip\nobreak
}
\def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
\vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
\par\penalty 5000 %
}
\def\centerchfopen #1{%
-\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
- \parindent=0pt
- \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
+ \chapoddpage
+ \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings \hfill #1\hfill}%
+ \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
}
\def\CHAPFopen{%
\global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
@@ -4756,40 +6197,102 @@ output) for that.)}
% Print any size, any type, section title.
%
-% #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
-% the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
-% section number.
+% #1 is the text of the title,
+% #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec),
+% #3 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc),
+% #4 is the section number.
+%
+\def\seckeyword{sec}
%
\def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
{%
+ \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
+ \def\temptype{#3}%
+ %
+ % It is ok for the @heading series commands to appear inside an
+ % environment (it's been historically allowed, though the logic is
+ % dubious), but not the others.
+ \ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword\else
+ \checkenv{}% non-@*heading should not be in an environment.
+ \fi
+ \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading
+ %
% Switch to the right set of fonts.
- \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
+ \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rmisbold
+ %
+ % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
+ \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
+ \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
+ \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
+ \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
+ \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
+ \fi
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
+ % Don't redefine \thissection.
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
+ \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
+ % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
+ % commands in some of the translations.
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
+ \noexpand\thissectionnum:
+ \noexpand\thissectionname}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
+ % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
+ % commands in some of the translations.
+ \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
+ \noexpand\thissectionnum:
+ \noexpand\thissectionname}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ \fi\fi\fi
+ %
+ % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
+ % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
+ % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
+ \par
+ %
+ % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
+ % the preceding space.
+ \safewhatsit\domark
%
% Insert space above the heading.
\csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
%
- % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
- \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
- \def\temptype{#3}%
+ % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
+ % between here and the heading.
+ \global\let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
+ \domark
%
+ % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
\ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
\setbox0 = \hbox{}%
\def\toctype{unn}%
- \gdef\thissection{#1}%
+ \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
\else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
% for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
- % and don't redefine \thissection.
+ % and don't redefine \lastsection.
\setbox0 = \hbox{}%
\def\toctype{omit}%
\let\sectionlevel=\empty
\else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
\setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
\def\toctype{app}%
- \gdef\thissection{#1}%
+ \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
\else
\setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
\def\toctype{num}%
- \gdef\thissection{#1}%
+ \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
\fi\fi\fi
%
% Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
@@ -4808,7 +6311,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\nobreak
%
% Output the actual section heading.
- \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
+ \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
\hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
\unhbox0 #1}%
}%
@@ -4822,15 +6325,15 @@ output) for that.)}
%
% We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
% glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
- % discardable item.)
+ % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next
+ % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out
+ % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically
+ % obscuring the section heading with something else.
\vskip-\parskip
- %
- % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
- % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
- % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
- %
- % @section sec-whatever
- % @deffn def-whatever
+ %
+ % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known
+ % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation
+ % and do the needful.
\penalty 10001
}
@@ -4886,7 +6389,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
% fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
% with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
-%
+%
\def\activecatcodes{%
\catcode`\"=\active
\catcode`\$=\active
@@ -4904,7 +6407,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\readtocfile{%
\setupdatafile
\activecatcodes
- \input \jobname.toc
+ \input \tocreadfilename
}
\newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
@@ -4923,23 +6426,27 @@ output) for that.)}
%
% Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
% It is abundantly clear what they are.
- \def\thischapter{}%
\chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
%
\savepageno = \pageno
\begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
\raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
- \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
+ \entryrightmargin=\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
%
% Roman numerals for page numbers.
\ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
}
+% redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
+% \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
+%
+\def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
% Normal (long) toc.
+%
\def\contents{%
\startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
- \openin 1 \jobname.toc
+ \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
\ifeof 1 \else
\readtocfile
\fi
@@ -4958,6 +6465,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\summarycontents{%
\startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
%
+ \let\partentry = \shortpartentry
\let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
\let\appentry = \shortchapentry
\let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
@@ -4977,7 +6485,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
\let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
\let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \openin 1 \jobname.toc
+ \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
\ifeof 1 \else
\readtocfile
\fi
@@ -5013,9 +6521,22 @@ output) for that.)}
% The last argument is the page number.
% The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
+% Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't
+% exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
+% Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
+\def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}}
+\def\partentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}}
+%
+% Parts, in the short toc.
+\def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
+ \penalty-300
+ \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip
+ \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
+}
+
% Chapters, in the main contents.
\def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-%
+
% Chapters, in the short toc.
% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
@@ -5030,7 +6551,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
\hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
%
-\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\hskip.7em#1}{#4}}
% Unnumbered chapters.
\def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
@@ -5063,6 +6584,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\dochapentry#1#2{%
\penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
\begingroup
+ % Move the page numbers slightly to the right
+ \advance\entryrightmargin by -0.05em
\chapentryfonts
\tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
\endgroup
@@ -5102,45 +6625,12 @@ output) for that.)}
\message{environments,}
% @foo ... @end foo.
-% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
-%
-% Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
-% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
-%
-\def\point{$\star$}
-\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
-\def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
-\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
-\def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
-
-% The @error{} command.
-% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
-%
-\newbox\errorbox
-%
-{\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
-\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
-% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
-\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf error\kern-1.5pt}
-%
-\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
- \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
- \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
- \vbox{%
- \hrule height\dimen2
- \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
- \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
- \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
- \hrule height\dimen2}
- \hfil}
-%
-\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
-
-% @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
+% @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
% One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
-% But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
+% But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
\envdef\tex{%
+ \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
\catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
\catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
\catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
@@ -5150,8 +6640,15 @@ output) for that.)}
\catcode `\|=\other
\catcode `\<=\other
\catcode `\>=\other
+ \catcode `\`=\other
+ \catcode `\'=\other
\escapechar=`\\
%
+ % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our
+ % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
+ \mathactive
+ %
+ % Inverse of the list at the beginning of the file.
\let\b=\ptexb
\let\bullet=\ptexbullet
\let\c=\ptexc
@@ -5167,8 +6664,11 @@ output) for that.)}
\let\+=\tabalign
\let\}=\ptexrbrace
\let\/=\ptexslash
+ \let\sp=\ptexsp
\let\*=\ptexstar
+ %\let\sup=\ptexsup % do not redefine, we want @sup to work in math mode
\let\t=\ptext
+ \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % we've made it outer
\let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
%
\def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
@@ -5205,6 +6705,24 @@ output) for that.)}
\endgraf
\ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
\removelastskip
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
+ % Penalize breaking before the environment, because preceding text
+ % often leads into it.
+ \penalty100
+ \fi
+ \vskip\envskipamount
+ \fi
+ \fi
+}}
+
+\def\afterenvbreak{{%
+ % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
+ % \sectionheading, q.v.
+ \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
+ \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
+ \endgraf
+ \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
+ \removelastskip
% it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
% or better ...
\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
@@ -5213,8 +6731,6 @@ output) for that.)}
\fi
}}
-\let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
-
% \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
% also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
\let\nonarrowing=\relax
@@ -5252,9 +6768,13 @@ output) for that.)}
% side, and for 6pt waste from
% each corner char, and rule thickness
\normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
- % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \vbox\bgroup
+ %
+ % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
+ % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
+ % collide with the section heading.
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi
+ %
+ \setbox\groupbox=\vbox\bgroup
\baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
\carttop
\hbox\bgroup
@@ -5267,7 +6787,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\lineskip=\normlskip
\parskip=\normpskip
\vskip -\parskip
- \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
+ \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
}
\def\Ecartouche{%
\ifhmode\par\fi
@@ -5278,20 +6798,27 @@ output) for that.)}
\egroup
\cartbot
\egroup
+ \addgroupbox
\checkinserts
}
% This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
% inside a group.
+\newdimen\nonfillparindent
\def\nonfillstart{%
\aboveenvbreak
- \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
+ \ifdim\hfuzz < 12pt \hfuzz = 12pt \fi % Don't be fussy
\sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
\let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
\obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
\parskip = 0pt
+ % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
+ % the normal \indent.
+ \nonfillparindent=\parindent
\parindent = 0pt
+ \let\indent\nonfillindent
+ %
\emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
\ifx\nonarrowing\relax
\advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
@@ -5302,6 +6829,24 @@ output) for that.)}
\let\exdent=\nofillexdent
}
+\begingroup
+\obeyspaces
+% We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
+% @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
+% active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
+% @indent.
+\gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
+\gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
+\ifx\temp %
+\expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
+\else%
+\leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
+\fi%
+}%
+\endgroup
+\def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
+\def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
+
% If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
% If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
% This affects the following displayed environments:
@@ -5329,41 +6874,42 @@ output) for that.)}
}
% We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
-% Let's do it by one command:
-\def\makedispenv #1#2{
- \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
- \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
+% Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
+\def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
+ \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
+ \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
\expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
\expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
}
-% Define two synonyms:
-\def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
- \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
- \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
+% Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
+\def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
+ \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
+ \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
}
-
-% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
+%
+% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
+% @example: same as @lisp.
%
% @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
%
-\maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
+\maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{%
\nonfillstart
- \tt\quoteexpand
+ \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
\let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
- \gobble % eat return
+ \gobble % eat return
}
% @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
%
-\makedispenv {display}{%
+\makedispenvdef{display}{%
\nonfillstart
\gobble
}
% @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
%
-\makedispenv{format}{%
+\makedispenvdef{format}{%
\let\nonarrowing = t%
\nonfillstart
\gobble
@@ -5382,28 +6928,51 @@ output) for that.)}
\envdef\flushright{%
\let\nonarrowing = t%
\nonfillstart
- \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
+ \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax
\gobble
}
\let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
+% @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
+% justification. From plain.tex. Don't stretch around special
+% characters in urls in this environment, since the stretch at the right
+% should be enough.
+\envdef\raggedright{%
+ \rightskip0pt plus2.4em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
+ \def\urefprestretchamount{0pt}%
+ \def\urefpoststretchamount{0pt}%
+}
+\let\Eraggedright\par
+
+\envdef\raggedleft{%
+ \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em
+ \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
+ \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
+ % badness reporting.
+}
+\let\Eraggedleft\par
+
+\envdef\raggedcenter{%
+ \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em
+ \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
+ \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
+ % badness reporting.
+}
+\let\Eraggedcenter\par
+
+
% @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
% and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
% we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
% \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
%
-\envdef\quotation{%
- {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
- \parindent=0pt
- %
- % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
+\makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart}
+%
+\def\quotationstart{%
+ \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too.
\ifx\nonarrowing\relax
- \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
\advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
- \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
- \else
- \let\nonarrowing = \relax
\fi
\parsearg\quotationlabel
}
@@ -5413,12 +6982,13 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\def\Equotation{%
\par
- \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
+ \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
% indent a bit.
\leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
\fi
{\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
}
+\def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
% If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
\def\quotationlabel#1{%
@@ -5428,6 +6998,32 @@ output) for that.)}
\fi
}
+% @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and
+% has no optional argument.
+%
+\makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart}
+%
+\def\indentedblockstart{%
+ {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
+ \parindent=0pt
+ %
+ % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
+ \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
+ \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
+ \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
+ \else
+ \let\nonarrowing = \relax
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling.
+%
+\def\Eindentedblock{%
+ \par
+ {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
+}
+\def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock}
+
% LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
% If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
@@ -5443,18 +7039,16 @@ output) for that.)}
\do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
\do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
\do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
+ % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
+ % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
+ % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
+ %\do\`\do\'%
}
%
% [Knuth] p. 380
\def\uncatcodespecials{%
\def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
%
-% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
-% Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq}
-\endgroup
-%
% Setup for the @verb command.
%
% Eight spaces for a tab
@@ -5466,7 +7060,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\setupverb{%
\tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
\def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
- \catcode`\`=\active
+ \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
\tabeightspaces
% Respect line breaks,
% print special symbols as themselves, and
@@ -5477,73 +7071,46 @@ output) for that.)}
% Setup for the @verbatim environment
%
-% Real tab expansion
+% Real tab expansion.
\newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
%
-\def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
-
-% Allow an option to not replace quotes with a regular directed right
-% quote/apostrophe (char 0x27), but instead use the undirected quote
-% from cmtt (char 0x0d). The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it
-% the default, but it works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least
-% evince), the lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the
-% regular 0x27.
-%
-\def\codequoteright{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
- '%
- \else
- \char'15
- \fi
-}
-%
-% and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
-% Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
-% the code environments to do likewise.
-%
-\def\codequoteleft{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
- `%
- \else
- \char'22
- \fi
-}
+% We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
+% tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent,
+% or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the
+% entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before
+% it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands
+% (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself.
+\newbox\verbbox
+\def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup}
%
\begingroup
\catcode`\^^I=\active
\gdef\tabexpand{%
\catcode`\^^I=\active
\def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
- \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
- \divide\dimen0 by\tabw
- \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
- \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
- \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
+ \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
+ \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw
+ \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
+ \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
+ \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox
}%
}
- \catcode`\'=\active
- \gdef\rquoteexpand{\catcode\rquoteChar=\active \def'{\codequoteright}}%
- %
- \catcode`\`=\active
- \gdef\lquoteexpand{\catcode\lquoteChar=\active \def`{\codequoteleft}}%
- %
- \gdef\quoteexpand{\rquoteexpand \lquoteexpand}%
\endgroup
% start the verbatim environment.
\def\setupverbatim{%
\let\nonarrowing = t%
\nonfillstart
- % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
- \tt
- \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
- \catcode`\`=\active
+ \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
+ % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would
+ % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode.
+ \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}%
\tabexpand
- \quoteexpand
+ \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
% Respect line breaks,
% print special symbols as themselves, and
- % make each space count
- % must do in this order:
+ % make each space count.
+ % Must do in this order:
\obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
\everypar{\starttabbox}%
}
@@ -5599,6 +7166,8 @@ output) for that.)}
{%
\makevalueexpandable
\setupverbatim
+ \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
+ \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}%
\input #1
\afterenvbreak
}%
@@ -5612,7 +7181,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
% beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
% file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
-% possible is very desirable.
+% possible is desirable.
%
\def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
\def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
@@ -5631,21 +7200,28 @@ output) for that.)}
\newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
\newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
\newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
+\newcount\defunpenalty
% Start the processing of @deffn:
\def\startdefun{%
\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
\medbreak
+ \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
+ % following @def command, see below.
\else
% If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
% which is there to keep the function description together with its
% header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
% break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
- % by \defargscommonending, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
+ % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
% commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
% a break between a section heading and a defun.
- %
- \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi
+ %
+ % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
+ % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
+ % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
+ % @def command.
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
%
% Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
% But do insert the glue.
@@ -5663,7 +7239,7 @@ output) for that.)}
%
% As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
% It's not a great place, though.
- \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \fi
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
%
% And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
\expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
@@ -5678,10 +7254,10 @@ output) for that.)}
#1#2 \endheader
% common ending:
\interlinepenalty = 10000
- \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
+ \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax
\endgraf
\nobreak\vskip -\parskip
- \penalty 10002 % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
+ \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
% Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
% rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
\checkparencounts
@@ -5691,7 +7267,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
% \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
-% the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader.
+% the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
%
\def\makedefun#1{%
\expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
@@ -5700,7 +7276,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\temp
}
-% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
+% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader { (defn. of \deffnheader) }
%
% Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
% \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
@@ -5708,13 +7284,36 @@ output) for that.)}
\def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
\envdef#1{%
\startdefun
+ \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else
\parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
}%
\def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
\def#3%
}
-%%% Untyped functions:
+\newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function?
+\newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line?
+
+% @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
+% are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
+% @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
+%
+\parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\onword
+ \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
+ = \empty
+ \else\ifx\temp\offword
+ \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
+ = \relax
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp',
+ must be on|off}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+
+% Untyped functions:
% @deffn category name args
\makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
@@ -5733,7 +7332,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
}
-%%% Typed functions:
+% Typed functions:
% @deftypefn category type name args
\makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
@@ -5748,10 +7347,11 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
\dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
+ \doingtypefntrue
\defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
}
-%%% Typed variables:
+% Typed variables:
% @deftypevr category type var args
\makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
@@ -5769,7 +7369,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
}
-%%% Untyped variables:
+% Untyped variables:
% @defvr category var args
\makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
@@ -5780,7 +7380,8 @@ output) for that.)}
% \defcvof {category of}class var args
\def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
-%%% Type:
+% Types:
+
% @deftp category name args
\makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
\doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
@@ -5808,25 +7409,49 @@ output) for that.)}
% We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
%
\def\defname#1#2#3{%
+ \par
% Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
\advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
%
- % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
+ % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
+ % on a line by itself.
+ \rettypeownlinefalse
+ \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically?
+ % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else
+ \rettypeownlinetrue
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ %
+ % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps
% distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
% just below it.
\def\temp{#1}%
\setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
%
- % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
+ % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at
+ % least two.
+ \tempnum = 2
+ %
% The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
% we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
\dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
+ %
+ % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
+ \ifrettypeownline
+ \advance\tempnum by 1
+ \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}%
+ \else
+ \def\maybeshapeline{}%
+ \fi
+ %
% The continuations:
\dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
- % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
- \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
%
- % Put the type name to the right margin.
+ % The final paragraph shape:
+ \parshape \tempnum 0in \dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2
+ %
+ % Put the category name at the right margin.
\noindent
\hbox to 0pt{%
\hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
@@ -5848,8 +7473,16 @@ output) for that.)}
% . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
% one has made identifiers using them :).
\df \tt
- \def\temp{#2}% return value type
- \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
+ \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
+ \ifx\temp\empty\else
+ \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
+ \ifrettypeownline
+ % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
+ \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
+ \else
+ \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space
+ \fi
+ \fi % no return type
#3% output function name
}%
{\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
@@ -5869,8 +7502,11 @@ output) for that.)}
\df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
%
% On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
- % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
- \let\var=\ttslanted
+ % want a way to get ttsl. We used to recommend @var for that, so
+ % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter.
+ % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen
+ % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny. @code also disables ?` !`.
+ \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
#1%
\sl\hyphenchar\font=45
}
@@ -5950,12 +7586,14 @@ output) for that.)}
\ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
\ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
}
+% these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
+% has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
\def\badparencount{%
- \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}%
+ \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
\global\parencount=0
}
\def\badbrackcount{%
- \errmessage{Unbalanced square braces in @def}%
+ \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
\global\brackcount=0
}
@@ -5965,7 +7603,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
-\ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
+\ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
\newwrite\macscribble
\def\scantokens#1{%
\toks0={#1}%
@@ -5976,29 +7614,43 @@ output) for that.)}
}
\fi
+\let\aftermacroxxx\relax
+\def\aftermacro{\aftermacroxxx}
+
+% alias because \c means cedilla in @tex or @math
+\let\texinfoc=\c
+
+% Used at the time of macro expansion.
+% Argument is macro body with arguments substituted
\def\scanmacro#1{%
- \begingroup
- \newlinechar`\^^M
- \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
- % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
- % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
- % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
- % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
- % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
- \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
- % ... and \example
- \spaceisspace
- %
- % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
- % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
- % --kasal, 29nov03
- \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
- \endgroup
+ \newlinechar`\^^M
+ \def\xprocessmacroarg{\eatspaces}%
+ %
+ % Process the macro body under the current catcode regime.
+ \scantokens{#1\texinfoc}\aftermacro%
+ %
+ % The \c is to remove the \newlinechar added by \scantokens, and
+ % can be noticed by \parsearg.
+ % The \aftermacro allows a \comment at the end of the macro definition
+ % to duplicate itself past the final \newlinechar added by \scantokens:
+ % this is used in the definition of \group to comment out a newline. We
+ % don't do the same for \c to support Texinfo files with macros that ended
+ % with a @c, which should no longer be necessary.
+ % We avoid surrounding the call to \scantokens with \bgroup and \egroup
+ % to allow macros to open or close groups themselves.
}
+% Used for copying and captions
\def\scanexp#1{%
+ \bgroup
+ % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \printindex
+ % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
+ % backslash to get it printed correctly.
+ % FIXME: This may not be needed.
+ %\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
\edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
\temp
+ \egroup
}
\newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
@@ -6022,7 +7674,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
% \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
% (except of course we have to play expansion games).
-%
+%
\def\cslet#1#2{%
\expandafter\let
\csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
@@ -6048,41 +7700,60 @@ output) for that.)}
% Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
-% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
-
+% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
+% to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
+%
+% Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
+% them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
+% confine the change to the current group.
+%
% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
-% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
+% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
-
-\def\scanctxt{%
+%
+\def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
\catcode`\"=\other
\catcode`\+=\other
\catcode`\<=\other
\catcode`\>=\other
- \catcode`\@=\other
\catcode`\^=\other
\catcode`\_=\other
\catcode`\|=\other
\catcode`\~=\other
+ \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
}
-\def\scanargctxt{%
+\def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
\scanctxt
+ \catcode`\@=\other
\catcode`\\=\other
\catcode`\^^M=\other
}
-\def\macrobodyctxt{%
+\def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
\scanctxt
+ \catcode`\ =\other
+ \catcode`\@=\other
\catcode`\{=\other
\catcode`\}=\other
\catcode`\^^M=\other
\usembodybackslash
}
+% Used when scanning braced macro arguments. Note, however, that catcode
+% changes here are ineffectual if the macro invocation was nested inside
+% an argument to another Texinfo command.
\def\macroargctxt{%
\scanctxt
- \catcode`\\=\other
+ \catcode`\ =\active
+ \catcode`\^^M=\other
+ \catcode`\\=\active
+}
+
+\def\macrolineargctxt{% used for whole-line arguments without braces
+ \scanctxt
+ \catcode`\{=\other
+ \catcode`\}=\other
}
% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
@@ -6090,22 +7761,30 @@ output) for that.)}
% where N is the macro parameter number.
% We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
% \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
-
+%
{\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
@gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
@gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
}
\expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
+\def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 }
+
\def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
\def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
\def\macroxxx#1{%
- \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
+ \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
\ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
- \paramno=0%
+ \paramno=0\relax
\else
\expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
+ \if\paramno>256\relax
+ \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments}
+ \fi
+ \fi
\fi
\if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
\message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
@@ -6147,125 +7826,513 @@ output) for that.)}
\fi
}
-% This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
-% <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
-% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
+% \getargs -- Parse the arguments to a @macro line. Set \macname to
+% the name of the macro, and \argl to the braced argument list.
\def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
\def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
-\def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
+\def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
\def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
+% This made use of the feature that if the last token of a
+% <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
+% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
-% Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
-% so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
-% in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
+% Parse the optional {params} list to @macro or @rmacro.
+% Set \paramno to the number of arguments,
+% and \paramlist to a parameter text for the macro (e.g. #1,#2,#3 for a
+% three-param macro.) Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH in the params
+% list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded. If there are
+% less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
+% is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
+% defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
+%
% That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
-
-% We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
-% The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
-% unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
-% it to # just before using the token list produced.
%
-% The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
-% the macro is used.
-
-\def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
- \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,}
+% If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used: see
+% \parsemmanyargdef.
+%
+\def\parsemargdef#1;{%
+ \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
+ \let\hash\relax
+ % \hash is redefined to `#' later to get it into definitions
+ \let\processmacroarg\relax
+ \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,%
+ \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else
+ \paramno0\relax
+ \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments
+ \fi
+}
\def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
\if#1;\let\next=\relax
\else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
- \advance\paramno by 1%
+ \advance\paramno by 1
\expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
- {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
+ {\processmacroarg{\hash\the\paramno}}%
\edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
\fi\next}
-% These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
-% (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
+% \parsemacbody, \parsermacbody
+%
+% Read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. (They're different since
+% rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
+%
+% We are in \macrobodyctxt, and the \xdef causes backslashshes in the macro
+% body to be transformed.
+% Set \macrobody to the body of the macro, and call \defmacro.
+%
+{\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsemacbody#1@end macro{%
+\xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
+{\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro{%
+\xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
+
+% Make @ a letter, so that we can make private-to-Texinfo macro names.
+\edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@}
+\catcode `@=11\relax
+
+%%%%%%%%%%%%%% Code for > 10 arguments only %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
+
+% If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
+% hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
+% processed again to replace the arguments.
+%
+% In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
+% argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
+% the catcode regime under which the body was input).
+%
+% If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
+% arguments, no macro can have more than 256 arguments (else error).
+%
+% In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
+% list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
+% each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
+% in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
+% are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
+% twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
+\def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{%
+ \if#1;\let\next=\relax
+ \else
+ \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@
+ \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
+ \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
+ \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}%
+ % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
+ % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an
+ % \xdef .
+ \expandafter\edef\tempa
+ {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
+ \advance\paramno by 1\relax
+ \fi\next}
+
-\long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
-{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
-\long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
-{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
+\let\endargs@\relax
+\let\nil@\relax
+\def\nilm@{\nil@}%
+\long\def\nillm@{\nil@}%
-% This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
-% nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
-% Much magic with \expandafter here.
+% This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
+% definition. It gets all the arguments' values and assigns them to macros
+% macarg.ARGNAME
+%
+% #1 is the macro name
+% #2 is the list of argument names
+% #3 is the list of argument values
+\def\getargvals@#1#2#3{%
+ \def\macargdeflist@{}%
+ \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
+ \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}%
+ \def\macroname{#1}%
+ \begingroup
+ \macroargctxt
+ \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}%
+ \def\@tempa{#3}%
+ \ifx\@tempa\empty
+ \setemptyargvalues@
+ \else
+ \getargvals@@
+ \fi
+}
+\def\getargvals@@{%
+ \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
+ % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
+ \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}%
+ \fi
+ \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
+ \else
+ \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
+ % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg
+ % macros to empty.
+ \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
+ \else
+ % pop current arg name into \@tempb
+ \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}%
+ \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}%
+ % pop current argument value into \@tempc
+ \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}%
+ \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
+ % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
+ % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
+ \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}%
+ \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax
+ \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{%
+ \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}%
+ \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}%
+ \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@
+ \let\next\getargvals@@
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \next
+}
+
+\def\push@#1#2{%
+ \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
+ \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
+ \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
+ \expandafter#1#2}%
+}
+
+% Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
+% in macro \@tempa.
+%
+\def\macvalstoargs@{%
+ % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
+ % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
+ % values into respective token registers.
+ %
+ % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
+ \begingroup
+ \paramno0\relax
+ % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
+ % value into a new token list register \toks#N
+ \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,%
+ % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
+ % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
+ % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
+ \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}%
+ % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
+ % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
+ % group.
+ \expandafter
+ \endgroup
+ \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}%
+ }
+
+% Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
+%
+\def\macargexpandinbody@{%
+ \expandafter
+ \endgroup
+ \macargdeflist@
+ % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
+ % is in \@tempa .
+ \macvalstoargs@
+ % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
+ % with \@tempb .
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname
+ % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
+ % \egroup .
+ \ifx\@tempb\gobble
+ \let\@tempc\relax
+ \else
+ \let\@tempc\egroup
+ \fi
+ % And now we do the real job:
+ \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}%
+ \@tempd
+}
+
+\def\putargsintokens@#1,{%
+ \if#1;\let\next\relax
+ \else
+ \let\next\putargsintokens@
+ % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
+ % alias \@tempb .
+ \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno
+ % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname
+ \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}%
+ \advance\paramno by 1\relax
+ \fi
+ \next
+}
+
+% Trailing missing arguments are set to empty.
+%
+\def\setemptyargvalues@{%
+ \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
+ \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
+ \else
+ \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@
+ \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
+ \fi
+ \next
+}
+
+\def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{%
+ \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{%
+ \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}%
+ \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@
+ \def\paramlist{#2}%
+}
+
+% #1 is the element target macro
+% #2 is the list macro
+% #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
+\def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
+ \def#1{#3}%
+ \def#2{#4}%
+}
+\long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
+ \long\def#1{#3}%
+ \long\def#2{#4}%
+}
+
+
+%%%%%%%%%%%%%% End of code for > 10 arguments %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
+
+
+
+% Remove following spaces at the expansion stage.
+% This works because spaces are discarded before each argument when TeX is
+% getting the arguments for a macro.
+% This must not be immediately followed by a }.
+\long\def\gobblespaces#1{#1}
+
+% This defines a Texinfo @macro or @rmacro, called by \parsemacbody.
+% \macrobody has the body of the macro in it, with placeholders for
+% its parameters, looking like "\processmacroarg{\hash 1}".
+% \paramno is the number of parameters
+% \paramlist is a TeX parameter text, e.g. "#1,#2,#3,"
+% There are eight cases: recursive and nonrecursive macros of zero, one,
+% up to nine, and many arguments.
% \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
-% they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
+% they're defined in: @include reads the file inside a group.
+%
\def\defmacro{%
\let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
- \ifrecursive
+ \ifnum\paramno=1
+ \def\processmacroarg{\gobblespaces}%
+ % This removes the pair of braces around the argument. We don't
+ % use \eatspaces, because this can cause ends of lines to be lost
+ % when the argument to \eatspaces is read, leading to line-based
+ % commands like "@itemize" not being read correctly.
+ \else
+ \def\processmacroarg{\xprocessmacroarg}%
+ \let\xprocessmacroarg\relax
+ \fi
+ \ifrecursive %%%%%%%%%%%%%% Recursive %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
\ifcase\paramno
% 0
\expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
+ \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
\or % 1
\expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
+ \bgroup
\noexpand\braceorline
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
- \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
- \else % many
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
- \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \expandafter\xdef
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
- \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname{%
+ \noexpand\gobblespaces##1\empty}%
+ % The \empty is for \gobblespaces in case #1 is empty
+ }%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname##1{%
+ \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
+ \else
+ \ifnum\paramno<10\relax % at most 9
+ % See non-recursive section below for comments
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \bgroup
+ \noexpand\expandafter
+ \noexpand\macroargctxt
+ \noexpand\expandafter
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname##1{%
+ \noexpand\passargtomacro
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{##1,}}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname ##1}%
+ \expandafter\expandafter
+ \expandafter\xdef
+ \expandafter\expandafter
+ \csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname\paramlist{%
+ \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
+ \else % 10 or more
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
+ }%
+ \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\macrobody
+ \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble
+ \fi
\fi
- \else
+ \else %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% Non-recursive %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
\ifcase\paramno
% 0
\expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
+ \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
\or % 1
\expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
+ \bgroup
\noexpand\braceorline
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname{%
+ \noexpand\gobblespaces##1\empty}%
+ % The \empty is for \gobblespaces in case #1 is empty
+ }%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname##1{%
\egroup
- \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
- \else % many
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \expandafter\xdef
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
- \paramlist{%
- \egroup
- \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
+ \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}%
+ }%
+ \else % at most 9
+ \ifnum\paramno<10\relax
+ % @MACNAME sets the context for reading the macro argument
+ % @MACNAME@@ gets the argument, processes backslashes and appends a
+ % comma.
+ % @MACNAME@@@ removes braces surrounding the argument list.
+ % @MACNAME@@@@ scans the macro body with arguments substituted.
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \bgroup
+ \noexpand\expandafter % This \expandafter skip any spaces after the
+ \noexpand\macroargctxt % macro before we change the catcode of space.
+ \noexpand\expandafter
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname##1{%
+ \noexpand\passargtomacro
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{##1,}}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname ##1}%
+ \expandafter\expandafter
+ \expandafter\xdef
+ \expandafter\expandafter
+ \csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname\paramlist{%
+ \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
+ \else % 10 or more:
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
+ }%
+ \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\macrobody
+ \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\norecurse
+ \fi
\fi
\fi}
+\catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax % end private-to-Texinfo catcodes
+
\def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
-% \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
-% {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
-% line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
-% as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
+
+%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
+%
+{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=13 % We need to manipulate \ so use @ as escape
+@catcode`@_=11 % private names
+@catcode`@!=11 % used as argument separator
+
+% \passargtomacro#1#2 -
+% Call #1 with a list of tokens #2, with any doubled backslashes in #2
+% compressed to one.
+%
+% This implementation works by expansion, and not execution (so we cannot use
+% \def or similar). This reduces the risk of this failing in contexts where
+% complete expansion is done with no execution (for example, in writing out to
+% an auxiliary file for an index entry).
+%
+% State is kept in the input stream: the argument passed to
+% @look_ahead, @gobble_and_check_finish and @add_segment is
+%
+% THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT ! {PENDING_BS} NEXT_TOKEN (... rest of input)
+%
+% where:
+% THE_MACRO - name of the macro we want to call
+% ARG_RESULT - argument list we build to pass to that macro
+% PENDING_BS - either a backslash or nothing
+% NEXT_TOKEN - used to look ahead in the input stream to see what's coming next
+
+@gdef@passargtomacro#1#2{%
+ @add_segment #1!{}@relax#2\@_finish\%
+}
+@gdef@_finish{@_finishx} @global@let@_finishx@relax
+
+% #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
+% #2 - PENDING_BS
+% #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
+% #4 used to look ahead
+%
+% If the next token is not a backslash, process the rest of the argument;
+% otherwise, remove the next token.
+@gdef@look_ahead#1!#2#3#4{%
+ @ifx#4\%
+ @expandafter@gobble_and_check_finish
+ @else
+ @expandafter@add_segment
+ @fi#1!{#2}#4#4%
+}
+
+% #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
+% #2 - PENDING_BS
+% #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
+% #4 should be a backslash, which is gobbled.
+% #5 looks ahead
+%
+% Double backslash found. Add a single backslash, and look ahead.
+@gdef@gobble_and_check_finish#1!#2#3#4#5{%
+ @add_segment#1\!{}#5#5%
+}
+
+@gdef@is_fi{@fi}
+
+% #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
+% #2 - PENDING_BS
+% #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
+% #4 is input stream until next backslash
+%
+% Input stream is either at the start of the argument, or just after a
+% backslash sequence, either a lone backslash, or a doubled backslash.
+% NEXT_TOKEN contains the first token in the input stream: if it is \finish,
+% finish; otherwise, append to ARG_RESULT the segment of the argument up until
+% the next backslash. PENDING_BACKSLASH contains a backslash to represent
+% a backslash just before the start of the input stream that has not been
+% added to ARG_RESULT.
+@gdef@add_segment#1!#2#3#4\{%
+@ifx#3@_finish
+ @call_the_macro#1!%
+@else
+ % append the pending backslash to the result, followed by the next segment
+ @expandafter@is_fi@look_ahead#1#2#4!{\}@fi
+ % this @fi is discarded by @look_ahead.
+ % we can't get rid of it with \expandafter because we don't know how
+ % long #4 is.
+}
+
+% #1 - THE_MACRO
+% #2 - ARG_RESULT
+% #3 discards the res of the conditional in @add_segment, and @is_fi ends the
+% conditional.
+@gdef@call_the_macro#1#2!#3@fi{@is_fi #1{#2}}
+
+}
+%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
+
+% \braceorline MAC is used for a one-argument macro MAC. It checks
+% whether the next non-whitespace character is a {. It sets the context
+% for reading the argument (slightly different in the two cases). Then,
+% to read the argument, in the whole-line case, it then calls the regular
+% \parsearg MAC; in the lbrace case, it calls \passargtomacro MAC.
+%
\def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
\def\braceorlinexxx{%
- \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
- \expandafter\parsearg
+ \ifx\nchar\bgroup
+ \macroargctxt
+ \expandafter\passargtomacro
+ \else
+ \macrolineargctxt\expandafter\parsearg
\fi \macnamexxx}
% @alias.
% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
-% sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
+% sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
+%
\def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
@@ -6286,7 +8353,8 @@ output) for that.)}
% @inforef is relatively simple.
\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
-\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
+\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{%
+ \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
% @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
@@ -6325,7 +8393,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
% anchor), which consists of three parts:
-% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \thissection,
+% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
% or the anchor name.
% 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
% empty for anchors.
@@ -6339,47 +8407,87 @@ output) for that.)}
\pdfmkdest{#1}%
\iflinks
{%
+ \requireauxfile
\atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
\edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
\write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
}%
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\thissection}%
+ \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
\immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
\immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
- \writexrdef{pg}{\folio}% will be written later, during \shipout
+ \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
}%
\fi
}
+% @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
+% automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
+% This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
+% variable, now it's official.
+%
+\parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\onword
+ \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
+ = \empty
+ \else\ifx\temp\offword
+ \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
+ = \relax
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp',
+ must be on|off}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+
+%
% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
% node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
% manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
%
-\def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
-\def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
-\def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
+\def\pxref{\putwordsee{} \xrefXX}
+\def\xref{\putwordSee{} \xrefXX}
+\def\ref{\xrefXX}
+
+\def\xrefXX#1{\def\xrefXXarg{#1}\futurelet\tokenafterxref\xrefXXX}
+\def\xrefXXX{\expandafter\xrefX\expandafter[\xrefXXarg,,,,,,,]}
+%
+\newbox\toprefbox
+\newbox\printedrefnamebox
+\newbox\infofilenamebox
+\newbox\printedmanualbox
+%
\def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
\unsepspaces
- \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
+ %
+ % Get args without leading/trailing spaces.
\def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
- \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
- \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
- \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
+ \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
+ %
+ \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}%
+ \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}%
+ %
+ \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
+ \setbox\printedmanualbox = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
+ %
+ % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
+ % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
+ \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
% No printed node name was explicitly given.
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
- % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax
+ % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
\def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
\else
- % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
- % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
- \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
- % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
+ % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
+ % the square brackets if we have it.
+ \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
+ % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
\def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
\else
\ifhavexrefs
- % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
+ % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
\def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
\else
% Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
@@ -6391,23 +8499,32 @@ output) for that.)}
%
% Make link in pdf output.
\ifpdf
- \leavevmode
- \getfilename{#4}%
{\indexnofonts
\turnoffactive
- % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
- {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
- \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
+ % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
+ % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
+ \getfilename{#4}%
+ %
+ % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
+ % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
+ \edef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
+ \ifx\pdfxrefdest\empty
+ \def\pdfxrefdest{Top}% no empty targets
+ \else
+ \txiescapepdf\pdfxrefdest % escape PDF special chars
+ \fi
%
+ \leavevmode
+ \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
\ifnum\filenamelength>0
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
- goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
+ goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
\else
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
- goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
+ goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
\fi
}%
- \linkcolor
+ \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
\fi
%
% Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
@@ -6424,29 +8541,42 @@ output) for that.)}
\iffloat\Xthisreftitle
% If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
% print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
- \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
+ \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
\refx{#1-snt}{}%
\else
\printedrefname
\fi
%
- % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
+ % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
% "in MANUALNAME".
- \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
+ \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
\space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
\fi
\else
% node/anchor (non-float) references.
+ %
+ % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
+ % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
+ % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
+ % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
+ % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name
+ % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
+ %
+ \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
+ % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name.
+ %
+ \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}%
+ %
+ \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt
+ % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no
+ % printed manual name (arg 5). This is essentially the same as
+ % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else.
+ %
+ \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}%
%
- % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
- % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
- % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
- % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
- % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
- % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
- \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
- \putwordsection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
\else
+ % Reference within this manual.
+ %
% _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
% control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
% into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
@@ -6458,7 +8588,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
\ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
}%
- % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
+ % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
\xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
%
% But we always want a comma and a space:
@@ -6466,11 +8596,43 @@ output) for that.)}
%
% output the `page 3'.
\turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
- \fi
+ \ifx,\tokenafterxref
+ \else\ifx.\tokenafterxref
+ \else\ifx;\tokenafterxref
+ \else\ifx)\tokenafterxref
+ \else,% add a , if xref not followed by punctuation
+ \fi\fi\fi\fi
+ \fi\fi
\fi
\endlink
\endgroup}
+% Output a cross-manual xref to #1. Used just above (twice).
+%
+% Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither
+% missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply
+% "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual.
+%
+% But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the
+% string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in
+% the input. By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less
+% likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g.,
+% in a monospaced font). Hopefully it will never happen in practice.
+%
+% For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
+% reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
+%
+\def\crossmanualxref#1{%
+ \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}%
+ \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
+ \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp % nonempty?
+ \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else % same as Top?
+ \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ #1%
+}
+
% This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
% output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
% since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
@@ -6510,6 +8672,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
%
\def\refx#1#2{%
+ \requireauxfile
{%
\indexnofonts
\otherbackslash
@@ -6521,7 +8684,8 @@ output) for that.)}
\angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
\iflinks
\ifhavexrefs
- \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}%
+ {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
+ \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}%
\else
\ifwarnedxrefs\else
\global\warnedxrefstrue
@@ -6572,6 +8736,23 @@ output) for that.)}
\fi
}
+% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
+% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
+% This is done with @novalidate at the beginning of the file.
+%
+\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
+\let\novalidate = \linksfalse
+
+% Used when writing to the aux file, or when using data from it.
+\def\requireauxfile{%
+ \iflinks
+ \tryauxfile
+ % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
+ \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
+ \fi
+ \global\let\requireauxfile=\relax % Only do this once.
+}
+
% Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
%
\def\tryauxfile{%
@@ -6651,14 +8832,7 @@ output) for that.)}
\catcode`\\=\other
%
% Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
- {%
- \count1=128
- \def\loop{%
- \catcode\count1=\other
- \advance\count1 by 1
- \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
- }%
- }%
+ {\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other}%
%
% @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
\catcode`\{=1
@@ -6685,15 +8859,13 @@ output) for that.)}
% space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
\def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
-% @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
+% @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
\let\footnotestyle=\comment
{\catcode `\@=11
%
% Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
\gdef\footnote{%
- \let\indent=\ptexindent
- \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
\global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
\edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
%
@@ -6717,6 +8889,11 @@ output) for that.)}
%
\gdef\dofootnote{%
\insert\footins\bgroup
+ %
+ % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot
+ % more work. (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.)
+ \let\footnote=\errfootnotenest
+ %
% We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
% footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
% So reset some parameters.
@@ -6748,17 +8925,30 @@ output) for that.)}
% expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
% provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
\footstrut
+ %
+ % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
\futurelet\next\fo@t
}
}%end \catcode `\@=11
+\def\errfootnotenest{%
+ \errhelp=\EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex,
+ even though they work in makeinfo; sorry}
+}
+
+\def\errfootnoteheading{%
+ \errhelp=\EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Footnotes in chapters, sections, etc., are not supported}
+}
+
% In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
% the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
% would be lost.
-% Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
+% Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
% And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
-
+%
% Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
% Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
% out prematurely.
@@ -6835,7 +9025,7 @@ output) for that.)}
it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
%
\def\image#1{%
- \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
+ \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined
\ifwarnednoepsf \else
\errhelp = \noepsfhelp
\errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
@@ -6851,23 +9041,39 @@ output) for that.)}
% #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
% #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
% #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
-% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
+% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
\newif\ifimagevmode
\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
\catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
\normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
+ \def\xprocessmacroarg{\eatspaces}% in case we are being used via a macro
% If the image is by itself, center it.
\ifvmode
\imagevmodetrue
- \nobreak\bigskip
+ \else \ifx\centersub\centerV
+ % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space
+ \imagevmodetrue
+ \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev
+ \fi\fi
+ %
+ \ifimagevmode
+ \nobreak\medskip
% Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
% \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
% above and below.
\nobreak\vskip\parskip
\nobreak
- \line\bgroup
\fi
%
+ % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
+ % environment such as @quotation is respected.
+ % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the
+ % normal paragraph indentation.
+ % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't
+ % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and
+ % eradicate the centering.
+ \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi
+ %
% Output the image.
\ifpdf
\dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
@@ -6878,7 +9084,10 @@ output) for that.)}
\epsfbox{#1.eps}%
\fi
%
- \ifimagevmode \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image
+ \ifimagevmode
+ \medskip % space after a standalone image
+ \fi
+ \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi
\endgroup}
@@ -6945,13 +9154,13 @@ output) for that.)}
\global\advance\floatno by 1
%
{%
- % This magic value for \thissection is output by \setref as the
+ % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
% XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
% labels (which have a completely different output format) from
% node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
% lists of floats.
%
- \edef\thissection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
+ \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
\setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
}%
\fi
@@ -7018,6 +9227,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
% caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
{%
+ \requireauxfile
\atdummies
%
% since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
@@ -7086,7 +9296,7 @@ output) for that.)}
% #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
% which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
-% \thissection value which we \setref above.
+% \lastsection value which we \setref above.
%
\def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
%
@@ -7150,34 +9360,128 @@ output) for that.)}
\message{localization,}
-% @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
-% @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything
-% properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation.
-% It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here.
+% For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
+% early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
+% (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
%
+{
+ \catcode`\_ = \active
+ \globaldefs=1
\parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
\tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
- % Read the file if it exists.
+ % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
+ \let_ = \normalunderscore % normal _ character for filename test
\openin 1 txi-#1.tex
\ifeof 1
- \errhelp = \nolanghelp
- \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
+ \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore #1_\finish
\else
+ \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
\input txi-#1.tex
\fi
\closein 1
- \endgroup
+ \endgroup % end raw TeX
+}
+%
+% If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
+% try txi-de.tex.
+%
+\gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
+ \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
+ \ifeof 1
+ \errhelp = \nolanghelp
+ \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
+ \else
+ \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
+ \input txi-#1.tex
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
}
+}% end of special _ catcode
+%
\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
-is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory
-should work if nowhere else does.}
+is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
+directory should work if nowhere else does.}
+
+% This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
+% \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
+% third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
+%
+% The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
+% See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
+% /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
+%
+% With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
+% available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
+% Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
+% accented characters problem.)
+%
+\catcode`@=11
+\def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
+ % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
+ \message{no patterns for #1}%
+ \else
+ \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
+ \fi
+ % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
+ \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
+ \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
+}
+
+% Get input by bytes instead of by UTF-8 codepoints for XeTeX and LuaTeX,
+% otherwise the encoding support is completely broken.
+\ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
+\else
+\XeTeXdefaultencoding "bytes" % For subsequent files to be read
+\XeTeXinputencoding "bytes" % Effective in texinfo.tex only
+% Unfortunately, there seems to be no corresponding XeTeX command for
+% output encoding. This is a problem for auxiliary index and TOC files.
+% The only solution would be perhaps to write out @U{...} sequences in
+% place of UTF-8 characters.
+\fi
+\ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
+\else
+\directlua{
+local utf8_char, byte, gsub = unicode.utf8.char, string.byte, string.gsub
+local function convert_char (char)
+ return utf8_char(byte(char))
+end
+
+local function convert_line (line)
+ return gsub(line, ".", convert_char)
+end
+
+callback.register("process_input_buffer", convert_line)
+
+local function convert_line_out (line)
+ local line_out = ""
+ for c in string.utfvalues(line) do
+ line_out = line_out .. string.char(c)
+ end
+ return line_out
+end
+
+callback.register("process_output_buffer", convert_line_out)
+}
+\fi
+
+
+% Helpers for encodings.
% Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
%
\def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
\count255=128
\loop\ifnum\count255<256
- \global\catcode\count255=#1
+ \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
+ \advance\count255 by 1
+ \repeat
+}
+
+\def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
+ \count255=128
+ \loop\ifnum\count255<256
+ \catcode\count255=#1\relax
\advance\count255 by 1
\repeat
}
@@ -7185,7 +9489,16 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
% @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
% according to the specified encoding.
%
-\parseargdef\documentencoding{%
+\def\documentencoding{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\documentencodingzzz}
+\def\documentencodingzzz#1{%
+ % Get input by bytes instead of by UTF-8 codepoints for XeTeX,
+ % otherwise the encoding support is completely broken.
+ % This settings is for the document root file.
+ \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
+ \else
+ \XeTeXinputencoding "bytes"
+ \fi
+ %
% Encoding being declared for the document.
\def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
%
@@ -7204,7 +9517,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\setnonasciicharscatcode\active
\lattwochardefs
%
- \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
+ \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
\setnonasciicharscatcode\active
\latonechardefs
%
@@ -7214,10 +9527,12 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
%
\else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
\setnonasciicharscatcode\active
- \utfeightchardefs
+ % since we already invoked \utfeightchardefs at the top level
+ % (below), do not re-invoke it, then our check for duplicated
+ % definitions triggers. Making non-ascii chars active is enough.
%
- \else
- \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}%
+ \else
+ \message{Ignoring unknown document encoding: #1.}%
%
\fi % utfeight
\fi % latnine
@@ -7226,10 +9541,11 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\fi % ascii
}
+% emacs-page
% A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
% the default font encoding (OT1).
-%
-\def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}}
+%
+\def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing, sorry: #1.}}
% Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
\def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
@@ -7241,21 +9557,21 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
%
% Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
\def\latonechardefs{%
- \gdef^^a0{~}
+ \gdef^^a0{\tie}
\gdef^^a1{\exclamdown}
- \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}}
- \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}}
- \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
- \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}}
- \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}}
+ \gdef^^a2{{\tcfont \char162}} % cent
+ \gdef^^a3{\pounds}
+ \gdef^^a4{{\tcfont \char164}} % currency
+ \gdef^^a5{{\tcfont \char165}} % yen
+ \gdef^^a6{{\tcfont \char166}} % broken bar
\gdef^^a7{\S}
- \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
- \gdef^^a9{\copyright}
+ \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
+ \gdef^^a9{\copyright}
\gdef^^aa{\ordf}
- \gdef^^ab{\missingcharmsg{LEFT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}}
- \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$}
- \gdef^^ad{\-}
- \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol}
+ \gdef^^ab{\guillemetleft}
+ \gdef^^ac{\ensuremath\lnot}
+ \gdef^^ad{\-}
+ \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol}
\gdef^^af{\={}}
%
\gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
@@ -7265,13 +9581,11 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^b4{\'{}}
\gdef^^b5{$\mu$}
\gdef^^b6{\P}
- %
- \gdef^^b7{$^.$}
+ \gdef^^b7{\ensuremath\cdot}
\gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
\gdef^^b9{$^1$}
\gdef^^ba{\ordm}
- %
- \gdef^^bb{\missingcharmsg{RIGHT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}}
+ \gdef^^bb{\guillemetright}
\gdef^^bc{$1\over4$}
\gdef^^bd{$1\over2$}
\gdef^^be{$3\over4$}
@@ -7282,7 +9596,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^c2{\^A}
\gdef^^c3{\~A}
\gdef^^c4{\"A}
- \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A}
+ \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A}
\gdef^^c6{\AE}
\gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
\gdef^^c8{\`E}
@@ -7294,7 +9608,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^ce{\^I}
\gdef^^cf{\"I}
%
- \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER ETH}}
+ \gdef^^d0{\DH}
\gdef^^d1{\~N}
\gdef^^d2{\`O}
\gdef^^d3{\'O}
@@ -7308,7 +9622,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^db{\^U}
\gdef^^dc{\"U}
\gdef^^dd{\'Y}
- \gdef^^de{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER THORN}}
+ \gdef^^de{\TH}
\gdef^^df{\ss}
%
\gdef^^e0{\`a}
@@ -7328,7 +9642,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
\gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
%
- \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER ETH}}
+ \gdef^^f0{\dh}
\gdef^^f1{\~n}
\gdef^^f2{\`o}
\gdef^^f3{\'o}
@@ -7342,7 +9656,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^fb{\^u}
\gdef^^fc{\"u}
\gdef^^fd{\'y}
- \gdef^^fe{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER THORN}}
+ \gdef^^fe{\th}
\gdef^^ff{\"y}
}
@@ -7363,8 +9677,8 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
% Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
\def\lattwochardefs{%
- \gdef^^a0{~}
- \gdef^^a1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
+ \gdef^^a0{\tie}
+ \gdef^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
\gdef^^a2{\u{}}
\gdef^^a3{\L}
\gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
@@ -7381,8 +9695,8 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z}
%
\gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
- \gdef^^b1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
- \gdef^^b2{\missingcharmsg{OGONEK}}
+ \gdef^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
+ \gdef^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
\gdef^^b3{\l}
\gdef^^b4{\'{}}
\gdef^^b5{\v l}
@@ -7407,14 +9721,14 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
\gdef^^c8{\v C}
\gdef^^c9{\'E}
- \gdef^^ca{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
+ \gdef^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
\gdef^^cb{\"E}
\gdef^^cc{\v E}
\gdef^^cd{\'I}
\gdef^^ce{\^I}
\gdef^^cf{\v D}
%
- \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
+ \gdef^^d0{\DH}
\gdef^^d1{\'N}
\gdef^^d2{\v N}
\gdef^^d3{\'O}
@@ -7423,7 +9737,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^d6{\"O}
\gdef^^d7{$\times$}
\gdef^^d8{\v R}
- \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U}
+ \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U}
\gdef^^da{\'U}
\gdef^^db{\H U}
\gdef^^dc{\"U}
@@ -7441,14 +9755,14 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
\gdef^^e8{\v c}
\gdef^^e9{\'e}
- \gdef^^ea{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
+ \gdef^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
\gdef^^eb{\"e}
\gdef^^ec{\v e}
- \gdef^^ed{\'\i}
- \gdef^^ee{\^\i}
+ \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}}
+ \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}}
\gdef^^ef{\v d}
%
- \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
+ \gdef^^f0{\dh}
\gdef^^f1{\'n}
\gdef^^f2{\v n}
\gdef^^f3{\'o}
@@ -7467,11 +9781,11 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
}
% UTF-8 character definitions.
-%
+%
% This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
% changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
% permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
-%
+%
\newcount\countUTFx
\newcount\countUTFy
\newcount\countUTFz
@@ -7525,6 +9839,18 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\UTFviiiLoop
\endgroup
+\def\globallet{\global\let} % save some \expandafter's below
+
+% @U{xxxx} to produce U+xxxx, if we support it.
+\def\U#1{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unicode character U+#1 not supported, sorry}%
+ \else
+ \csname uni:#1\endcsname
+ \fi
+}
+
\begingroup
\catcode`\"=12
\catcode`\<=12
@@ -7533,10 +9859,9 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\catcode`\;=12
\catcode`\!=12
\catcode`\~=13
-
\gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
\countUTFz = "#1\relax
- \wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
+ %\wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
\begingroup
\parseXMLCharref
\def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{%
@@ -7548,6 +9873,13 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
+ %
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax \else
+ \message{Internal error, already defined: #1}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % define an additional control sequence for this code point.
+ \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFviiiTmp
\endgroup}
\gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
@@ -7585,21 +9917,53 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
\endgroup
+% https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Plane_(Unicode)#Basic_M
+% U+0000..U+007F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Basic_Latin_(Unicode_block)
+% U+0080..U+00FF = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin-1_Supplement_(Unicode_block)
+% U+0100..U+017F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-A
+% U+0180..U+024F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-B
+%
+% Many of our renditions are less than wonderful, and all the missing
+% characters are available somewhere. Loading the necessary fonts
+% awaits user request. We can't truly support Unicode without
+% reimplementing everything that's been done in LaTeX for many years,
+% plus probably using luatex or xetex, and who knows what else.
+% We won't be doing that here in this simple file. But we can try to at
+% least make most of the characters not bomb out.
+%
\def\utfeightchardefs{%
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A2}{{\tcfont \char162}}% 0242=cent
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A4}{{\tcfont \char164}}% 0244=currency
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A5}{{\tcfont \char165}}% 0245=yen
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A6}{{\tcfont \char166}}% 0246=brokenbar
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A7}{\S}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AC}{\ensuremath\lnot}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B1}{\ensuremath\pm}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B2}{$^2$}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B3}{$^3$}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B5}{$\mu$}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B6}{\P}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B7}{\ensuremath\cdot}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B9}{$^1$}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BC}{$1\over4$}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BD}{$1\over2$}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BE}{$3\over4$}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}
@@ -7619,18 +9983,21 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D7}{\ensuremath\times}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}
@@ -7650,24 +10017,29 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F7}{\ensuremath\div}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}
@@ -7677,13 +10049,18 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010F}{d'}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0110}{\DH}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0111}{\dh}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}
@@ -7693,14 +10070,20 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0122}{\cedilla{G}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0123}{\cedilla{g}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0126}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0127}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012E}{\ogonek{I}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012F}{\ogonek{i}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}
@@ -7708,15 +10091,29 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0136}{\cedilla{K}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0137}{\cedilla{k}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0138}{\ensuremath\kappa}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013B}{\cedilla{L}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013C}{\cedilla{l}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013D}{L'}% should kern
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013E}{l'}% should kern
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013F}{L\U{00B7}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0140}{l\U{00B7}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0145}{\cedilla{N}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0146}{\cedilla{n}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0149}{'n}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014A}{\missingcharmsg{ENG}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014B}{\missingcharmsg{eng}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}
@@ -7728,6 +10125,8 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0156}{\cedilla{R}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0157}{\cedilla{r}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}
@@ -7739,10 +10138,12 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{T}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{t}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}
-
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0165}{\v{t}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0166}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0167}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}
@@ -7754,6 +10155,8 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0172}{\ogonek{U}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0173}{\ogonek{u}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}
@@ -7765,6 +10168,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017F}{\missingcharmsg{LONG S}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}
@@ -7819,6 +10223,85 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}
+
+ % Greek letters upper case
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0391}{{\it A}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0392}{{\it B}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0393}{\ensuremath{\mit\Gamma}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0394}{\ensuremath{\mit\Delta}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0395}{{\it E}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0396}{{\it Z}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0397}{{\it H}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0398}{\ensuremath{\mit\Theta}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0399}{{\it I}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039A}{{\it K}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039B}{\ensuremath{\mit\Lambda}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039C}{{\it M}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039D}{{\it N}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039E}{\ensuremath{\mit\Xi}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039F}{{\it O}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A0}{\ensuremath{\mit\Pi}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A1}{{\it P}}
+ %\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A2}{} % none - corresponds to final sigma
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A3}{\ensuremath{\mit\Sigma}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A4}{{\it T}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A5}{\ensuremath{\mit\Upsilon}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A6}{\ensuremath{\mit\Phi}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A7}{{\it X}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A8}{\ensuremath{\mit\Psi}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A9}{\ensuremath{\mit\Omega}}
+
+ % Vowels with accents
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0390}{\ensuremath{\ddot{\acute\iota}}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AC}{\ensuremath{\acute\alpha}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AD}{\ensuremath{\acute\epsilon}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AE}{\ensuremath{\acute\eta}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AF}{\ensuremath{\acute\iota}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B0}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ddot\upsilon}}}
+
+ % Standalone accent
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0384}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ }}}
+
+ % Greek letters lower case
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B1}{\ensuremath\alpha}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B2}{\ensuremath\beta}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B3}{\ensuremath\gamma}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B4}{\ensuremath\delta}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B5}{\ensuremath\epsilon}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B6}{\ensuremath\zeta}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B7}{\ensuremath\eta}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B8}{\ensuremath\theta}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B9}{\ensuremath\iota}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BA}{\ensuremath\kappa}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BB}{\ensuremath\lambda}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BC}{\ensuremath\mu}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BD}{\ensuremath\nu}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BE}{\ensuremath\xi}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BF}{{\it o}} % omicron
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C0}{\ensuremath\pi}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C1}{\ensuremath\rho}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C2}{\ensuremath\varsigma}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C3}{\ensuremath\sigma}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C4}{\ensuremath\tau}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C5}{\ensuremath\upsilon}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C6}{\ensuremath\phi}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C7}{\ensuremath\chi}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C8}{\ensuremath\psi}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C9}{\ensuremath\omega}
+
+ % More Greek vowels with accents
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CA}{\ensuremath{\ddot\iota}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CB}{\ensuremath{\ddot\upsilon}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CC}{\ensuremath{\acute o}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CD}{\ensuremath{\acute\upsilon}}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CE}{\ensuremath{\acute\omega}}
+
+ % Variant Greek letters
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D1}{\ensuremath\vartheta}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D6}{\ensuremath\varpi}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03F1}{\ensuremath\varrho}
+
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}
@@ -7946,26 +10429,236 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}
+ % Punctuation
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2020}{\ensuremath\dagger}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2021}{\ensuremath\ddagger}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{202F}{\thinspace}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright}
+
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result}
+ % Mathematical symbols
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2200}{\ensuremath\forall}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2203}{\ensuremath\exists}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2208}{\ensuremath\in}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\ast}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221E}{\ensuremath\infty}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2225}{\ensuremath\parallel}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2227}{\ensuremath\wedge}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2229}{\ensuremath\cap}
\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2264}{\ensuremath\leq}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2265}{\ensuremath\geq}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2282}{\ensuremath\subset}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2287}{\ensuremath\supseteq}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2016}{\ensuremath\Vert}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2032}{\ensuremath\prime}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{210F}{\ensuremath\hbar}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2111}{\ensuremath\Im}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2113}{\ensuremath\ell}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2118}{\ensuremath\wp}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{211C}{\ensuremath\Re}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2127}{\ensuremath\mho}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2135}{\ensuremath\aleph}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2190}{\ensuremath\leftarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2191}{\ensuremath\uparrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2193}{\ensuremath\downarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2194}{\ensuremath\leftrightarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2195}{\ensuremath\updownarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2196}{\ensuremath\nwarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2197}{\ensuremath\nearrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2198}{\ensuremath\searrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2199}{\ensuremath\swarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A6}{\ensuremath\mapsto}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A9}{\ensuremath\hookleftarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21AA}{\ensuremath\hookrightarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BC}{\ensuremath\leftharpoonup}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BD}{\ensuremath\leftharpoondown}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BE}{\ensuremath\upharpoonright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C0}{\ensuremath\rightharpoonup}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C1}{\ensuremath\rightharpoondown}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21CC}{\ensuremath\rightleftharpoons}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D0}{\ensuremath\Leftarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D1}{\ensuremath\Uparrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D3}{\ensuremath\Downarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D4}{\ensuremath\Leftrightarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D5}{\ensuremath\Updownarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21DD}{\ensuremath\leadsto}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2201}{\ensuremath\complement}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2202}{\ensuremath\partial}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2205}{\ensuremath\emptyset}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2207}{\ensuremath\nabla}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2209}{\ensuremath\notin}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220B}{\ensuremath\owns}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220F}{\ensuremath\prod}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2210}{\ensuremath\coprod}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2211}{\ensuremath\sum}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2213}{\ensuremath\mp}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2218}{\ensuremath\circ}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221A}{\ensuremath\surd}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221D}{\ensuremath\propto}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2220}{\ensuremath\angle}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2223}{\ensuremath\mid}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2228}{\ensuremath\vee}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222A}{\ensuremath\cup}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222B}{\ensuremath\smallint}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222E}{\ensuremath\oint}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{223C}{\ensuremath\sim}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2240}{\ensuremath\wr}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2243}{\ensuremath\simeq}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2245}{\ensuremath\cong}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2248}{\ensuremath\approx}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{224D}{\ensuremath\asymp}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2250}{\ensuremath\doteq}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2260}{\ensuremath\neq}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226A}{\ensuremath\ll}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226B}{\ensuremath\gg}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227A}{\ensuremath\prec}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227B}{\ensuremath\succ}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2283}{\ensuremath\supset}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2286}{\ensuremath\subseteq}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228E}{\ensuremath\uplus}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228F}{\ensuremath\sqsubset}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2290}{\ensuremath\sqsupset}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2291}{\ensuremath\sqsubseteq}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2292}{\ensuremath\sqsupseteq}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2293}{\ensuremath\sqcap}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2294}{\ensuremath\sqcup}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2295}{\ensuremath\oplus}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2296}{\ensuremath\ominus}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2297}{\ensuremath\otimes}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2298}{\ensuremath\oslash}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2299}{\ensuremath\odot}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A2}{\ensuremath\vdash}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A3}{\ensuremath\dashv}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A4}{\ensuremath\ptextop}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A5}{\ensuremath\bot}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A8}{\ensuremath\models}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22B4}{\ensuremath\unlhd}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22B5}{\ensuremath\unrhd}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C0}{\ensuremath\bigwedge}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C1}{\ensuremath\bigvee}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C2}{\ensuremath\bigcap}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C3}{\ensuremath\bigcup}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C4}{\ensuremath\diamond}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C5}{\ensuremath\cdot}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C6}{\ensuremath\star}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C8}{\ensuremath\bowtie}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2308}{\ensuremath\lceil}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2309}{\ensuremath\rceil}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230A}{\ensuremath\lfloor}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230B}{\ensuremath\rfloor}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2322}{\ensuremath\frown}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2323}{\ensuremath\smile}
+
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25A1}{\ensuremath\Box}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B3}{\ensuremath\triangle}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B7}{\ensuremath\triangleright}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25BD}{\ensuremath\bigtriangledown}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C1}{\ensuremath\triangleleft}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C7}{\ensuremath\Diamond}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2660}{\ensuremath\spadesuit}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2661}{\ensuremath\heartsuit}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2662}{\ensuremath\diamondsuit}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2663}{\ensuremath\clubsuit}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266D}{\ensuremath\flat}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266E}{\ensuremath\natural}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266F}{\ensuremath\sharp}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{26AA}{\ensuremath\bigcirc}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27B9}{\ensuremath\rangle}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27C2}{\ensuremath\perp}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27E8}{\ensuremath\langle}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F5}{\ensuremath\longleftarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F6}{\ensuremath\longrightarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F7}{\ensuremath\longleftrightarrow}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27FC}{\ensuremath\longmapsto}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{29F5}{\ensuremath\setminus}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A00}{\ensuremath\bigodot}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A01}{\ensuremath\bigoplus}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A02}{\ensuremath\bigotimes}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A04}{\ensuremath\biguplus}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A06}{\ensuremath\bigsqcup}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A1D}{\ensuremath\Join}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A3F}{\ensuremath\amalg}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AAF}{\ensuremath\preceq}
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AB0}{\ensuremath\succeq}
+
+ \global\mathchardef\checkmark="1370 % actually the square root sign
+ \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2713}{\ensuremath\checkmark}
}% end of \utfeightchardefs
-
% US-ASCII character definitions.
\def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
\relax
}
+% Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
+\def\nonasciistringdefs{%
+ \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
+ \def\defstringchar##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
+ %
+ \defstringchar^^80\defstringchar^^81\defstringchar^^82\defstringchar^^83%
+ \defstringchar^^84\defstringchar^^85\defstringchar^^86\defstringchar^^87%
+ \defstringchar^^88\defstringchar^^89\defstringchar^^8a\defstringchar^^8b%
+ \defstringchar^^8c\defstringchar^^8d\defstringchar^^8e\defstringchar^^8f%
+ %
+ \defstringchar^^90\defstringchar^^91\defstringchar^^92\defstringchar^^93%
+ \defstringchar^^94\defstringchar^^95\defstringchar^^96\defstringchar^^97%
+ \defstringchar^^98\defstringchar^^99\defstringchar^^9a\defstringchar^^9b%
+ \defstringchar^^9c\defstringchar^^9d\defstringchar^^9e\defstringchar^^9f%
+ %
+ \defstringchar^^a0\defstringchar^^a1\defstringchar^^a2\defstringchar^^a3%
+ \defstringchar^^a4\defstringchar^^a5\defstringchar^^a6\defstringchar^^a7%
+ \defstringchar^^a8\defstringchar^^a9\defstringchar^^aa\defstringchar^^ab%
+ \defstringchar^^ac\defstringchar^^ad\defstringchar^^ae\defstringchar^^af%
+ %
+ \defstringchar^^b0\defstringchar^^b1\defstringchar^^b2\defstringchar^^b3%
+ \defstringchar^^b4\defstringchar^^b5\defstringchar^^b6\defstringchar^^b7%
+ \defstringchar^^b8\defstringchar^^b9\defstringchar^^ba\defstringchar^^bb%
+ \defstringchar^^bc\defstringchar^^bd\defstringchar^^be\defstringchar^^bf%
+ %
+ \defstringchar^^c0\defstringchar^^c1\defstringchar^^c2\defstringchar^^c3%
+ \defstringchar^^c4\defstringchar^^c5\defstringchar^^c6\defstringchar^^c7%
+ \defstringchar^^c8\defstringchar^^c9\defstringchar^^ca\defstringchar^^cb%
+ \defstringchar^^cc\defstringchar^^cd\defstringchar^^ce\defstringchar^^cf%
+ %
+ \defstringchar^^d0\defstringchar^^d1\defstringchar^^d2\defstringchar^^d3%
+ \defstringchar^^d4\defstringchar^^d5\defstringchar^^d6\defstringchar^^d7%
+ \defstringchar^^d8\defstringchar^^d9\defstringchar^^da\defstringchar^^db%
+ \defstringchar^^dc\defstringchar^^dd\defstringchar^^de\defstringchar^^df%
+ %
+ \defstringchar^^e0\defstringchar^^e1\defstringchar^^e2\defstringchar^^e3%
+ \defstringchar^^e4\defstringchar^^e5\defstringchar^^e6\defstringchar^^e7%
+ \defstringchar^^e8\defstringchar^^e9\defstringchar^^ea\defstringchar^^eb%
+ \defstringchar^^ec\defstringchar^^ed\defstringchar^^ee\defstringchar^^ef%
+ %
+ \defstringchar^^f0\defstringchar^^f1\defstringchar^^f2\defstringchar^^f3%
+ \defstringchar^^f4\defstringchar^^f5\defstringchar^^f6\defstringchar^^f7%
+ \defstringchar^^f8\defstringchar^^f9\defstringchar^^fa\defstringchar^^fb%
+ \defstringchar^^fc\defstringchar^^fd\defstringchar^^fe\defstringchar^^ff%
+}
+
+
+% define all the unicode characters we know about, for the sake of @U.
+\utfeightchardefs
+
+
% Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
% existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
% document encoding.
@@ -7984,10 +10677,10 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
% Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
\vbadness = 10000
-% Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
-\hbadness = 2000
+% Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
+\hbadness = 6666
-% Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans.
+% Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
\widowpenalty=10000
\clubpenalty=10000
@@ -8034,6 +10727,10 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\ifpdf
\pdfpageheight #7\relax
\pdfpagewidth #8\relax
+ % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
+ % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
+ \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
+ \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
\fi
%
\setleading{\textleading}
@@ -8048,7 +10745,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\textleading = 13.2pt
%
% If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
- \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}%
+ \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
{\voffset}{.25in}%
{\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
{11in}{8.5in}%
@@ -8060,7 +10757,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\textleading = 12pt
%
\internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
- {\voffset}{.25in}%
+ {-.2in}{0in}%
{\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
{9.25in}{7in}%
%
@@ -8104,7 +10801,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
% \global\normaloffset = -6mm
% \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
% @end tex
- \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm}
+ \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
{\voffset}{\hoffset}%
{\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
{297mm}{210mm}%
@@ -8169,7 +10866,7 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
\setleading{\textleading}%
%
- \dimen0 = #1
+ \dimen0 = #1\relax
\advance\dimen0 by \voffset
%
\dimen2 = \hsize
@@ -8188,25 +10885,21 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
\message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
+\def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
+
+% DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
+\catcode`\^^? = 14
+
% Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
-\catcode`\"=\other
-\catcode`\~=\other
-\catcode`\^=\other
-\catcode`\_=\other
-\catcode`\|=\other
-\catcode`\<=\other
-\catcode`\>=\other
-\catcode`\+=\other
-\catcode`\$=\other
-\def\normaldoublequote{"}
-\def\normaltilde{~}
-\def\normalcaret{^}
-\def\normalunderscore{_}
-\def\normalverticalbar{|}
-\def\normalless{<}
-\def\normalgreater{>}
-\def\normalplus{+}
-\def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
+\catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"}
+\catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
+\catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+}
+\catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<}
+\catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>}
+\catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^}
+\catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_}
+\catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|}
+\catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~}
% This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
% (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
@@ -8225,44 +10918,47 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
% this is not a problem.
\def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
-% Turn off all special characters except @
-% (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
+% Set catcodes for Texinfo file
+
+% Active characters for printing the wanted glyph.
% Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
% use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
-
+%
\catcode`\"=\active
\def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
\let"=\activedoublequote
-\catcode`\~=\active
-\def~{{\tt\char126}}
-\chardef\hat=`\^
-\catcode`\^=\active
-\def^{{\tt \hat}}
+\catcode`\~=\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ = \activetilde
+\chardef\hatchar=`\^
+\catcode`\^=\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hatchar}} \let^ = \activehat
\catcode`\_=\active
\def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
-\let\realunder=_
-% Subroutine for the previous macro.
\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
+\let\realunder=_
+
+\catcode`\|=\active \def|{{\tt\char124}}
-\catcode`\|=\active
-\def|{{\tt\char124}}
\chardef \less=`\<
-\catcode`\<=\active
-\def<{{\tt \less}}
+\catcode`\<=\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< = \activeless
\chardef \gtr=`\>
-\catcode`\>=\active
-\def>{{\tt \gtr}}
-\catcode`\+=\active
-\def+{{\tt \char 43}}
-\catcode`\$=\active
-\def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
+\catcode`\>=\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> = \activegtr
+\catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
+\catcode`\$=\active \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
+\catcode`\-=\active \let-=\normaldash
-% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
-% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
-% So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
-% \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
-\def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
+
+% used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page
+% breaks in the middle of an @tex block.
+\def\texinfochars{%
+ \let< = \activeless
+ \let> = \activegtr
+ \let~ = \activetilde
+ \let^ = \activehat
+ \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault
+ \let\b = \strong
+ \let\i = \smartitalic
+ % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too.
+}
% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
% parsing them.
@@ -8282,71 +10978,140 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
% \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
-% In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
+% In Texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
% in fixed width font.
-\catcode`\\=\active
-@def@normalbackslash{{@tt@backslashcurfont}}
-% On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
-% @let \ = @normalbackslash
+\catcode`\\=\active % @ for escape char from now on.
+
+% Print a typewriter backslash. For math mode, we can't simply use
+% \backslashcurfont: the story here is that in math mode, the \char
+% of \backslashcurfont ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol
+% font (because \char in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex
+% sets \mathcode`\\="026E). Hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
+% which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
+% ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the
+% usual hex value because it has already been made active.
+
+@def@ttbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}}
+@let@backslashchar = @ttbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
% \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
% \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
-% catcode other.
+% catcode other. We switch back and forth between these.
@gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
@gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
% the literal character `\'.
-%
-@def@normalturnoffactive{%
- @let\=@normalbackslash
- @let"=@normaldoublequote
- @let~=@normaltilde
- @let^=@normalcaret
- @let_=@normalunderscore
- @let|=@normalverticalbar
- @let<=@normalless
- @let>=@normalgreater
- @let+=@normalplus
- @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
- @unsepspaces
-}
-
-% Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
-% This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
-@otherifyactive
+%
+{@catcode`- = @active
+ @gdef@normalturnoffactive{%
+ @nonasciistringdefs
+ @let-=@normaldash
+ @let"=@normaldoublequote
+ @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
+ @let+=@normalplus
+ @let<=@normalless
+ @let>=@normalgreater
+ @let^=@normalcaret
+ @let_=@normalunderscore
+ @let|=@normalverticalbar
+ @let~=@normaltilde
+ @let\=@ttbackslash
+ @markupsetuplqdefault
+ @markupsetuprqdefault
+ @unsepspaces
+ }
+}
+% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
+% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
+% So turn them off again, and have @fixbackslash turn them back on.
+@catcode`+=@other @catcode`@_=@other
+
+% \enablebackslashhack - allow file to begin `\input texinfo'
+%
% If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
% That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
% a backslash.
-%
-@gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
-@global@let\ = @eatinput
+% If the file did not have a `\input texinfo', then it is turned off after
+% the first line; otherwise the first `\' in the file would cause an error.
+% This is used on the very last line of this file, texinfo.tex.
+% We also use @c to call @fixbackslash, in case ends of lines are hidden.
+{
+@catcode`@^=7
+@catcode`@^^M=13@gdef@enablebackslashhack{%
+ @global@let\ = @eatinput%
+ @catcode`@^^M=13%
+ @def@c{@fixbackslash@c}%
+ @def ^^M{@let^^M@secondlinenl}%
+ @gdef @secondlinenl{@let^^M@thirdlinenl}%
+ @gdef @thirdlinenl{@fixbackslash}%
+}}
+
+{@catcode`@^=7 @catcode`@^^M=13%
+@gdef@eatinput input texinfo#1^^M{@fixbackslash}}
+
+% Emergency active definition of newline, in case an active newline token
+% appears by mistake.
+{@catcode`@^=7 @catcode13=13%
+@gdef@enableemergencynewline{%
+ @gdef^^M{%
+ @par%
+ %<warning: active newline>@par%
+}}}
+
-% On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
-% the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
-% that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
-% Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
-% file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
-%
@gdef@fixbackslash{%
- @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
+ @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @ttbackslash @fi
+ @catcode13=5 % regular end of line
+ @enableemergencynewline
+ @let@c=@texinfoc
+ % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
+ % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
@catcode`+=@active
@catcode`@_=@active
+ %
+ % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
+ % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. This macro, @fixbackslash, gets
+ % called at the beginning of every Texinfo file. Not opening texinfo.cnf
+ % directly in this file, texinfo.tex, makes it possible to make a format
+ % file for Texinfo.
+ %
+ @openin 1 texinfo.cnf
+ @ifeof 1 @else @input texinfo.cnf @fi
+ @closein 1
}
+
% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
@escapechar = `@@
-% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
-@catcode`@& = @other
-@catcode`@# = @other
-@catcode`@% = @other
+% These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
+% active definitions as the normal characters.
+@def@normaldot{.}
+@def@normalquest{?}
+@def@normalslash{/}
+% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
+% @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
+@catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&}
+@catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#}
+@catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
+
+@let @hashchar = @normalhash
+
+@c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
+@c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we
+@c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
+@c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
+@catcode`@'=@active
+@catcode`@`=@active
+@markupsetuplqdefault
+@markupsetuprqdefault
@c Local variables:
@c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
-@c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
+@c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message\\|emacs-page"
@c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
@c time-stamp-end: "}"
@@ -8357,3 +11122,4 @@ should work if nowhere else does.}
@ignore
arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
@end ignore
+@enablebackslashhack
diff --git a/build-aux/update-copyright b/build-aux/update-copyright
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..17ee6b1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/update-copyright
@@ -0,0 +1,274 @@
+eval '(exit $?0)' && eval 'exec perl -wS -0777 -pi "$0" "$@"'
+ & eval 'exec perl -wS -0777 -pi "$0" $argv:q'
+ if 0;
+# Update an FSF copyright year list to include the current year.
+
+my $VERSION = '2016-01-12.23:13'; # UTC
+
+# Copyright (C) 2009-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# Written by Jim Meyering and Joel E. Denny
+
+# The arguments to this script should be names of files that contain
+# copyright statements to be updated. The copyright holder's name
+# defaults to "Free Software Foundation, Inc." but may be changed to
+# any other name by using the "UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_HOLDER" environment
+# variable.
+#
+# For example, you might wish to use the update-copyright target rule
+# in maint.mk from gnulib's maintainer-makefile module.
+#
+# Iff a copyright statement is recognized in a file and the final
+# year is not the current year, then the statement is updated for the
+# new year and it is reformatted to:
+#
+# 1. Fit within 72 columns.
+# 2. Convert 2-digit years to 4-digit years by prepending "19".
+# 3. Expand copyright year intervals. (See "Environment variables"
+# below.)
+#
+# A warning is printed for every file for which no copyright
+# statement is recognized.
+#
+# Each file's copyright statement must be formatted correctly in
+# order to be recognized. For example, each of these is fine:
+#
+# Copyright @copyright{} 1990-2005, 2007-2009 Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# # Copyright (C) 1990-2005, 2007-2009 Free Software
+# # Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# /*
+# * Copyright &copy; 90,2005,2007-2009
+# * Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# */
+#
+# However, the following format is not recognized because the line
+# prefix changes after the first line:
+#
+# ## Copyright (C) 1990-2005, 2007-2009 Free Software
+# # Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# However, any correctly formatted copyright statement following
+# a non-matching copyright statements would be recognized.
+#
+# The exact conditions that a file's copyright statement must meet
+# to be recognized are:
+#
+# 1. It is the first copyright statement that meets all of the
+# following conditions. Subsequent copyright statements are
+# ignored.
+# 2. Its format is "Copyright (C)", then a list of copyright years,
+# and then the name of the copyright holder.
+# 3. The "(C)" takes one of the following forms or is omitted
+# entirely:
+#
+# A. (C)
+# B. (c)
+# C. @copyright{}
+# D. &copy;
+#
+# 4. The "Copyright" appears at the beginning of a line, except that it
+# may be prefixed by any sequence (e.g., a comment) of no more than
+# 5 characters -- including white space.
+# 5. Iff such a prefix is present, the same prefix appears at the
+# beginning of each remaining line within the FSF copyright
+# statement. There is one exception in order to support C-style
+# comments: if the first line's prefix contains nothing but
+# whitespace surrounding a "/*", then the prefix for all subsequent
+# lines is the same as the first line's prefix except with each of
+# "/" and possibly "*" replaced by a " ". The replacement of "*"
+# by " " is consistent throughout all subsequent lines.
+# 6. Blank lines, even if preceded by the prefix, do not appear
+# within the FSF copyright statement.
+# 7. Each copyright year is 2 or 4 digits, and years are separated by
+# commas or dashes. Whitespace may appear after commas.
+#
+# Environment variables:
+#
+# 1. If UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_FORCE=1, a recognized FSF copyright statement
+# is reformatted even if it does not need updating for the new
+# year. If unset or set to 0, only updated FSF copyright
+# statements are reformatted.
+# 2. If UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_USE_INTERVALS=1, every series of consecutive
+# copyright years (such as 90, 1991, 1992-2007, 2008) in a
+# reformatted FSF copyright statement is collapsed to a single
+# interval (such as 1990-2008). If unset or set to 0, all existing
+# copyright year intervals in a reformatted FSF copyright statement
+# are expanded instead.
+# If UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_USE_INTERVALS=2, convert a sequence with gaps
+# to the minimal containing range. For example, convert
+# 2000, 2004-2007, 2009 to 2000-2009.
+# 3. For testing purposes, you can set the assumed current year in
+# UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_YEAR.
+# 4. The default maximum line length for a copyright line is 72.
+# Set UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_MAX_LINE_LENGTH to use a different length.
+# 5. Set UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_HOLDER if the copyright holder is other
+# than "Free Software Foundation, Inc.".
+
+use strict;
+use warnings;
+
+my $copyright_re = 'Copyright';
+my $circle_c_re = '(?:\([cC]\)|@copyright\{}|\\\\\(co|&copy;)';
+my $holder = $ENV{UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_HOLDER};
+$holder ||= 'Free Software Foundation, Inc.';
+my $prefix_max = 5;
+my $margin = $ENV{UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_MAX_LINE_LENGTH};
+!$margin || $margin !~ m/^\d+$/
+ and $margin = 72;
+
+my $tab_width = 8;
+
+my $this_year = $ENV{UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_YEAR};
+if (!$this_year || $this_year !~ m/^\d{4}$/)
+ {
+ my ($sec, $min, $hour, $mday, $month, $year) = localtime (time ());
+ $this_year = $year + 1900;
+ }
+
+# Unless the file consistently uses "\r\n" as the EOL, use "\n" instead.
+my $eol = /(?:^|[^\r])\n/ ? "\n" : "\r\n";
+
+my $leading;
+my $prefix;
+my $ws_re;
+my $stmt_re;
+while (/(^|\n)(.{0,$prefix_max})$copyright_re/g)
+ {
+ $leading = "$1$2";
+ $prefix = $2;
+ if ($prefix =~ /^(\s*\/)\*(\s*)$/)
+ {
+ $prefix =~ s,/, ,;
+ my $prefix_ws = $prefix;
+ $prefix_ws =~ s/\*/ /; # Only whitespace.
+ if (/\G(?:[^*\n]|\*[^\/\n])*\*?\n$prefix_ws/)
+ {
+ $prefix = $prefix_ws;
+ }
+ }
+ $ws_re = '[ \t\r\f]'; # \s without \n
+ $ws_re =
+ "(?:$ws_re*(?:$ws_re|\\n" . quotemeta($prefix) . ")$ws_re*)";
+ my $holder_re = $holder;
+ $holder_re =~ s/\s/$ws_re/g;
+ my $stmt_remainder_re =
+ "(?:$ws_re$circle_c_re)?"
+ . "$ws_re(?:(?:\\d\\d)?\\d\\d(?:,$ws_re?|-))*"
+ . "((?:\\d\\d)?\\d\\d)$ws_re$holder_re";
+ if (/\G$stmt_remainder_re/)
+ {
+ $stmt_re =
+ quotemeta($leading) . "($copyright_re$stmt_remainder_re)";
+ last;
+ }
+ }
+if (defined $stmt_re)
+ {
+ /$stmt_re/ or die; # Should never die.
+ my $stmt = $1;
+ my $final_year_orig = $2;
+
+ # Handle two-digit year numbers like "98" and "99".
+ my $final_year = $final_year_orig;
+ $final_year <= 99
+ and $final_year += 1900;
+
+ if ($final_year != $this_year)
+ {
+ # Update the year.
+ $stmt =~ s/\b$final_year_orig\b/$final_year, $this_year/;
+ }
+ if ($final_year != $this_year || $ENV{'UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_FORCE'})
+ {
+ # Normalize all whitespace including newline-prefix sequences.
+ $stmt =~ s/$ws_re/ /g;
+
+ # Put spaces after commas.
+ $stmt =~ s/, ?/, /g;
+
+ # Convert 2-digit to 4-digit years.
+ $stmt =~ s/(\b\d\d\b)/19$1/g;
+
+ # Make the use of intervals consistent.
+ if (!$ENV{UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_USE_INTERVALS})
+ {
+ $stmt =~ s/(\d{4})-(\d{4})/join(', ', $1..$2)/eg;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ $stmt =~
+ s/
+ (\d{4})
+ (?:
+ (,\ |-)
+ ((??{
+ if ($2 eq '-') { '\d{4}'; }
+ elsif (!$3) { $1 + 1; }
+ else { $3 + 1; }
+ }))
+ )+
+ /$1-$3/gx;
+
+ # When it's 2, emit a single range encompassing all year numbers.
+ $ENV{UPDATE_COPYRIGHT_USE_INTERVALS} == 2
+ and $stmt =~ s/\b(\d{4})\b.*\b(\d{4})\b/$1-$2/;
+ }
+
+ # Format within margin.
+ my $stmt_wrapped;
+ my $text_margin = $margin - length($prefix);
+ if ($prefix =~ /^(\t+)/)
+ {
+ $text_margin -= length($1) * ($tab_width - 1);
+ }
+ while (length $stmt)
+ {
+ if (($stmt =~ s/^(.{1,$text_margin})(?: |$)//)
+ || ($stmt =~ s/^([\S]+)(?: |$)//))
+ {
+ my $line = $1;
+ $stmt_wrapped .= $stmt_wrapped ? "$eol$prefix" : $leading;
+ $stmt_wrapped .= $line;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ # Should be unreachable, but we don't want an infinite
+ # loop if it can be reached.
+ die;
+ }
+ }
+
+ # Replace the old copyright statement.
+ s/$stmt_re/$stmt_wrapped/;
+ }
+ }
+else
+ {
+ print STDERR "$ARGV: warning: copyright statement not found\n";
+ }
+
+# Local variables:
+# mode: perl
+# indent-tabs-mode: nil
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "my $VERSION = '"
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H:%02M"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "'; # UTC"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/useless-if-before-free b/build-aux/useless-if-before-free
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..1899b1f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/build-aux/useless-if-before-free
@@ -0,0 +1,207 @@
+eval '(exit $?0)' && eval 'exec perl -wST "$0" "$@"'
+ & eval 'exec perl -wST "$0" $argv:q'
+ if 0;
+# Detect instances of "if (p) free (p);".
+# Likewise "if (p != 0)", "if (0 != p)", or with NULL; and with braces.
+
+my $VERSION = '2016-01-12 23:13'; # UTC
+# The definition above must lie within the first 8 lines in order
+# for the Emacs time-stamp write hook (at end) to update it.
+# If you change this file with Emacs, please let the write hook
+# do its job. Otherwise, update this string manually.
+
+# Copyright (C) 2008-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
+# (at your option) any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+
+# Written by Jim Meyering
+
+use strict;
+use warnings;
+use Getopt::Long;
+
+(my $ME = $0) =~ s|.*/||;
+
+# use File::Coda; # http://meyering.net/code/Coda/
+END {
+ defined fileno STDOUT or return;
+ close STDOUT and return;
+ warn "$ME: failed to close standard output: $!\n";
+ $? ||= 1;
+}
+
+sub usage ($)
+{
+ my ($exit_code) = @_;
+ my $STREAM = ($exit_code == 0 ? *STDOUT : *STDERR);
+ if ($exit_code != 0)
+ {
+ print $STREAM "Try '$ME --help' for more information.\n";
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ print $STREAM <<EOF;
+Usage: $ME [OPTIONS] FILE...
+
+Detect any instance in FILE of a useless "if" test before a free call, e.g.,
+"if (p) free (p);". Any such test may be safely removed without affecting
+the semantics of the C code in FILE. Use --name=FOO --name=BAR to also
+detect free-like functions named FOO and BAR.
+
+OPTIONS:
+
+ --list print only the name of each matching FILE (\\0-terminated)
+ --name=N add name N to the list of \'free\'-like functions to detect;
+ may be repeated
+
+ --help display this help and exit
+ --version output version information and exit
+
+Exit status:
+
+ 0 one or more matches
+ 1 no match
+ 2 an error
+
+EXAMPLE:
+
+For example, this command prints all removable "if" tests before "free"
+and "kfree" calls in the linux kernel sources:
+
+ git ls-files -z |xargs -0 $ME --name=kfree
+
+EOF
+ }
+ exit $exit_code;
+}
+
+sub is_NULL ($)
+{
+ my ($expr) = @_;
+ return ($expr eq 'NULL' || $expr eq '0');
+}
+
+{
+ sub EXIT_MATCH {0}
+ sub EXIT_NO_MATCH {1}
+ sub EXIT_ERROR {2}
+ my $err = EXIT_NO_MATCH;
+
+ my $list;
+ my @name = qw(free);
+ GetOptions
+ (
+ help => sub { usage 0 },
+ version => sub { print "$ME version $VERSION\n"; exit },
+ list => \$list,
+ 'name=s@' => \@name,
+ ) or usage 1;
+
+ # Make sure we have the right number of non-option arguments.
+ # Always tell the user why we fail.
+ @ARGV < 1
+ and (warn "$ME: missing FILE argument\n"), usage EXIT_ERROR;
+
+ my $or = join '|', @name;
+ my $regexp = qr/(?:$or)/;
+
+ # Set the input record separator.
+ # Note: this makes it impractical to print line numbers.
+ $/ = '"';
+
+ my $found_match = 0;
+ FILE:
+ foreach my $file (@ARGV)
+ {
+ open FH, '<', $file
+ or (warn "$ME: can't open '$file' for reading: $!\n"),
+ $err = EXIT_ERROR, next;
+ while (defined (my $line = <FH>))
+ {
+ while ($line =~
+ /\b(if\s*\(\s*([^)]+?)(?:\s*!=\s*([^)]+?))?\s*\)
+ # 1 2 3
+ (?: \s*$regexp\s*\((?:\s*\([^)]+\))?\s*([^)]+)\)\s*;|
+ \s*\{\s*$regexp\s*\((?:\s*\([^)]+\))?\s*([^)]+)\)\s*;\s*\}))/sxg)
+ {
+ my $all = $1;
+ my ($lhs, $rhs) = ($2, $3);
+ my ($free_opnd, $braced_free_opnd) = ($4, $5);
+ my $non_NULL;
+ if (!defined $rhs) { $non_NULL = $lhs }
+ elsif (is_NULL $rhs) { $non_NULL = $lhs }
+ elsif (is_NULL $lhs) { $non_NULL = $rhs }
+ else { next }
+
+ # Compare the non-NULL part of the "if" expression and the
+ # free'd expression, without regard to white space.
+ $non_NULL =~ tr/ \t//d;
+ my $e2 = defined $free_opnd ? $free_opnd : $braced_free_opnd;
+ $e2 =~ tr/ \t//d;
+ if ($non_NULL eq $e2)
+ {
+ $found_match = 1;
+ $list
+ and (print "$file\0"), next FILE;
+ print "$file: $all\n";
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ continue
+ {
+ close FH;
+ }
+
+ $found_match && $err == EXIT_NO_MATCH
+ and $err = EXIT_MATCH;
+
+ exit $err;
+}
+
+my $foo = <<'EOF';
+# The above is to *find* them.
+# This adjusts them, removing the unnecessary "if (p)" part.
+
+# FIXME: do something like this as an option (doesn't do braces):
+free=xfree
+git grep -l -z "$free *(" \
+ | xargs -0 useless-if-before-free -l --name="$free" \
+ | xargs -0 perl -0x3b -pi -e \
+ 's/\bif\s*\(\s*(\S+?)(?:\s*!=\s*(?:0|NULL))?\s*\)\s+('"$free"'\s*\((?:\s*\([^)]+\))?\s*\1\s*\)\s*;)/$2/s'
+
+# Use the following to remove redundant uses of kfree inside braces.
+# Note that -0777 puts perl in slurp-whole-file mode;
+# but we have plenty of memory, these days...
+free=kfree
+git grep -l -z "$free *(" \
+ | xargs -0 useless-if-before-free -l --name="$free" \
+ | xargs -0 perl -0777 -pi -e \
+ 's/\bif\s*\(\s*(\S+?)(?:\s*!=\s*(?:0|NULL))?\s*\)\s*\{\s*('"$free"'\s*\((?:\s*\([^)]+\))?\s*\1\s*\);)\s*\}[^\n]*$/$2/gms'
+
+Be careful that the result of the above transformation is valid.
+If the matched string is followed by "else", then obviously, it won't be.
+
+When modifying files, refuse to process anything other than a regular file.
+EOF
+
+## Local Variables:
+## mode: perl
+## indent-tabs-mode: nil
+## eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+## time-stamp-start: "my $VERSION = '"
+## time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d %02H:%02M"
+## time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+## time-stamp-end: "'; # UTC"
+## End:
diff --git a/build-aux/vc-list-files b/build-aux/vc-list-files
index b170638..c5c420a 100755
--- a/build-aux/vc-list-files
+++ b/build-aux/vc-list-files
@@ -1,12 +1,15 @@
#!/bin/sh
-# List the specified version-controlled files.
+# List version-controlled file names.
+
+# Print a version string.
+scriptversion=2016-01-11.22; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 2006-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-# any later version.
+# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
+# (at your option) any later version.
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
@@ -14,47 +17,97 @@
# GNU General Public License for more details.
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-# Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
# List the specified version-controlled files.
-# With no argument, list them all.
-# This script must be run solely from the top of a $srcdir build directory.
+# With no argument, list them all. With a single DIRECTORY argument,
+# list the version-controlled files in that directory.
-# If there's an argument, it must be a single, "."-relative directory name,
-# with no trailing slashes. In mercurial mode, it's used as part of a
-# "grep" pattern (prepend "^", append "/"), and in cvs mode, it's simply
-# used as an argument to the cvsu script.
+# If there's an argument, it must be a single, "."-relative directory name.
# cvsu is part of the cvsutils package: http://www.red-bean.com/cvsutils/
-include_prefix=
-case $# in
- 0) ;;
- 1) include_prefix=$1 ;;
- *) echo "$0: too many arguments" 1>&2; exit 1 ;;
+postprocess=
+case $1 in
+ --help) cat <<EOF
+Usage: $0 [-C SRCDIR] [DIR...]
+
+Output a list of version-controlled files in DIR (default .), relative to
+SRCDIR (default .). SRCDIR must be the top directory of a checkout.
+
+Options:
+ --help print this help, then exit
+ --version print version number, then exit
+ -C SRCDIR change directory to SRCDIR before generating list
+
+Report bugs and patches to <bug-gnulib@gnu.org>.
+EOF
+ exit ;;
+
+ --version)
+ year=`echo "$scriptversion" | sed 's/[^0-9].*//'`
+ cat <<EOF
+vc-list-files $scriptversion
+Copyright (C) $year Free Software Foundation, Inc,
+License GPLv3+: GNU GPL version 3 or later <http://gnu.org/licenses/gpl.html>
+This is free software: you are free to change and redistribute it.
+There is NO WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law.
+EOF
+ exit ;;
+
+ -C)
+ test "$2" = . || postprocess="| sed 's|^|$2/|'"
+ cd "$2" || exit 1
+ shift; shift ;;
esac
-if test -d .git; then
- if test "x$include_prefix" = x; then
- git-ls-files
- else
- git-ls-files | grep "^$include_prefix/"
- fi
-elif test -d .hg; then
- if test "x$include_prefix" = x; then
- hg manifest | cut -d ' ' -f 2
+test $# = 0 && set .
+
+for dir
+do
+ if test -d .git; then
+ test "x$dir" = x. \
+ && dir= sed_esc= \
+ || { dir="$dir/"; sed_esc=`echo "$dir"|env sed 's,\([\\/]\),\\\\\1,g'`; }
+ # Ignore git symlinks - either they point into the tree, in which case
+ # we don't need to visit the target twice, or they point somewhere
+ # else (often into a submodule), in which case the content does not
+ # belong to this package.
+ eval exec git ls-tree -r 'HEAD:"$dir"' \
+ \| sed -n '"s/^100[^ ]*./$sed_esc/p"' $postprocess
+ elif test -d .hg; then
+ eval exec hg locate '"$dir/*"' $postprocess
+ elif test -d .bzr; then
+ test "$postprocess" = '' && postprocess="| sed 's|^\./||'"
+ eval exec bzr ls -R --versioned '"$dir"' $postprocess
+ elif test -d CVS; then
+ test "$postprocess" = '' && postprocess="| sed 's|^\./||'"
+ if test -x build-aux/cvsu; then
+ eval build-aux/cvsu --find --types=AFGM '"$dir"' $postprocess
+ elif (cvsu --help) >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ eval cvsu --find --types=AFGM '"$dir"' $postprocess
+ else
+ eval awk -F/ \''{ \
+ if (!$1 && $3 !~ /^-/) { \
+ f=FILENAME; \
+ if (f ~ /CVS\/Entries$/) \
+ f = substr(f, 1, length(f)-11); \
+ print f $2; \
+ }}'\'' \
+ `find "$dir" -name Entries -print` /dev/null' $postprocess
+ fi
+ elif test -d .svn; then
+ eval exec svn list -R '"$dir"' $postprocess
else
- hg manifest | cut -d ' ' -f 2 | grep "^$include_prefix/"
+ echo "$0: Failed to determine type of version control used in `pwd`" 1>&2
+ exit 1
fi
-elif test -x build-aux/cvsu; then
- build-aux/cvsu --find --types=AFGM $include_prefix
-else
- awk -F/ '{ \
- if (!$1 && $3 !~ /^-/) { \
- f=FILENAME; \
- sub(/CVS\/Entries/, "", f); \
- print f $2; \
- }}' \
- $(find ${*-*} -name Entries -print) /dev/null;
-fi
+done
+
+# Local variables:
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC0"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
+# End:
diff --git a/build-aux/ylwrap b/build-aux/ylwrap
index 102bd89..7c2d927 100755
--- a/build-aux/ylwrap
+++ b/build-aux/ylwrap
@@ -1,10 +1,9 @@
#! /bin/sh
# ylwrap - wrapper for lex/yacc invocations.
-scriptversion=2005-05-14.22
+scriptversion=2013-01-12.17; # UTC
-# Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
-# Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Copyright (C) 1996-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
#
# Written by Tom Tromey <tromey@cygnus.com>.
#
@@ -19,9 +18,7 @@ scriptversion=2005-05-14.22
# GNU General Public License for more details.
#
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
-# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
-# 02110-1301, USA.
+# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
@@ -32,9 +29,41 @@ scriptversion=2005-05-14.22
# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
+get_dirname ()
+{
+ case $1 in
+ */*|*\\*) printf '%s\n' "$1" | sed -e 's|\([\\/]\)[^\\/]*$|\1|';;
+ # Otherwise, we want the empty string (not ".").
+ esac
+}
+
+# guard FILE
+# ----------
+# The CPP macro used to guard inclusion of FILE.
+guard ()
+{
+ printf '%s\n' "$1" \
+ | sed \
+ -e 'y/abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz/ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ/' \
+ -e 's/[^ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ]/_/g' \
+ -e 's/__*/_/g'
+}
+
+# quote_for_sed [STRING]
+# ----------------------
+# Return STRING (or stdin) quoted to be used as a sed pattern.
+quote_for_sed ()
+{
+ case $# in
+ 0) cat;;
+ 1) printf '%s\n' "$1";;
+ esac \
+ | sed -e 's|[][\\.*]|\\&|g'
+}
+
case "$1" in
'')
- echo "$0: No files given. Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
+ echo "$0: No files given. Try '$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
exit 1
;;
--basedir)
@@ -67,144 +96,138 @@ esac
# The input.
-input="$1"
+input=$1
shift
-case "$input" in
+# We'll later need for a correct munging of "#line" directives.
+input_sub_rx=`get_dirname "$input" | quote_for_sed`
+case $input in
[\\/]* | ?:[\\/]*)
# Absolute path; do nothing.
;;
*)
# Relative path. Make it absolute.
- input="`pwd`/$input"
+ input=`pwd`/$input
;;
esac
+input_rx=`get_dirname "$input" | quote_for_sed`
+
+# Since DOS filename conventions don't allow two dots,
+# the DOS version of Bison writes out y_tab.c instead of y.tab.c
+# and y_tab.h instead of y.tab.h. Test to see if this is the case.
+y_tab_nodot=false
+if test -f y_tab.c || test -f y_tab.h; then
+ y_tab_nodot=true
+fi
+
+# The parser itself, the first file, is the destination of the .y.c
+# rule in the Makefile.
+parser=$1
+
+# A sed program to s/FROM/TO/g for all the FROM/TO so that, for
+# instance, we rename #include "y.tab.h" into #include "parse.h"
+# during the conversion from y.tab.c to parse.c.
+sed_fix_filenames=
-pairlist=
-while test "$#" -ne 0; do
- if test "$1" = "--"; then
+# Also rename header guards, as Bison 2.7 for instance uses its header
+# guard in its implementation file.
+sed_fix_header_guards=
+
+while test $# -ne 0; do
+ if test x"$1" = x"--"; then
shift
break
fi
- pairlist="$pairlist $1"
+ from=$1
+ # Handle y_tab.c and y_tab.h output by DOS
+ if $y_tab_nodot; then
+ case $from in
+ "y.tab.c") from=y_tab.c;;
+ "y.tab.h") from=y_tab.h;;
+ esac
+ fi
shift
+ to=$1
+ shift
+ sed_fix_filenames="${sed_fix_filenames}s|"`quote_for_sed "$from"`"|$to|g;"
+ sed_fix_header_guards="${sed_fix_header_guards}s|"`guard "$from"`"|"`guard "$to"`"|g;"
done
# The program to run.
-prog="$1"
+prog=$1
shift
# Make any relative path in $prog absolute.
-case "$prog" in
+case $prog in
[\\/]* | ?:[\\/]*) ;;
- *[\\/]*) prog="`pwd`/$prog" ;;
+ *[\\/]*) prog=`pwd`/$prog ;;
esac
-# FIXME: add hostname here for parallel makes that run commands on
-# other machines. But that might take us over the 14-char limit.
dirname=ylwrap$$
-trap "cd `pwd`; rm -rf $dirname > /dev/null 2>&1" 1 2 3 15
+do_exit="cd '`pwd`' && rm -rf $dirname > /dev/null 2>&1;"' (exit $ret); exit $ret'
+trap "ret=129; $do_exit" 1
+trap "ret=130; $do_exit" 2
+trap "ret=141; $do_exit" 13
+trap "ret=143; $do_exit" 15
mkdir $dirname || exit 1
cd $dirname
case $# in
- 0) $prog "$input" ;;
- *) $prog "$@" "$input" ;;
+ 0) "$prog" "$input" ;;
+ *) "$prog" "$@" "$input" ;;
esac
ret=$?
if test $ret -eq 0; then
- set X $pairlist
- shift
- first=yes
- # Since DOS filename conventions don't allow two dots,
- # the DOS version of Bison writes out y_tab.c instead of y.tab.c
- # and y_tab.h instead of y.tab.h. Test to see if this is the case.
- y_tab_nodot="no"
- if test -f y_tab.c || test -f y_tab.h; then
- y_tab_nodot="yes"
- fi
-
- # The directory holding the input.
- input_dir=`echo "$input" | sed -e 's,\([\\/]\)[^\\/]*$,\1,'`
- # Quote $INPUT_DIR so we can use it in a regexp.
- # FIXME: really we should care about more than `.' and `\'.
- input_rx=`echo "$input_dir" | sed 's,\\\\,\\\\\\\\,g;s,\\.,\\\\.,g'`
-
- while test "$#" -ne 0; do
- from="$1"
- # Handle y_tab.c and y_tab.h output by DOS
- if test $y_tab_nodot = "yes"; then
- if test $from = "y.tab.c"; then
- from="y_tab.c"
- else
- if test $from = "y.tab.h"; then
- from="y_tab.h"
- fi
- fi
- fi
+ for from in *
+ do
+ to=`printf '%s\n' "$from" | sed "$sed_fix_filenames"`
if test -f "$from"; then
# If $2 is an absolute path name, then just use that,
- # otherwise prepend `../'.
- case "$2" in
- [\\/]* | ?:[\\/]*) target="$2";;
- *) target="../$2";;
+ # otherwise prepend '../'.
+ case $to in
+ [\\/]* | ?:[\\/]*) target=$to;;
+ *) target=../$to;;
esac
- # We do not want to overwrite a header file if it hasn't
- # changed. This avoid useless recompilations. However the
- # parser itself (the first file) should always be updated,
- # because it is the destination of the .y.c rule in the
- # Makefile. Divert the output of all other files to a temporary
- # file so we can compare them to existing versions.
- if test $first = no; then
- realtarget="$target"
- target="tmp-`echo $target | sed s/.*[\\/]//g`"
+ # Do not overwrite unchanged header files to avoid useless
+ # recompilations. Always update the parser itself: it is the
+ # destination of the .y.c rule in the Makefile. Divert the
+ # output of all other files to a temporary file so we can
+ # compare them to existing versions.
+ if test $from != $parser; then
+ realtarget=$target
+ target=tmp-`printf '%s\n' "$target" | sed 's|.*[\\/]||g'`
fi
- # Edit out `#line' or `#' directives.
- #
- # We don't want the resulting debug information to point at
- # an absolute srcdir; it is better for it to just mention the
- # .y file with no path.
- #
- # We want to use the real output file name, not yy.lex.c for
- # instance.
- #
- # We want the include guards to be adjusted too.
- FROM=`echo "$from" | sed \
- -e 'y/abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz/ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ/'\
- -e 's/[^ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ]/_/g'`
- TARGET=`echo "$2" | sed \
- -e 'y/abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz/ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ/'\
- -e 's/[^ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ]/_/g'`
-
- sed -e "/^#/!b" -e "s,$input_rx,," -e "s,$from,$2," \
- -e "s,$FROM,$TARGET," "$from" >"$target" || ret=$?
-
- # Check whether header files must be updated.
- if test $first = no; then
- if test -f "$realtarget" && cmp -s "$realtarget" "$target"; then
- echo "$2" is unchanged
- rm -f "$target"
- else
- echo updating "$2"
+
+ # Munge "#line" or "#" directives. Don't let the resulting
+ # debug information point at an absolute srcdir. Use the real
+ # output file name, not yy.lex.c for instance. Adjust the
+ # include guards too.
+ sed -e "/^#/!b" \
+ -e "s|$input_rx|$input_sub_rx|" \
+ -e "$sed_fix_filenames" \
+ -e "$sed_fix_header_guards" \
+ "$from" >"$target" || ret=$?
+
+ # Check whether files must be updated.
+ if test "$from" != "$parser"; then
+ if test -f "$realtarget" && cmp -s "$realtarget" "$target"; then
+ echo "$to is unchanged"
+ rm -f "$target"
+ else
+ echo "updating $to"
mv -f "$target" "$realtarget"
fi
fi
else
- # A missing file is only an error for the first file. This
- # is a blatant hack to let us support using "yacc -d". If -d
- # is not specified, we don't want an error when the header
- # file is "missing".
- if test $first = yes; then
+ # A missing file is only an error for the parser. This is a
+ # blatant hack to let us support using "yacc -d". If -d is not
+ # specified, don't fail when the header file is "missing".
+ if test "$from" = "$parser"; then
ret=1
fi
fi
- shift
- shift
- first=no
done
-else
- ret=$?
fi
# Remove the directory.
@@ -219,5 +242,6 @@ exit $ret
# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC"
+# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
# End: